Ford Automobile 2010 F 250 User Manual

Table of Contents  
All rights reserved. Reproduction by any means, electronic or mechanical  
including photocopying, recording or by any information storage and retrieval  
system or translation in whole or part is not permitted without written  
authorization from Ford Motor Company. Ford may change the contents without  
notice and without incurring obligation.  
Copyright © 2009 Ford Motor Company  
3
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
CONGRATULATIONS  
Congratulations on acquiring your new Ford. Please take the time to get  
well acquainted with your vehicle by reading this handbook. The more  
you know and understand about your vehicle, the greater the safety and  
pleasure you will derive from driving it.  
For more information on Ford Motor Company and its products visit the  
following website:  
In the United States: www.ford.com  
In Canada: www.ford.ca  
In Australia: www.ford.com.au  
In Mexico: www.ford.com.mx  
Additional owner information is given in separate publications.  
This Owner’s Guide describes every option and model variant available  
and therefore some of the items covered may not apply to your  
particular vehicle. Furthermore, due to printing cycles it may describe  
options before they are generally available.  
Remember to pass on this Owner’s Guide when reselling the vehicle. It is  
an integral part of the vehicle.  
WARNING: Fuel pump shut-off switch: In the event of an  
accident the safety switch will automatically cut off the fuel  
supply to the engine. The switch can also be activated through sudden  
vibration (e.g. collision when parking). To reset the switch, refer to the  
Fuel pump shut-off switch in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
SAFETY AND ENVIRONMENT PROTECTION  
Warning symbols in this guide  
How can you reduce the risk of personal injury to yourself or others? In  
this guide, answers to such questions are contained in comments  
highlighted by the warning triangle symbol. These comments should be  
read and observed.  
4
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
Warning symbols on your vehicle  
When you see this symbol, it is  
imperative that you consult the  
relevant section of this guide before  
touching or attempting adjustment  
of any kind.  
Protecting the environment  
We must all play our part in  
protecting the environment. Correct  
vehicle usage and the authorized  
disposal of waste, cleaning and  
lubrication materials are significant  
steps towards this aim. Information in this respect is highlighted in this  
guide with the tree symbol.  
CALIFORNIA Proposition 65 Warning  
WARNING: Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and  
certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to  
the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and  
certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known  
to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm.  
PERCHLORATE MATERIAL  
Certain components of this vehicle such as airbag modules, seat belt  
pretensioners, and button cell batteries may contain Perchlorate Material  
– Special handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal.  
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
BREAKING-IN YOUR VEHICLE  
Your vehicle does not need an extensive break-in. Try not to drive  
continuously at the same speed for the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of  
new vehicle operation. Vary your speed frequently in order to give the  
moving parts a chance to break in.  
Drive your new vehicle at least 1,000 miles (1,600 km) before towing a  
trailer. For more detailed information about towing a trailer, refer to  
Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
5
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Do not add friction modifier compounds or special break-in oils since  
these additives may prevent piston ring seating. See Engine oil in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter for more information on oil  
usage.  
SPECIAL NOTICES  
New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
For a detailed description of what is covered and what is not covered by  
your vehicle’s New Vehicle Limited Warranty, refer to the Warranty  
Guide/Customer Information Guide that is provided to you along with  
your Owner’s Guide.  
Special instructions  
For your added safety, your vehicle is fitted with sophisticated electronic  
controls.  
WARNING: Please read the section Airbag Supplemental  
Restraint System (SRS) in the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter. Failure to follow the specific warnings and instructions could  
result in personal injury.  
WARNING: Front seat mounted rear-facing child or infant seats  
should NEVER be placed in front of an active passenger airbag.  
Notice to owners of diesel-powered vehicles  
Read the 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement for information regarding correct operation  
and maintenance of your Diesel-powered light truck.  
Notice to owners of pickup trucks and utility type vehicles  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
Before you drive your vehicle, please read this Owner’s Guide carefully.  
Your vehicle is not a passenger car. As with other vehicles of this type,  
failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury or death.  
6
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
Using your vehicle with a snowplow  
For more information and guidelines for using your vehicle with a  
snowplow, refer to the Driving chapter.  
Using your vehicle as an ambulance  
If your light truck is equipped with the Ford Ambulance Preparation  
Package, it may be utilized as an ambulance. Ford urges ambulance  
manufacturers to follow the recommendations of the Ford Incomplete  
Vehicle Manual, Ford Truck Body Builder’s Layout Book and the  
Qualified Vehicle Modifiers (QVM) Guidelines as well as pertinent  
supplements. For additional information, please contact the Truck Body  
Builders Advisory Service at http://www.fleet.ford.com/truckbbas/ and  
then by selecting “Contact Us” or by phone at 1–877–840–4338.  
Use of your Ford light truck as an ambulance, without the Ford  
Ambulance Preparation Package voids the Ford New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty and may void the Emissions Warranties. In addition, ambulance  
usage without the preparation package could cause high underbody  
temperatures, overpressurized fuel and a risk of spraying fuel which  
could lead to fires.  
If your vehicle is equipped with the Ford Ambulance Preparation  
Package, it will be indicated on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label. The label is located on the driver’s side door pillar or on the rear  
edge of the driver’s door. You can determine whether the ambulance  
manufacturer followed Ford’s recommendations by directly contacting  
that manufacturer. Ford Ambulance Preparation Package is only available  
on certain Diesel engine equipped vehicles.  
Using your vehicle as a stationary power source (PTO)  
Refer to the Driving chapter for more information and guidelines for  
operating a vehicle equipped with an aftermarket power take-off system.  
7
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
DATA RECORDING  
Service Data Recording  
Service data recorders in your vehicle are capable of collecting and  
storing diagnostic information about your vehicle. This potentially  
includes information about the performance or status of various systems  
and modules in the vehicle, such as engine, throttle, steering or brake  
systems. In order to properly diagnose and service your vehicle, Ford  
Motor Company, Ford of Canada, and service and repair facilities may  
access or share among them vehicle diagnostic information received  
through a direct connection to your vehicle when diagnosing or servicing  
your vehicle. For U.S. only (if equipped), if you choose to use the SYNC௡  
Vehicle Health Report, you consent that certain diagnostic information  
may also be accessed electronically by Ford Motor Company and Ford  
authorized service facilities, and that the diagnostic information may be  
used for any purpose. See your SYNCsupplement for more information.  
Event Data Recording  
Other modules in your vehicle — event data recorders — are  
capable of collecting and storing data during a crash or near  
crash event. The recorded information may assist in the  
investigation of such an event. The modules may record  
information about both the vehicle and the occupants, potentially  
including information such as:  
how various systems in your vehicle were operating;  
whether or not the driver and passenger seatbelts were  
buckled;  
how far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator  
and/or the brake pedal;  
how fast the vehicle was traveling;  
where the driver was positioning the steering wheel; and  
longitude and latitude of vehicle at last location, using GPS  
technology and advanced vehicle sensors.  
8
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
To access this information, special equipment must be directly  
connected to the recording modules. Ford Motor Company and  
Ford of Canada do not access event data recorder information  
without obtaining consent, unless pursuant to court order or  
where required by law enforcement, other government authorities  
or other third parties acting with lawful authority. Other parties  
may seek to access the information independently of Ford Motor  
Company and Ford of Canada. To the extent that any law  
pertaining to Event Data Recording applies to SYNCor its  
features, please note the following: Once 911 Assist (if equipped)  
is enabled (set ON), 911 Assist may, through any paired and  
connected cell phone, disclose to emergency services that the  
vehicle has been in a crash involving the deployment of an airbag  
or, in certain vehicles, the activation of the fuel pump shut-off.  
Certain versions or updates to 911 Assist may also be capable of  
electronically or verbally disclosing to 911 operators the vehicle  
location, and/or other details about the vehicle or crash to assist  
911 operators to provide the most appropriate emergency  
services. If you do not want to disclose this information, do not  
activate the feature. See your SYNCsupplement for more  
information. Additionally, when you connect to Traffic, Directions  
and Information (if equipped, U.S. only), the service uses GPS  
technology and advanced vehicle sensors to collect the vehicle’s  
current location, travel direction, and speed (“vehicle travel  
information”) only to help provide you with the directions, traffic  
reports, or business searches you request. If you do not want  
Ford or its vendors to receive this information, do not activate  
the service. Ford Motor Company and the vendors it uses to  
provide you with this information do not store your vehicle travel  
information. For more information, see Traffic, Directions and  
Information, Terms and Conditions. See your SYNCsupplement  
for more information.  
9
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Vehicle Modification Data Recording  
Some aftermarket products may cause severe engine and/or transmission  
damage; refer to the What is not covered section in The new vehicle  
limited warranty for your vehicle chapter of your vehicle’s Warranty  
Guide for more information. Some vehicles are equipped with  
Powertrain Control Systems that can detect and store information about  
vehicle modifications that, for example, increase horsepower and torque  
output; this information cannot be erased and will stay in the system’s  
memory even if the modification is removed. When a dealer or repair  
facility works on your vehicle, it may be necessary for them to access the  
information in the Powertrain Control System. This information will likely  
identify if any unauthorized modifications have been made to the system,  
which may be used to determine if the warranty has been violated and if  
repairs will be covered by warranty.  
CELL PHONE USE  
The use of Mobile Communications Equipment has become increasingly  
important in the conduct of business and personal affairs. However,  
drivers must not compromise their own or others’ safety when using  
such equipment. Mobile Communications can enhance personal safety  
and security when appropriately used, particularly in emergency  
situations. Safety must be paramount when using mobile communications  
equipment to avoid negating these benefits.  
Mobile Communication Equipment includes, but is not limited to cellular  
phones, pagers, portable email devices, in-vehicle communications  
systems, telematics devices and portable two-way radios.  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
10  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
EXPORT UNIQUE (NON–UNITED STATES/CANADA) VEHICLE  
SPECIFIC INFORMATION  
For your particular global region, your vehicle may be equipped with  
features and options that are different from the features and options that  
are described in this Owner’s Guide. A market unique supplement may  
be supplied that complements this book. By referring to the market  
unique supplement, if provided, you can properly identify those features,  
recommendations and specifications that are unique to your vehicle. This  
Owner’s Guide is written primarily for the U.S. and Canadian Markets.  
Features or equipment listed as standard may be different on units built  
for Export. Refer to this Owner’s Guide for all other required  
information and warnings.  
11  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
These are some of the symbols you may see on your vehicle.  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Safety Alert  
See Owner’s Guide  
Airbag - Front  
Fasten Safety Belt  
Airbag - Side  
Child Seat Lower  
Anchor  
Child Seat Tether  
Anchor  
Brake System  
Anti-Lock Brake System  
Parking Brake System  
Brake Fluid -  
Non-Petroleum Based  
Parking Aid System  
Speed Control  
Stability Control System  
Master Lighting Switch  
Fog Lamps-Front  
Hazard Warning Flasher  
Fuse Compartment  
Windshield Wash/Wipe  
Fuel Pump Reset  
Windshield  
Rear Window  
Defrost/Demist  
Defrost/Demist  
12  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Power Window Lockout  
Interior Luggage  
Power Windows  
Front/Rear  
Child Safety Door  
Lock/Unlock  
Compartment Release  
Panic Alarm  
Engine Oil  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature  
Engine Coolant  
Do Not Open When Hot  
Battery  
Avoid Smoking, Flames,  
or Sparks  
Battery Acid  
Fan Warning  
Explosive Gas  
MAX  
MIN  
Maintain Correct Fluid  
Level  
Power Steering Fluid  
Service Engine Soon  
Engine Air Filter  
Jack  
Passenger Compartment  
Air Filter  
Low Tire Pressure  
Warning  
Check Fuel Cap  
13  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING LIGHTS AND CHIMES  
Automatic transmission cluster shown, manual similar  
Harley-Davidson vehicles  
Warning lights and gauges can alert you to a vehicle condition that may  
become serious enough to cause expensive repairs. A warning light may  
illuminate when a problem exists with one of your vehicle’s functions.  
Many lights will illuminate when you start your vehicle to make sure the  
14  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
bulbs work. If any light remains on after starting the vehicle, refer to the  
respective system warning light description for additional information.  
Note: Some warning lights are  
reconfigurable telltale (RTT)  
indicator lights and will illuminate in  
the message center. These lights  
function the same as the other  
warning lights.  
Service engine soon: The Service  
engine soon indicator light  
illuminates when the ignition is first  
turned to the on position to check  
the bulb and to indicate whether the vehicle is ready for  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing. Normally, the “Service engine  
soon” light will stay on until the engine is cranked, then turn itself off if  
no malfunctions are present. However, if after 15 seconds the “Service  
engine soon” light blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not  
ready for I/M testing. See the Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance  
(I/M) testing in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Solid illumination after the engine is started indicates the On Board  
Diagnostics System (OBD-II) has detected a malfunction. Refer to On  
board diagnostics (OBD-II) in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. If the light is blinking, engine misfire is occurring which could  
damage your catalytic converter. Drive in a moderate fashion (avoid  
heavy acceleration and deceleration) and have your vehicle serviced  
immediately by your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Under engine misfire conditions, excessive exhaust  
temperatures could damage the catalytic converter, the fuel  
system, interior floor coverings or other vehicle components, possibly  
causing a fire.  
15  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Brake system warning light: To  
confirm the brake system warning  
light is functional, it will  
momentarily illuminate when the  
ignition is turned to the on position  
!
P
BRAKE  
when the engine is not running, or in a position between on and start, or  
by applying the parking brake when the ignition is turned to the on  
position. If the brake system warning light does not illuminate at this  
time, seek service immediately from your authorized dealer. Illumination  
after releasing the parking brake indicates low brake fluid level and the  
brake system should be inspected immediately by your servicing  
authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Driving a vehicle with the brake system warning  
light on is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking  
performance may occur. It will take you longer to stop the vehicle.  
Have the vehicle checked by your authorized dealer immediately.  
Driving extended distances with the parking brake engaged can cause  
brake failure and the risk of personal injury.  
Anti-lock brake system: If the  
ABS light stays illuminated or  
ABS  
continues to flash, a malfunction has  
been detected, have the system  
serviced immediately by your  
authorized dealer. Normal braking is still functional unless the brake  
warning light also is illuminated.  
Airbag readiness: If this light fails  
to illuminate when ignition is turned  
to on, continues to flash or remains  
on, have the system serviced  
immediately by your authorized dealer. A chime will sound when there is  
a malfunction in the indicator light.  
Safety belt: Reminds you to fasten  
your safety belt. A Belt-Minder௡  
chime will also sound to remind you  
to fasten your safety belt. Refer to  
the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter to activate/deactivate the Belt-Minderchime feature.  
16  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Engine oil pressure: Illuminates  
when the oil pressure falls below the  
normal range. Refer to Engine oil  
in the Maintenance and  
Specifications chapter.  
Low tire pressure warning (if  
equipped): Illuminates when your  
tire pressure is low. If the light  
remains on at start up or while  
driving, the tire pressure should be  
checked. Refer to Inflating your tires in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter. When the ignition is first turned to on, the light will  
illuminate for three seconds to ensure the bulb is working. If the light  
does not turn on, have the system inspected by your authorized dealer.  
For more information on this system, refer to Understanding your tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter.  
Charging system: Illuminates when  
the battery is not charging properly.  
If it stays on while the engine is  
running, there may be a malfunction  
with the charging system. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible. This indicates a problem with the electrical system or a related  
component.  
Powertrain malfunction/Reduced  
power/Electronic throttle  
control (RTT): Displays when the  
engine has defaulted to a  
“limp-home” operation or when a transmission problem has been  
detected and shifting may be restricted. If the light remains on, have the  
system serviced immediately by your authorized dealer.  
Traction control (RTT) (if  
equipped): Displays when the  
traction control system is active. If  
the light remains on, have the  
system serviced immediately by  
your authorized dealer. Refer to Traction control in the Driving chapter  
for more information  
17  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Check fuel cap (RTT): Displays  
when the fuel cap may not be  
properly installed. Continued driving  
with this light on may cause the  
Service engine soon warning light to  
come on. Refer to Fuel filler cap in  
the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Engine coolant temperature  
(RTT): Displays when the engine  
coolant temperature is high. Stop  
the vehicle as soon as safely possible, switch off the engine and let it  
cool. Refer to Engine coolant in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
Low fuel (RTT): Displays when  
the fuel level in the fuel tank is at  
or near empty (refer to Fuel gauge  
in this chapter).  
Door ajar (RTT): Displays when  
the ignition is in the on position and  
any door is open.  
Transmission Tow/Haul Feature  
(automatic transmission) (if  
equipped): The Tow Haul light  
remains illuminated as long as the  
Tow/Haul feature is activated. Refer to the Driving chapter for  
transmission function and operation. If the light remains illuminated and  
will not cancel using the Tow/Haul switch located on the end of the gear  
shift lever, have the system serviced immediately or damage to the  
transmission could occur.  
18  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Four wheel drive low (if  
equipped): Illuminates when  
four-wheel drive low is engaged.  
4x4  
LOW  
Four wheel drive high (if  
equipped): Illuminates when  
four-wheel drive high is engaged.  
4x4  
HIGH  
Anti-theft system: Flashes when  
the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft  
System has been activated.  
Speed control (if equipped):  
Illuminates when the speed control  
is activated. Turns off when the  
speed control system is deactivated.  
Turn signal: Illuminates when the  
left or right turn signal or the  
hazard lights are turned on. If the  
indicators stay on or flash faster, check for a burned out bulb.  
High beams: Illuminates when the  
high beam headlamps are turned on.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a diesel engine, it has some unique  
warning lights; refer to Instrument Cluster in your Power Stroke 6.0  
and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide  
Supplement for detailed information on their function.  
Diesel warning lights:  
Glow plug pre-heat  
Water in fuel  
Low oil pressure  
19  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Key-in-ignition warning chime: Sounds when the key is left in the  
ignition in the off or accessory position and the driver’s door is opened.  
Headlamps on warning chime: Sounds when the headlamps or parking  
lamps are on, the ignition is off (the key is not in the ignition) and the  
driver’s door is opened.  
Parking brake on warning chime: Sounds when the parking brake is  
set, the engine is running and the vehicle is driven more than 3 mph  
(5 km). If the warning remains on after the parking brake is off, contact  
your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
Turn signal chime: Sounds when the turn signal lever has been  
activated to signal a turn and not turned off after the vehicle is driven  
more than 2 miles (3.2 km).  
Message center activation chime: Sounds when some warning  
messages appears in the message center display for the first time.  
Overspeed chime (if equipped): Sounds when the vehicle speed  
reaches 75 mph (120 km/h) or higher.  
Airbag secondary warning chime: Sounds to inform the driver, in the  
event that the airbag readiness warning lamp is inoperable, that there is  
a fault in the supplemental restraint system.  
20  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
GAUGES  
Speedometer: Indicates the current vehicle speed.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Harley-Davidson instrument  
cluster  
21  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Engine coolant temperature  
gauge: Indicates engine coolant  
temperature. At normal operating  
temperature, the needle will be in  
the normal range (between “H” and  
“C”). If it enters the red section,  
the engine is overheating. Stop  
the vehicle as soon as safely  
possible, switch off the engine and let the engine cool.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
Odometer: Registers the total miles  
(kilometers) of the vehicle. Refer to  
Standard message center or  
Optional message center in this  
chapter on how to switch the  
display from Metric to English.  
Trip odometer: Registers the miles (kilometers) of individual journeys.  
With standard message center:  
Press the SELECT/RESET stem  
once to switch from the odometer to  
the trip odometer. Press the stem  
again to select Trip A and Trip B  
features. To reset the trip, press and  
hold the stem until it resets.  
With optional message center:  
See TRIP A/B under Optional message center in this chapter.  
22  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Tachometer: Indicates the engine speed in revolutions per minute.  
Driving with your tachometer pointer continuously at the top of the scale  
may damage the engine.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Harley-Davidson instrument  
cluster  
Engine oil pressure gauge:  
Indicates engine oil pressure. The  
needle should stay in the normal  
operating range (between “L” and  
“H”). If the needle falls below the  
normal range, stop the vehicle, turn  
off the engine and check the engine  
oil level. Add oil if needed. If the oil  
level is correct, have your vehicle checked at your authorized dealer.  
23  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Fuel gauge: Indicates  
approximately how much fuel is left  
in the fuel tank (when the ignition  
is in the on position). The fuel  
gauge may vary slightly when the  
vehicle is in motion or on a grade.  
The FUEL icon and arrow indicates  
which side of the vehicle the fuel  
filler door is located.  
Refer to Filling the tank in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter for more information.  
Battery voltage gauge (manual  
transmission only): Indicates the  
battery voltage when the ignition is  
in the on position. If the pointer  
moves and stays outside the normal  
operating range, have the vehicle’s  
electrical system checked as soon as  
possible.  
Transmission fluid temperature gauge (automatic transmission  
only): If the gauge is in the:  
Normal area– the transmission  
fluid is within the normal operating  
temperature (between “H” and “C”).  
Yellow area– the transmission fluid  
is higher than normal operating  
temperature. This can be caused by  
special operating conditions (i.e.  
snowplowing, towing or off road  
use). Refer to Special operating  
conditions in the scheduled  
maintenance information for  
instructions. Operating the transmission for extended periods of time  
with the gauge in the yellow area may cause internal transmission  
damage.  
24  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Altering the severity of the operating conditions is recommended to  
lower the transmission temperature into the normal range.  
Red area– the transmission fluid is  
overheating. Stop the vehicle to  
allow the temperature to return to  
normal range.  
If the gauge is operating in the Yellow or Red area, stop the vehicle and  
verify the airflow is not restricted such as snow or debris blocking airflow  
through the grill. If the gauge continues to show high temperatures, see  
your authorized dealer.  
STANDARD MESSAGE CENTER  
Your vehicle’s message center is capable of monitoring many vehicle systems  
and will alert you to potential vehicle problems and various conditions with  
an informational message followed by a long indicator chime.  
The message center display is located in the instrument cluster.  
Selectable features (information menu)  
Press and release the SELECT/RESET button, located in the speedometer,  
to scroll and reset the following functions. Select or reset the function by  
holding the SELECT/RESET button for more than 2 seconds.  
TRIP  
Registers the distance of individual journeys. Press and release the  
SELECT/RESET button on the cluster to toggle between odometer and  
trip odometer display. To reset, press and hold for less than two seconds.  
ENG HRS  
Registers the accumulated time the engine has been running.  
MILES (km) TO E  
This displays an estimate of approximately how far you can drive with  
the fuel remaining in your tank under normal driving conditions.  
Remember to turn the ignition off when refueling to allow this feature to  
correctly detect the added fuel.  
The DTE function will display LOW FUEL LEVEL when you have  
approximately 50 miles (80 km), to empty. Press RESET to clear this  
warning message. It will return at approximately 25 miles (40 km),  
10 miles (16 km) and 0 miles (0 km) to empty.  
25  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
DTE is calculated using a running average fuel economy, which is based  
on your recent driving history of 500 miles (800 km). This value is not  
the same as the average fuel economy display. The running average fuel  
economy is re-initialized to a factory default value if the battery is  
disconnected.  
XX.X MPG (L/100km)  
Average fuel economy displays your average fuel economy in miles/gallon  
or liters/100 km.  
If you calculate your average fuel economy by dividing distance traveled  
by gallons of fuel used (liters of fuel used by 100 kilometers traveled),  
your figure may be different than displayed for the following reasons:  
Your vehicle was not perfectly level during fill-up  
Differences in the automatic shut-off points on the fuel pumps at  
service stations  
Variations in top-off procedure from one fill-up to another  
Rounding of the displayed values to the nearest 0.1 gallon (liter)  
1. Drive the vehicle at least 5 miles (8 km) with the speed control  
system engaged to display a stabilized average.  
2. Record the highway fuel economy for future reference.  
It is important to press the SELECT/RESET button (press and hold the  
SELECT/RESET button for two seconds in order to reset the function)  
after setting the speed control to get accurate highway fuel economy  
readings.  
Setup menu (vehicle customization and vehicle system check)  
HOLD RESET FOR SETUP MENU  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button to get into the setup menu  
sequence for the following displays:  
Note: When returning to the setup menu and a non-English language  
has been selected, HOLD RESET FOR ENGLISH will be displayed to  
change back to English. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button to  
change back to English.  
OIL LIFE  
This displays the remaining oil life.  
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center and  
according to the recommended maintenance schedule. USE ONLY  
RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.  
26  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change  
(approximately 7,500 miles [12,000 km] or 12 months) perform the  
following:  
1. Press and release the setup button to display “OIL LIFE XXX% HOLD  
RESET = NEW”.  
2. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem for two seconds and release  
to reset the oil life to 100%.  
Note: To change oil life 100% miles value from 7,500 miles (12,000 km)  
or 12 months to another value, proceed to Step 3.  
3. Once “OIL LIFE SET TO XXX%” is displayed, release and press the  
SELECT/RESET stem to change the Oil Life Start Value. Each release  
and press will reduce the value by 10%.  
Note: Oil life start value of 100% equals 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or  
12 months. For example, setting oil life start value to 60% sets the oil  
life start value to 4,500 miles (7,200 km) and 219 days.  
UNITS  
Displays the current units English or Metric.  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button to change from English to  
Metric.  
Press the SELECT/RESET button for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
LANGUAGE = ENGLISH / SPANISH / FRENCH  
Allows you to choose which language the message center will display in.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish, or French.  
Note: When entering the setup menu and a non-English language has  
been selected, “PRESS RESET FOR ENGLISH” will be displayed to  
change back to English.  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button to select a new language.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish and French  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button for two seconds to set the  
language choice.  
Press the SELECT/RESET button for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
27  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET button to select SYSTEM CHECK  
when HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK is displayed in the message  
center. For each of the monitored systems, the message center will  
indicate either an OK message or a warning message for two seconds.  
Pressing the SELECT/RESET button cycles the message center through  
each of the systems being monitored.  
The sequence of the system check report and how it appears in the  
message center is as follows:  
1. XXX% OIL LIFE  
2. ENGINE HOURS  
3. ENGINE IDLE HOURS (Diesel engine only)  
4. CHARGING SYSTEM  
5. DOOR AJAR  
6. BRAKE SYSTEM  
7. TBC GAIN = XX.X  
NO TRAILER (if equipped and no trailer connected)  
8. TBC GAIN = XX.X  
OUTPUT = ////// (if equipped and trailer connected)  
9. XX MILES TO E FUEL LEVEL XXX  
System warnings  
System warnings alert you to possible problems or malfunctions in your  
vehicle’s operating systems.  
In the event of a multiple warning situation, the message center will  
cycle the display to show all warnings by displaying each one for four  
seconds.  
The message center will display the last selected feature if there are no  
more warning messages.  
Types of messages and warnings:  
Some messages will appear briefly to inform you of something you  
may need to take action on or be informed of.  
Some messages will appear once and then again when the vehicle is  
restarted.  
28  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Some messages will reappear after clearing or being reset if a problem  
or condition is still present and needs your attention.  
Some messages can be acknowledged and reset by pressing the  
SELECT/RESET button. This allows you to use the full message  
center functionality by clearing the message.  
PARK BRAKE ENGAGED — Displayed when the parking brake is  
applied (or not fully released).  
CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM — Displayed when a fault has been detected  
by the ABS module.  
DRIVER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the driver’s door is not  
completely closed.  
PASSENGER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the passenger’s door is  
not completely closed.  
REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear left door is not  
completely closed.  
REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear right door is  
not completely closed.  
XXX MILES TO E FUEL LEVEL LOW — Displayed as an early  
reminder of a low fuel condition.  
WIRING FAULT ON TRAILER (if equipped) — Displayed if there  
are certain faults in the vehicle wiring and trailer wiring/brake system.  
Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for  
more information.  
TRAILER BRAKE MODULE FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime, in response to faults sensed by the TBC.  
Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for  
more information.  
TRAILER DISCONNECTED (if equipped) — Displayed when a  
trailer connection becomes disconnected, either intentionally or  
unintentionally, and has been sensed during a given ignition cycle. Refer  
to Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for more  
information.  
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the brake fluid level is low  
and the brake system should be inspected immediately. Refer to Brake  
fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
29  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped) — Displayed when one or more  
tires on your vehicle have low tire pressure. Refer to Inflating your  
tires in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed  
when the Tire Pressure Monitoring System is malfunctioning. If the  
warning stays on or continues to come on, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed when  
a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use. For  
more information on how the system operates under these conditions,  
refer to Understanding Your Tire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. If the warning stays  
on or continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
ENGINE WARMING PLEASE WAIT XX (Diesel engine only) —  
Displayed in extremely cold weather, typically below –15°F (–26°C), if  
the engine block heater is not utilized. The engine will not respond to  
accelerator pedal movement for 30 seconds; this is done so the engine oil  
can be properly circulated to avoid engine damage from lack of  
lubrication. A timer will begin a countdown from 30 seconds. Once the  
counter has reached 0 (Zero) seconds, OK TO DRIVE will be displayed  
and the engine will respond to accelerator pedal movement. Refer to  
your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement for more information.  
OK TO DRIVE (Diesel engine only) — Displayed when the time  
counter has reached 0 (zero) and the engine is sufficiently warm enough  
to drive in extremely cold weather (refer to the engine warming please  
wait message description mentioned previously). Refer to your Power  
Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide  
Supplement for more information.  
DRAIN WATER SEPARATOR (Diesel engine only) — Displayed  
when the water separator has reached a predetermined capacity and  
needs to be drained. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
30  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
ENGINE TURNS OFF IN XX (Diesel engine only) — Displayed  
when the vehicle is in the final 30 seconds of a countdown to where the  
engine will intentionally be turned off by the PCM. The diesel engine  
shutdown is a (regulatory) requirement which may be required of a  
particular diesel vehicle for sale in states requiring this feature. Refer to  
your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement for more information.  
ENGINE TURNED OFF (Diesel engine only) — Displayed after the  
30 second countdown. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
DRIVE TO CLEAN EXHAUST FILTER (Diesel engine only) —  
Displayed when the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) is full of particles  
(exhaust soot) and the vehicle is not being operated in a manner to  
allow normal cleaning. This message will stay on until the exhaust filter  
cleaning has begun, at which time the CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER  
message will be displayed. It is recommended the vehicle operator drive  
the vehicle above 30 mph (48 km/h) until the CLEANING EXHAUST  
FILTER message turns off. This message is NORMAL. Refer to your  
Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s  
Guide Supplement for more information.  
Note: If this message is ignored, your vehicle will continue to fill the  
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) with particles (exhaust soot). If cleaning  
is not permitted, the  
limited. If the vehicle is still not operated in a manner to allow cleaning,  
the service engine soon light will illuminate and engine power will  
light will illuminate and engine power may be  
be further limited. Dealer service will then be required to restore your  
vehicle to full-power operation.  
Note: Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) regeneration will not initiate at idle  
or in Power-Take-Off (PTO) mode. When DRIVE TO CLEAN EXHAUST  
FILTER is displayed in the message center, PTO and/or Stationary  
Elevated Idle Control (SEIC) must be disengaged/inactive in order to  
properly clean the DPF. The vehicle must be driven until the CLEANING  
EXHAUST FILTER message turns off.  
31  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER (Diesel engine only) — Displayed  
when the vehicle has entered the cleaning mode. Various engine actions  
will raise the exhaust temperature in the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)  
system to burn off the particles (exhaust soot). After the particles are  
burned off, the exhaust temperature will fall back to normal levels. This  
message is NORMAL. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
WARNING: When the CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER message  
appears in the message center, do not park near flammable  
materials, vapors or structures until filter cleaning is complete.  
EXHAUST FILTER DRIVE COMPLETE (Diesel engine only) —  
Displayed when the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) has been adequately  
cleaned after the DRIVE TO CLEAN EXHAUST FILTER followed by  
CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER messages have been displayed. This  
message is NORMAL. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
STOP SAFELY NOW (Diesel engine only) — Displayed and a chime  
sounds when the vehicle exhaust system temperature exceeds intended  
operating range. If this warning occurs, engine power is reduced and the  
engine will shut down when the vehicle speed is below 3 mph (5 km/h).  
Stop the vehicle as soon as safely possible and contact your  
authorized dealer. Depending on the severity of the over-temperature  
condition, the vehicle may not restart after cycling the ignition off. If the  
vehicle restarts, there may be limited power. If the exhaust  
over-temperature condition reoccurs, the message center will display  
STOP SAFELY NOW, the chime will sound, and engine power will be  
reduced again and shut down below 3 mph (5km/h). Refer to your  
Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s  
Guide Supplement for more information.  
OIL LIFE CHANGE SOON (Gas engine only) — Displayed when the  
engine oil life remaining is 5% or less.  
OIL CHANGE REQUIRED (Gas engine only) — Displayed when the  
oil life left reaches 0%. OIL LIFE OK displays after you have changed the  
oil.  
32  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
OPTIONAL MESSAGE CENTER (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle’s message center is capable of monitoring many vehicle  
systems and will alert you to potential vehicle problems and various  
conditions with an informational message followed by a long indicator  
chime.  
The message center display is located in the instrument cluster.  
Selectable features  
Info (information menu)  
Press the INFO button repeatedly to  
cycle through the following features:  
RESET  
SETUP  
INFO  
TRIP A/B  
Registers the distance of individual journeys. Press and release the INFO  
button until the TRIP A/B appear in the display (this represents the trip  
mode). Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds to reset.  
Refer to UNITS later in this section to switch the display from Metric to  
English.  
ENG HRS  
Registers the accumulated time the engine has been running.  
MILES (km) TO E  
This displays an estimate of approximately how far you can drive with  
the fuel remaining in your tank under normal driving conditions.  
Remember to turn the ignition off when refueling to allow this feature to  
correctly detect the added fuel.  
The DTE function will display LOW FUEL LEVEL when you have  
approximately 50 miles (80 km), to empty. Press RESET to clear this  
warning message. It will return at approximately 25 miles (40 km),  
10 miles (16 km) and 0 miles (0 km) miles to empty.  
33  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
DTE is calculated using a running average fuel economy, which is based  
on your recent driving history of 500 miles (800 km). This value is not  
the same as the average fuel economy display. The running average fuel  
economy is re-initialized to a factory default value if the battery is  
disconnected.  
XX.X MPG (L/100km)  
Average fuel economy displays your average fuel economy in miles/gallon  
or liters/100 km.  
If you calculate your average fuel economy by dividing distance traveled  
by gallons of fuel used (liters of fuel used by 100 kilometers traveled),  
your figure may be different than displayed for the following reasons:  
Your vehicle was not perfectly level during fill-up  
Differences in the automatic shut-off points on the fuel pumps at  
service stations  
Variations in top-off procedure from one fill-up to another  
Rounding of the displayed values to the nearest 0.1 gallon (liter)  
1. Drive the vehicle at least 5 miles (8 km) with the speed control  
system engaged to display a stabilized average.  
2. Record the highway fuel economy for future reference.  
It is important to press the RESET button (press and hold RESET for  
two seconds in order to reset the function) after setting the speed  
control to get accurate highway fuel economy readings.  
TIMER  
Timer displays the trip elapsed drive time.  
To operate, do the following:  
1. Press and release RESET in order to start the timer.  
2. Press and release RESET to pause the timer.  
3. Press and hold RESET until the timer resets.  
34  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
System check and vehicle feature customization  
Press the SETUP button repeatedly  
to cycle the message center through  
the following features:  
RESET  
SETUP  
INFO  
Note: When returning to the SETUP menu and a non-English language  
has been selected, HOLD RESET FOR ENGLISH will be displayed to  
change back to English. Press and hold the RESET button to change  
back to English.  
RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK  
When this message appears, press the RESET button and the message  
center will begin to cycle through the following systems and provide a  
status of the item if needed.  
1. OIL LIFE (Gas engine only)  
2. ENGINE HOURS  
3. ENGINE IDLE HOURS (Diesel engine only)  
4. CHARGING SYSTEM  
5. DOOR AJAR  
6. BRAKE SYSTEM  
7. TBC GAIN = XX.X  
NO TRAILER (if equipped and no trailer connected)  
8. TBC GAIN = XX.X  
OUTPUT = ////// (if equipped and trailer connected)  
9. FUEL LEVEL  
Note: Some systems show a message only if a condition is present.  
OIL LIFE  
This displays the remaining oil life.  
An oil change is required whenever indicated by the message center and  
according to the recommended maintenance schedule. USE ONLY  
RECOMMENDED ENGINE OILS.  
35  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change  
(approximately 7,500 miles [12,000 km] or 12 months) perform the  
following:  
1. Press and release the SETUP button to display “OIL LIFE XXX%  
HOLD RESET = NEW”.  
2. Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds and release to reset  
the oil life to 100%.  
Note: To change oil life 100% miles value from 7,500 miles (12,000 km)  
or 12 months to another value, proceed to Step 3.  
3. Once “OIL LIFE SET TO XXX%” is displayed, release and press the  
RESET button to change the Oil Life Start Value. Each release and press  
will reduce the value by 10%.  
Note: Oil life start value of 100% equals 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or  
12 months. For example, setting oil life start value to 60% sets the oil  
life start value to 4,500 miles (7,200 km) and 219 days.  
UNITS  
Displays the current units English or Metric.  
Press the RESET button to change from English to Metric.  
AUTOLAMP (SEC)  
This feature keeps your headlights on for up to three minutes after the  
ignition is switched off.  
Press the RESET control to select the new Autolamp delay values of 0,  
10, 20, 30, 60, 90, 120 or 180 seconds.  
AUTOLOCK  
This feature automatically locks all vehicle doors when the vehicle is  
shifted into any gear, putting the vehicle in motion.  
Press the RESET control to turn autolock on or off.  
ZONE <XX> RESET = CHANGE  
The compass heading is displayed as one of N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W and  
NW in the message center display.  
The compass reading may be affected when you drive near large  
buildings, bridges, power lines and powerful broadcast antenna. Magnetic  
or metallic objects placed in, on or near the vehicle may also affect  
compass accuracy.  
36  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Usually, when something affects the compass readings, the compass will  
correct itself after a few days of operating your vehicle in normal  
conditions. If the compass still appears to be inaccurate, a manual  
calibration may be necessary. Refer to Compass zone/calibration  
adjustment.  
Most geographic areas (zones) have a magnetic north compass point that  
varies slightly from the northerly direction on maps. This variation is four  
degrees between adjacent zones and will become noticeable as the  
vehicle crosses multiple zones. A correct zone setting will eliminate this  
error. Do the following to set the proper zone:  
Compass zone/calibration adjustment  
1. Determine your magnetic zone by  
referring to the zone map.  
3 2  
4
1
15  
2. Turn ignition to the on position.  
3. Start the engine.  
14  
13  
5
12  
6
7 8 91011  
4. From the SETUP menu, press and release the RESET button until the  
message center display changes to show the current zone setting ZONE  
<XX> RESET = CHANGE.  
5. Press and release the RESET button repeatedly until the correct zone  
setting for your geographic location is displayed on the message center.  
The range of zone values are from 1 to 15 and “wraps” back to 1.  
6. To exit the zone setting mode, and to “lock in” your change:  
press and release the SETUP button or,  
press INFO button to exit or,  
wait four seconds and the zone will be “locked in”.  
Perform compass calibration in an open area free from steel structures  
and high voltage lines. For optimum calibration, turn off all electrical  
accessories (heater/air conditioning, wipers, etc.) and make sure all  
vehicle doors are shut.  
7. Press the RESET button until the display reads RESET FOR  
CALIBRATION to start the compass calibration function.  
37  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
8. Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle (less than 3 mph [5 km/h]) until  
the CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE display changes to CALIBRATION  
COMPLETED. It will take up to five circles to complete calibration.  
9. The compass is now calibrated.  
Note: If the RESET button is pressed or three minutes has expired, the  
display will go back to the INFO menu and will show CAL instead of the  
compass heading until the compass is calibrated.  
LANGUAGE = ENGLISH / SPANISH / FRENCH  
Allows you to choose which language the message center will display in.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish, or French.  
Waiting four seconds or pressing the RESET button cycles the message  
center through each of the language choices.  
Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds to set the language  
choice.  
System warnings  
System warnings alert you to possible problems or malfunctions in your  
vehicle’s operating systems.  
In the event of a multiple warning situation, the message center will  
cycle the display to show all warnings by displaying each one for four  
seconds.  
The message center will display the last selected feature if there are no  
more warning messages.  
Types of messages and warnings:  
Some messages will appear briefly to inform you of something you  
may need to take action on or be informed of.  
Some messages will appear once and then again when the vehicle is  
restarted.  
Some messages will reappear after clearing or being reset if a problem  
or condition is still present and needs your attention.  
Some messages can be acknowledged and reset by pressing RESET.  
This allows you to use the full message center functionality by clearing  
the message.  
PARK BRAKE ENGAGED — Displayed when the parking brake is  
applied (or not fully released).  
CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM — Displayed when a fault has been detected  
by the ABS module.  
38  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
DRIVER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the driver’s door is not  
completely closed.  
PASSENGER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the passenger’s door is  
not completely closed.  
REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear left door is not  
completely closed.  
REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear right door is  
not completely closed.  
FUEL LEVEL LOW — Displayed as an early reminder of a low fuel  
condition.  
WIRING FAULT ON TRAILER (if equipped) — Displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime if there are certain faults in the vehicle  
wiring and trailer wiring/brake system. Refer to Trailer towing in the  
Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for more information.  
TRAILER BRAKE MODULE FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime in response to faults sensed by the TBC.  
Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for  
more information.  
TRAILER CONNECTED (if equipped) — Displayed when a correct  
trailer connection (a trailer with electric trailer brakes) is sensed during  
a given ignition cycle. Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter for more information.  
TRAILER DISCONNECTED (if equipped) — Displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime when a trailer connection becomes  
disconnected, either intentionally or unintentionally, and has been sensed  
during a given ignition cycle. Refer to Trailer towing in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter for more information.  
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the brake fluid level is low  
and the brake system should be inspected immediately. Refer to Brake  
fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
LOW TIRE PRESSURE (if equipped) — Displayed when one or more  
tires on your vehicle have low tire pressure. Refer to Inflating your  
tires in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed  
when the Tire Pressure Monitoring System is malfunctioning. If the  
warning stays on or continues to come on, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
39  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT (if equipped) — Displayed when  
a tire pressure sensor is malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use. For  
more information on how the system operates under these conditions,  
refer to Understanding Your Tire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. If the warning stays  
on or continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
ENGINE WARMING PLEASE WAIT XX (Diesel engine only) —  
Displayed in extremely cold weather, typically below –15°F (–26°C), if  
the engine block heater is not utilized. The engine will not respond to  
accelerator pedal movement for 30 seconds; this is done so the engine oil  
can be properly circulated to avoid engine damage from lack of  
lubrication. A timer will begin a countdown from 30 seconds. Once the  
counter has reached 0 (Zero) seconds, OK TO DRIVE will be displayed  
and the engine will respond to accelerator pedal movement. Refer to  
your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement for more information.  
OK TO DRIVE (Diesel engine only) — Displayed when the time  
counter has reached 0 (zero) and the engine is sufficiently warm enough  
to drive in extremely cold weather (refer to the engine warming please  
wait message description mentioned previously). Refer to your Power  
Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide  
Supplement for more information.  
DRAIN WATER SEPARATOR (Diesel engine only) — Displayed  
when the water separator has reached a predetermined capacity and  
needs to be drained. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
ENGINE TURNS OFF IN XX (Diesel engine only) — Displayed  
when the vehicle is in the final 30 seconds of a countdown to where the  
engine will intentionally be turned off by the PCM. The diesel engine  
shutdown is a (regulatory) requirement which may be required of a  
particular diesel vehicle for sale in states requiring this feature. Refer to  
your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement for more information.  
ENGINE TURNED OFF (Diesel engine only) — Displayed after the  
30 second countdown. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
40  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
DRIVE TO CLEAN EXHAUST FILTER (Diesel engine only) —  
Displayed when the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) is full of particles  
(exhaust soot) and the vehicle is not being operated in a manner to  
allow normal cleaning. This message will stay on until the exhaust filter  
cleaning has begun, at which time the CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER  
message will be displayed. It is recommended the vehicle operator drive  
the vehicle above 30 mph (48 km/h) until the CLEANING EXHAUST  
FILTER message turns off. This message is NORMAL. Refer to your  
Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s  
Guide Supplement for more information.  
Note: If this message is ignored, your vehicle will continue to fill the  
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) with particles (exhaust soot). If cleaning  
is not permitted, the  
limited. If the vehicle is still not operated in a manner to allow cleaning,  
the service engine soon light will illuminate and engine power will  
light will illuminate and engine power may be  
be further limited. Dealer service will then be required to restore your  
vehicle to full-power operation.  
Note: Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) regeneration will not initiate at idle  
or in Power-Take-Off (PTO) mode. When DRIVE TO CLEAN EXHAUST  
FILTER is displayed in the message center, PTO and/or Stationary  
Elevated Idle Control (SEIC) must be disengaged/inactive in order to  
properly clean the DPF. The vehicle must be driven until the CLEANING  
EXHAUST FILTER message turns off.  
CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER (Diesel engine only) — Displayed  
when the vehicle has entered the cleaning mode. Various engine actions  
will raise the exhaust temperature in the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)  
system to burn off the particles (exhaust soot). After the particles are  
burned off, the exhaust temperature will fall back to normal levels. This  
message is NORMAL. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
WARNING: When the CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER message  
appears in the message center, do not park near flammable  
materials, vapors or structures until filter cleaning is complete.  
41  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
EXHAUST FILTER DRIVE COMPLETE (Diesel engine only) —  
Displayed when the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) has been adequately  
cleaned after the DRIVE TO CLEAN EXHAUST FILTER followed by  
CLEANING EXHAUST FILTER messages have been displayed. This  
message is NORMAL. Refer to your Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for more  
information.  
STOP SAFELY NOW (Diesel engine only) — Displayed and a chime  
sounds when the vehicle exhaust system temperature exceeds intended  
operating range. If this warning occurs, engine power is reduced and the  
engine will shut down when the vehicle speed is below 3 mph (5 km/h).  
Stop the vehicle as soon as safely possible and contact your  
authorized dealer. Depending on the severity of the over-temperature  
condition, the vehicle may not restart after cycling the ignition off. If the  
vehicle restarts, there may be limited power. If the exhaust  
over-temperature condition reoccurs, the message center will display  
STOP SAFELY NOW, the chime will sound, and engine power will be  
reduced again and shut down below 3 mph (5km/h). Refer to your  
Power Stroke 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s  
Guide Supplement for more information.  
OIL LIFE CHANGE SOON (Gas engine only) — Displayed when the  
engine oil life remaining is 5% or less.  
OIL CHANGE REQUIRED (Gas engine only) — Displayed when the  
oil life left reaches 0%. OIL LIFE OK displays after you have changed the  
oil.  
42  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
AUDIO SYSTEMS  
AM/FM stereo system (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
The AM/FM stereo system does not contain rear speakers; only front  
driver side and passenger side speakers.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay. With  
this feature, the window switches and radio may be used for up to ten  
minutes after the ignition is turned off or until either front door is  
opened.  
1.  
/
(Tuner): Press to  
manually go up or down the radio  
frequency. Press and hold for a fast  
advance through radio frequencies.  
Also use in AUDIO mode to gain  
access to various settings.  
43  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
2. AUDIO: Press AUDIO repeatedly  
to gain access to the following  
settings:  
TREB (Treble): Press AUDIO to reach the treble setting.  
Use  
BASS (Bass): Press AUDIO to reach the bass setting.  
Use SEEK  
BAL (Balance): Press AUDIO to reach the balance setting.  
Use SEEK to adjust between the left and right  
speakers.  
Setting the clock: Press and hold CLK until the hours start to flash,  
then use SEEK to adjust. To adjust minutes, press CLK  
again to make the minutes start to flash and use SEEK  
to adjust. Press CLK again to exit the clock setting mode.  
3. SEEK: Press SEEK to  
/
/
SEEK  
.
/
/
.
/
/
/
/
/
/
access the previous/next strong  
station.  
4. Memory presets: To set a  
station: Select frequency band  
AM/FM1/FM2; tune to a station,  
press and hold a preset button until sound returns. You may store up to  
six stations in each frequency band for a total of 18.  
5. AM/FM: Press AM/FM to select  
AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
6. ON/OFF/Volume: Press VOL -  
PUSH to turn ON/OFF. Turn VOL -  
PUSH to increase/decrease volume.  
44  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
7. CLK (Clock): Press CLK to  
toggle between the clock and radio  
frequency.  
AM/FM stereo single CD/satellite compatible sound system  
(if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay which  
allows you to operate the window switches and the audio for up to ten  
minutes after the ignition has been turned off or until either front door is  
opened.  
1.  
/
: Press  
/
to  
manually go up or down the radio  
frequency. Press and hold for a fast  
advance through radio frequencies.  
45  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
/
to tune to the  
next/previous channel.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
2.  
(Phone): If your vehicle is  
equipped with SYNC, press to  
access SYNC PHONE features. For  
further information, please refer to supplemental information on SYNC௡  
included with your vehicle.  
If your vehicle is not equipped with SYNC, the display will read NO  
PHONE.  
3. MENU: Press MENU repeatedly  
to access to the following settings:  
Setting the clock: Press MENU until SET HOUR or SET MINUTES is  
displayed. Use  
hours/minutes.  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to adjust the  
SATELLITE RADIO MENU (if equipped): Press MENU when satellite  
radio mode is active to access. Press OK to enter into the satellite radio  
menu. Press  
/
to cycle through the following options:  
CATEGORY: Press OK to enter category mode. Press  
/
to  
scroll through the list of available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop,  
Rock, News, etc.) Press OK when the desired category appears in the  
display. After a category is selected, press SEEK to search for that  
specific category of channels only (i.e. ROCK). You may also select  
CATEGORY ALL to seek all available SIRIUS categories and channels.  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
SAVE SONG: Press OK to save the currently playing song title in the  
system’s memory. (If you try to save something other than a song,  
CANT SAVE will appear in the display.) When the chosen song is  
playing on any satellite radio channel, the system will alert you with  
an audible prompt. Press OK while SONG ALERT is in the display and  
the system will take you to the channel playing the desired song. You  
can save up to 20 song titles. If you attempt to save a song when the  
system is full, the display will read REPLACE SONG? Press OK to  
access the saved songs and press  
/
to cycle through the saved  
songs. When the song appears in the display that you would like to  
replace, press OK. SONG REPLACED will appear in the display.  
46  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
DELETE SONG: Press OK to delete a song title from the system’s  
memory. Press  
/
to cycle through the saved songs. When the  
song title appears in the display that you would like to delete, press  
OK. The song will appear in the display for confirmation. Press OK  
again and the display will read SONG DELETED. If you do not want  
to delete the currently listed song, press  
RETURN or CANCEL.  
/
to select either  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
DELETE ALL SONGS: Press OK to delete all songs from the  
system’s memory. The display will read ARE YOU SURE ? Press OK to  
confirm deletion of all saved songs and the display will read ALL  
DELETED.  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
ENABLE ALERTS / DISABLE ALERTS: Press OK to enable/disable  
the satellite alert status which alerts you when your selected songs are  
playing on a satellite radio channel. (The system default is disabled.)  
SONG ALERTS ENABLED/DISABLED will appear in the display. The  
menu listing will display the opposite state. For example, if you have  
chosen to enable the song alerts, the menu listing will read DISABLE  
as the alerts are currently on, so your other option is to turn them off.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
AUTOSET: Press MENU until the display reads AUTOSET. Autoset  
allows you to set the strongest local radio stations without losing your  
original manually set preset stations for AM/FM1/FM2.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to turn on/off.  
When the six strongest stations are filled, the station stored in preset 1  
will begin playing. If there are less than six strong stations, the system  
will store the last one in the remaining presets.  
BASS: Press MENU to reach the bass setting.  
Use  
TREB (Treble): Press MENU to reach the treble setting.  
Use SEEK, SEEK to adjust.  
BAL (Balance): Press MENU to reach the balance setting.  
Use SEEK, SEEK to adjust the audio between the left  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to adjust.  
/
/
/
/
(L) and right (R) speakers.  
47  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
FADE: Press MENU to reach the fade setting.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to adjust the audio between the back  
(B) and front (F) speakers.  
SPEEDVOL (Speed sensitive volume, if equipped): Press MENU to  
reach the SPEEDVOL setting. Radio volume automatically gets louder  
with increasing vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to adjust.  
The default setting is off; increasing your vehicle speed will not change  
the volume level.  
Adjust 1–7: Increasing this setting from 1 (lowest setting) to 7 (highest  
setting) allows the radio volume to automatically change slightly with  
vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Recommended level is 1–3; SPEED OFF turns the feature off and level 7  
is the maximum setting.  
Track/Folder mode: Available only on MP3 discs in CD mode. In Track  
mode, pressing  
disc  
SEEK, SEEK  
will scroll through all tracks on the  
In Folder mode, pressing  
SEEK, SEEK  
will scroll only through  
tracks within the selected folder.  
Press  
FOLDER, FOLDER  
to access the previous/next folder (if  
available).  
COMPRESS (Compression): Available only in CD/MP3 mode. Press  
MENU until COMPRESS ON/OFF appears in the display.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to toggle ON/OFF. When COMPRESS  
is ON, the system will bring the soft and loud CD passages together for a  
more consistent listening level.  
4. AUX: Press repeatedly to cycle  
through FES/DVD (if equipped),  
LINE IN (auxiliary audio mode, if  
equipped) and SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3 modes (satellite radio, if  
equipped).  
For location and further information on auxiliary audio mode, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack later in this chapter.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
48  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
5. SEEK: In radio mode,  
press to access the  
/
previous/next strong station.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press  
/
to access the previous/next CD/MP3 track.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to  
seek to the previous/next channel. If a specific category is selected,  
(Jazz, Rock, News, etc.), press SEEK, SEEK to seek to the  
previous/next channel in the selected category. Press and hold  
SEEK, SEEK  
to fast seek through the previous /next channels.  
SEEK, SEEK to view the  
In TEXT MODE, press  
previous/additional display text.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to select a category.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
6.  
/
OK (Play/Pause): This  
control is operational in CD/MP3  
mode. When a CD/MP3 is playing,  
press to pause or play the current CD/MP3. The CD/MP3 status will  
display in the radio display.  
OK: Use in various menu selections.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Family Entertainment System (FES)  
please refer to the Family entertainment DVD system section later in  
this chapter.  
7. SHUFFLE: In CD/MP3 mode,  
press SHUFFLE to engage shuffle  
mode. SHUFFLE ON will appear in  
the display. If you wish to engage shuffle mode right away, press SEEK  
to begin random play. Otherwise, random play will begin when the  
current track is finished playing. CD SHUF will appear in the display. To  
disengage, press SHUFFLE again. SHUFFLE OFF will appear in the  
display.  
Note: In CD/MP3 mode, press SHUFFLE to play the tracks in random  
order. In MP3 folder mode, the system will randomly play all tracks  
within the current folder.  
49  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
8. FOLDER  
press FOLDER  
: In folder mode,  
to access next  
folder on MP3 discs, if available.  
9.  
FOLDER: In folder mode,  
press  
FOLDER to access the  
previous folder on MP3 discs, if  
available.  
10. FF (Fast forward): Press FF  
to manually advance in a CD/MP3  
track.  
11. REW (Rewind): Press REW to  
manually reverse in a CD/MP3 track.  
12. Memory presets: To set a  
station: Select frequency band  
AM/FM1/FM2; tune to a station,  
press and hold a preset control until sound returns. You may store up to  
six stations in each frequency band for a total of 18.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), there are 18 available presets,  
six each for SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3. To save satellite channels in your  
memory presets, tune to the desired channel then press and hold a  
preset control until sound returns.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
13. TEXT/SCAN: In radio and  
CD/MP3 mode, press and hold for  
a brief sampling of radio stations or  
CD tracks. Press again to stop.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press and release to display track title, artist name,  
and disc title.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and release to enter  
TEXT MODE and display the current song title. While in TEXT MODE,  
press again to scroll through the current song title, artist, channel  
category and the SIRIUS long channel name.  
In TEXT MODE sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the “>” indicator is active, press SEEK  
to view the  
additional display text. When the “<” indicator is active, press  
to view the previous display text.  
SEEK  
50  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and hold to hear a brief  
sampling of the next channels. Press again to stop. In CATEGORY  
MODE, press SCAN to hear a brief sampling of the channels in the  
selected category. Press again to stop.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
14. AM/FM: Press AM/FM to select  
AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
15. ON/OFF/Volume: Press  
VOL-PUSH to turn on/off. Turn  
VOL-PUSH to increase/decrease  
volume.  
Note:If the volume is set above a  
certain level and the ignition is turned off, the volume will come back on  
at a “nominal” listening level when the ignition switch is turned back on.  
16. CD: Press to enter CD/MP3  
mode. If a CD is already loaded into  
the system, CD/MP3 play will begin  
where it ended last.  
17.  
(CD eject): Press to eject a  
CD.  
18. CD slot: Insert a CD label side  
up in the CD slot.  
51  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Premium/Premium plus in-dash six CD/MP3/satellite compatible  
sound system (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay which  
allows you to operate the window switches and audio for up to ten  
minutes after the ignition has turned off or until either front door has  
opened.  
1.  
In radio mode, press to manually  
go up ( ) or down ( ) the  
/
(Tune/Disc selector):  
radio frequency. Press and hold for  
a fast advance through radio frequencies.  
In menu mode, use to select various settings.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press to select the desired disc.  
52  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
2. (Phone): If your vehicle is  
equipped with SYNC, press to  
access SYNC PHONE features. For  
further information, please refer to supplemental information on SYNC௡  
included with your vehicle.  
If your vehicle is not equipped with SYNC, the display will read NO  
PHONE.  
3. MENU: Press repeatedly to  
access to the following settings:  
Setting the clock: Press until SELECT HOUR or SELECT MINS is  
displayed. Press  
/
/
SEEK  
to adjust the hours/minutes.  
SATELLITE RADIO MENU (if equipped): Press MENU when satellite  
radio mode is active to access. Press OK to enter into the satellite radio  
menu. Press  
/
to cycle through the following options:  
CATEGORY: Press OK to enter category mode. Press  
/
to  
scroll through the list of available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop,  
Rock, News, etc.) Press OK when the desired category appears in the  
display. After a category is selected, press SEEK to search for that  
specific category of channels only (i.e. ROCK). You may also select  
CATEGORY ALL to seek all available SIRIUS categories and channels.  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
SAVE SONG: Press OK to save the currently playing song title in the  
system’s memory. (If you try to save something other than a song,  
CANT SAVE will appear in the display.) When the chosen song is  
playing on any satellite radio channel, the system will alert you with  
an audible prompt. Press OK while SONG ALERT is in the display and  
the system will take you to the channel playing the desired song. You  
can save up to 20 song titles. If you attempt to save a song when the  
system is full, the display will read REPLACE SONG? Press OK to  
access the saved songs and press  
/
to cycle through the saved  
songs. When the song appears in the display that you would like to  
replace, press OK. SONG REPLACED will appear in the display.  
53  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
DELETE SONG: Press OK to delete a song from the system’s  
memory. Press  
/
to cycle through the saved songs. When the  
song appears in the display that you would like to delete, press OK.  
The song will appear in the display for confirmation. Press OK again  
and the display will read SONG DELETED. If you do not want to  
delete the currently listed song, press  
RETURN or CANCEL.  
/
to select either  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
DELETE ALL SONGS: Press OK to delete all songs from the  
system’s memory. The display will read ARE YOU SURE ? Press OK to  
confirm deletion of all saved songs and the display will read ALL  
DELETED.  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
ENABLE ALERTS / DISABLE ALERTS: Press OK to enable/disable  
the satellite alert status which alerts you when your selected songs are  
playing on a satellite radio channel. (The system default is disabled.)  
SONG ALERTS ENABLED/DISABLED will appear in the display. The  
menu listing will display the opposite state. For example, if you have  
chosen to enable the song alerts, the menu listing will read DISABLE  
as the alerts are currently on, so your other option is to turn them off.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
AUTOSET: Press MENU until the display reads AUTOSET. Autoset  
allows you to set the strongest local radio stations without losing your  
original manually set preset stations for AM/FM1/FM2. Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK to turn on/off.  
When the six strongest stations are filled, the station stored in preset 1  
will begin playing. If there are less than six strong stations, the system  
will store the last one in the remaining presets.  
RBDS: Available only in FM mode. This feature allows you to search  
RBDS-equipped stations for a certain category of music format:  
CLASSIC, COUNTRY, INFORM, JAZZ/RB, ROCK, etc.  
To activate, press MENU repeatedly until RBDS (ON/OFF) appears in  
the display. Use  
/
/
SEEK  
to toggle RBDS ON/OFF. When  
RBDS is OFF, you will not be able to search for RBDS equipped stations  
or view the station name or type.  
54  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
To search for specific RBDS music categories: When the desired  
category appears in the display, press  
/
to find the desired type,  
then press and release  
begin the search.  
SEEK, SEEK  
or press and hold SCAN to  
To view the station name or type: When the desired category appears  
in the display, press TEXT/SCAN to toggle between displaying the station  
type (COUNTRY, ROCK, etc.) or the station name (WYCD, WXYZ, etc.).  
BASS: Press MENU to reach the bass setting.  
Use  
TREB (Treble): Press MENU to reach the treble setting.  
Use SEEK, SEEK to adjust.  
BAL (Balance): Press MENU to reach the balance setting.  
Use SEEK, SEEK to adjust the audio between the left  
(L) and right (R) speakers.  
FADE: Press MENU to reach the fade setting.  
Use SEEK, SEEK to adjust the audio between the back  
(B) and front (F) speakers.  
ALL SEATS (Occupancy mode) (Available on Audiophile radios only):  
Press MENU repeatedly to access. Press SEEK to  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to adjust.  
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
/
optimize sound for ALL SEATS, DRIVERS SEAT or REAR SEATS.  
SPEEDVOL (Speed sensitive volume, if equipped): Press MENU to  
reach the SPEEDVOL setting. Radio volume automatically gets louder  
with increasing vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to adjust.  
The default setting is off; increasing your vehicle speed will not change  
the volume level.  
Adjust 1–7: Increasing this setting from 1 (lowest setting) to 7 (highest  
setting) allows the radio volume to automatically change slightly with  
vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Recommended level is1–3; SPEED OFF turns the feature off and level 7  
is the maximum setting.  
Track/Folder Mode: Available only on MP3 discs in CD mode. In Track  
Mode, pressing  
SEEK  
will scroll through all tracks on the disc.  
55  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
In Folder mode, pressing  
SEEK  
will scroll only through tracks  
within the selected folder.  
Press  
FOLDER, FOLDER to access the previous/next folder (if  
available).  
COMPRESS (Compression): Available only in CD/MP3 mode. Press  
MENU until COMPRESS ON/OFF appears in the display.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to toggle ON/OFF. When COMPRESS  
is ON, the system will bring soft and loud CD passages together for a  
more consistent listening level.  
4. AUX: Press repeatedly to cycle  
through FES/DVD (if equipped),  
LINE IN (Auxiliary audio mode, if  
equipped), SYNC, SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3 modes (satellite radio if  
equipped).  
For location and further information on the auxiliary audio mode, refer  
to Auxiliary input jack later in this chapter.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Family Entertainment System (FES)  
please refer to the Family entertainment DVD system section later in  
this chapter.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
5. SEEK: In radio mode,  
press  
/
to access the  
previous/next strong station.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press  
/
to access the previous/next CD track.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to  
seek to the previous/next channel. If a specific category is selected,  
(Jazz, Rock, News, etc.), press SEEK, SEEK to seek to the  
previous/next channel in the selected category. Press and hold  
SEEK, SEEK  
to fast seek through the previous /next channels.  
In TEXT MODE, press  
SEEK, SEEK to view the  
previous/additional display text.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press  
category.  
SEEK, SEEK  
to select a  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
56  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
6.  
/
OK (Play/Pause): This  
control is operational in CD/MP3  
mode. When a CD/MP3 is playing,  
press to pause or play the current CD. The CD status will display in the  
radio display.  
OK: Use in various menu selections.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Family Entertainment System (FES)  
please refer to the Family entertainment DVD system section later in  
this chapter.  
7. SHUFFLE: In CD/MP3 mode,  
press SHUFFLE to engage shuffle  
mode. SHUFFLE ON will appear in  
the display. If you wish to engage shuffle mode right away, press SEEK  
to begin random play. Otherwise, random play will begin when the  
current track is finished playing. CD SHUF will appear in the display. To  
disengage, press SHUFFLE again. SHUFFLE OFF will appear in the  
display.  
Note: In track mode, all tracks on the current disc will shuffle in  
random order. In MP3 folder mode, the system will randomly play all  
tracks within the current folder.  
8. FOLDER  
press FOLDER  
: In folder mode,  
to access next  
folder on MP3 discs, if available.  
9.  
FOLDER: In folder mode,  
press  
FOLDER to access the  
previous folder on MP3 discs, if  
folders are available.  
10. FF (Fast forward): Press FF  
to manually advance in a CD/MP3  
track.  
11. REW (Rewind): Press REW to  
manually reverse in a CD/MP3 track.  
12. Memory presets: To set a  
station: Select frequency band  
AM/FM1/FM2; tune to a station,  
press and hold a preset control until sound returns. You may store up to  
six stations in each frequency band for a total of 18.  
57  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), there are 18 available presets,  
six each for SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3. To save satellite channels in your  
memory presets, tune to the desired channel then press and hold a  
preset control until sound returns.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
13. TEXT/SCAN: In radio and  
CD/MP3 mode, press and hold for  
2 seconds to activate mode to hear  
a brief sampling of radio stations or CD tracks. Press again to stop.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press and release to display track title, artist name,  
and disc title and file name (if available).  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and release to enter  
TEXT MODE and display the current song title. While in TEXT MODE,  
press again to scroll through the current song title, artist, channel  
category and the SIRIUS long channel name.  
In TEXT MODE, sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the “>” indicator is active, press SEEK  
to view the  
additional display text. When the “>” indicator is active, press  
to view the previous display text.  
SEEK  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and hold to hear a brief  
sampling of the next channels. Press again to stop.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press SCAN to hear a brief sampling of channels  
in the selected category. Press again to stop.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS subscription.  
Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
14. AM/FM: Press to select  
AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
15. ON/OFF/Volume: Press to turn  
ON/OFF. Turn to increase/decrease  
volume.  
Note: If the volume is set above a  
certain level and the ignition is  
turned off, the volume will come back on at a “nominal” listening level  
when the ignition switch is turned back on.  
16. CD: Press to enter CD/MP3  
mode. If a CD is already loaded into  
the system, CD/MP3 play will begin  
where it ended last.  
58  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
17. LOAD: To load a disc into the  
system, press LOAD. Select a slot  
number using memory presets 1–6.  
When the display reads LOAD CD#,  
load the desired disc, label side up.  
If you do not choose a slot within five seconds, the system will choose  
for you. Once loaded, the first track will begin to play.  
To auto load up to 6 discs, press and hold LOAD until the display  
reads AUTOLOAD#. Load the desired disc, label side up. The system will  
prompt you to load discs for the remaining available slots. Insert the  
discs, one at a time, label side up, when prompted. Once loaded, the disc  
in the last slot loaded will begin to play.  
Note: An MP3 disc with folders will show F001 (folder #) T001 (track #)  
in the display. An MP3 disc without folders will show T001 (track#) in  
the display. Refer to MP3 track and folder structure later in this  
chapter for further information.  
18.  
(CD eject): To eject a disc  
. Select  
from the system, press  
the correct slot number using  
memory presets 1–6. When ready, the system will eject the disc and the  
display will read REMOVE CD. If the disc is not removed in 15 seconds,  
the system will reload the disc.  
To auto eject up to 6 CDs, press and hold  
until the system begins  
ejecting the current disc. Remove the current disc and the next disc will  
be ejected. If the current disc is not removed, the system will reload the  
disc.  
19. CD slot: Insert a CD label side  
up.  
Auxiliary input jack (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
59  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Your vehicle may be equipped with  
an Auxiliary Input Jack (AIJ). The  
Auxiliary Input Jack, located on the  
instrument panel below the power  
point, provides a way to connect  
your portable music player to the  
in-vehicle audio system. This allows  
the audio from a portable music  
player to be played through the  
vehicle speakers with high fidelity.  
To achieve optimal performance,  
please observe the following instructions when attaching your portable  
music device to the audio system.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, refer to the  
Auxiliary input jack section in the Audio Features chapter of your  
Navigation System supplement.  
Required equipment:  
1. Any portable music player designed to be used with headphones  
2. An audio extension cable with stereo male 1/8 in. (3.5 mm)  
connectors at each end  
To play your portable music player using the auxiliary input jack:  
1. Begin with the vehicle parked and the radio turned off.  
2. Ensure that the battery in your portable music player is new or fully  
charged and that the device is turned off.  
3. Attach one end of the audio extension cable to the headphone output  
of your player and the other end of the audio extension cable to the AIJ  
in your vehicle.  
4. Turn the radio on, using either a tuned FM station or a CD loaded into  
the system. Adjust the volume to a comfortable listening level.  
5. Turn the portable music player on and adjust the volume to 1/2 the  
volume.  
6. Press AUX on the vehicle radio repeatedly until LINE, LINE IN or  
SYNC LINE IN appears in the display.  
You should hear audio from your portable music player although it may  
be low.  
7. Adjust the sound on your portable music player until it reaches the  
level of the FM station or CD by switching back and forth between the  
AUX and FM or CD controls.  
60  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Troubleshooting:  
1. Do not connect the audio input jack to a line level output. Line level  
outputs are intended for connection to a home stereo and are not  
compatible with the AIJ. The AIJ will only work correctly with devices  
that have a headphone output with a volume control.  
2. Do not set the portable music player’s volume level higher than is  
necessary to match the volume of the CD or FM radio in your audio  
system as this will cause distortion and will reduce sound quality. Many  
portable music players have different output levels, so not all players  
should be set at the same levels. Some players will sound best at full  
volume and others will need to be set at a lower volume.  
3. If the music sounds distorted at lower listening levels, turn the  
portable music player volume down. If the problems persist, replace or  
recharge the batteries in the portable music player.  
4. The portable music player must be controlled in the same manner  
when it is used with headphones as the AIJ does not provide control  
(play, pause, etc.) over the attached portable music player.  
5. For safety reasons, connecting or adjusting the settings on your  
portable music player should not be attempted while the vehicle is  
moving. Also, the portable music player should be stored in a secure  
location, such as the center console or the glove box, when the vehicle is  
in motion. The audio extension cable must be long enough to allow the  
portable music player to be safely stored while the vehicle is in motion.  
USB port (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
61  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a  
USB port located on the instrument  
panel. This feature allows you to  
plug in media playing devices,  
memory sticks, and also to charge  
devices if they support this feature.  
For further information on this  
feature, refer to Accessing and  
using your USB port in the SYNC௡  
supplement or Navigation System  
supplement.  
GENERAL AUDIO INFORMATION  
Radio frequencies:  
AM and FM frequencies are established by the Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and the Canadian Radio and Telecommunications  
Commission (CRTC). Those frequencies are:  
AM: 530, 540–1700, 1710 kHz  
FM: 87.7, 87.9–107.7, 107.9 MHz  
Radio reception factors:  
There are three factors that can affect radio reception:  
Distance/strength: The further you travel from an FM station, the  
weaker the signal and the weaker the reception.  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, power lines, electric fences,  
traffic lights and thunderstorms can interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a broadcast tower, a stronger signal  
may overtake a weaker one and play while the weak station frequency  
is displayed.  
CD/CD player care  
Do:  
Handle discs by their edges only.  
(Never touch the playing  
surface).  
Inspect discs before playing.  
Clean only with an approved CD  
cleaner.  
62  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Wipe discs from the center out.  
Don’t:  
Expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended periods  
of time.  
Clean using a circular motion.  
CD units are designed to play commercially pressed 4.75 in  
(12 cm) audio compact discs only. Due to technical  
incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact  
discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD players.  
Do not use any irregular shaped  
CDs or discs with a scratch  
protection film attached.  
CDs with homemade paper  
(adhesive) labels should not be  
inserted into the CD player as  
the label may peel and cause the  
CD to become jammed. It is  
recommended that homemade  
CDs be identified with  
permanent felt tip marker rather  
than adhesive labels. Ballpoint pens may damage CDs. Please  
contact your authorized dealer for further information.  
Audio system warranty and service  
Refer to the Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for audio  
system warranty information. If service is necessary, see your dealer or  
qualified technician.  
63  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
MP3 track and folder structure  
Your MP3 system recognizes MP3 individual tracks and folder structure  
as follows:  
There are two different modes for MP3 disc playback: MP3 track mode  
(system default) and MP3 folder mode. For more information on track  
and folder mode, refer to Sample MP3 structure in the following section.  
MP3 track mode ignores any folder structure on the MP3 disc. The  
player numbers each MP3 track on the disc (noted by the .mp3 file  
extension) from T001 to a maximum of T255.  
Note: The maximum number of playable MP3 files may be less  
depending on the structure of the CD and exact model of radio present.  
MP3 folder mode represents a folder structure consisting of one level  
of folders. The CD player numbers all MP3 tracks on the disc (noted  
by the .mp3 file extension) and all folders containing MP3 files, from  
F001 (folder) T001 (track) to F253 T255.  
Creating discs with only one level of folders will help with navigation  
through the disc files.  
Sample MP3 structure  
If you are burning your own MP3  
discs, it is important to understand  
how the system will read the  
structures you create. While various  
files may be present, (files with  
extensions other than mp3), only  
files with the .mp3 extension will be  
played. Other files will be ignored  
by the system. This enables you to  
use the same MP3 disc for a variety  
of tasks on your work computer,  
home computer and your in vehicle  
system.  
.mp3  
.mp3  
1
1
2
3
.mp3  
2
3
4
5
.mp3  
.mp3  
.mp3  
4
6
7
.mp3  
.doc  
.ppt  
.xls  
In track mode, the system will display and play the structure as if it were  
only one level deep (all .mp3 files will be played, regardless of being in a  
specific folder). In folder mode, the system will only play the .mp3 files  
in the current folder.  
64  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Satellite radio information (if equipped)  
Satellite radio channels: SIRIUS broadcasts a variety of music, news,  
sports, weather, traffic and entertainment satellite radio channels. For  
more information and a complete list of SIRIUS satellite radio channels,  
visit www.sirius.com in the United States, www.sirius-canada.ca in  
Canada, or call SIRIUS at 1–888–539–7474.  
Satellite radio reception factors: To receive the satellite signal, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a satellite radio antenna located on the  
roof of your vehicle. The vehicle roof provides the best location for an  
unobstructed, open view of the sky, a requirement of a satellite radio  
system. Like AM/FM, there are several factors that can affect satellite  
radio reception performance:  
Antenna obstructions: For optimal reception performance, keep the  
antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and keep luggage and other  
material as far away from the antenna as possible.  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway  
overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can  
interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a ground based broadcast repeating  
tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and result in an  
audio mute.  
Unlike AM/FM audible static, you will hear an audio mute when there is  
a satellite radio signal interference. Your radio display may display NO  
SIGNAL to indicate the interference.  
SIRIUS satellite radio service: SIRIUS Satellite Radio is a subscription  
based satellite radio service that broadcasts music, sports, news and  
entertainment programming. A service fee is required in order to receive  
SIRIUS service. Vehicles that are equipped with a factory installed  
SIRIUS Satellite Radio system include:  
Hardware and limited subscription term, which begins on the date of  
sale or lease of the vehicle.  
Use of online media player providing access to all SIRIUS music  
channels over the internet using any computer connected to the  
internet (U.S. customers only).  
For information on extended subscription terms, contact SIRIUS at  
1–888–539–7474.  
65  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Note: SIRIUS reserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add  
or delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular  
channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford  
Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming  
changes.  
Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN): This 12–digit  
Satellite Serial Number is needed to activate, modify or track your  
satellite radio account. You will need this number when communicating  
with SIRIUS. While in Satellite Radio mode, you can view this number on  
the radio display by pressing AUX and Preset 1 control simultaneously.  
Radio Display  
ACQUIRING  
Condition  
Radio requires more  
than two seconds to  
produce audio for the  
selected channel.  
Internal module or  
system failure  
Action Required  
No action required.  
This message should  
disappear shortly.  
SAT FAULT  
If this message does  
not clear within a short  
period of time, or with  
an ignition key cycle,  
your receiver may have  
a fault. See your  
present.  
authorized dealer for  
service.  
INVALID CHNL  
Channel no longer  
available.  
This previously  
available channel is no  
longer available. Tune  
to another channel. If  
the channel was one of  
your presets, you may  
choose another channel  
for that preset button.  
Contact SIRIUS at  
1–888–539–7474 to  
subscribe to the  
UNSUBSCRIBED  
Subscription not  
available for this  
channel.  
channel or tune to  
another channel.  
66  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
NO TEXT  
Condition  
Action Required  
Artist information not Artist information not  
available.  
available at this time on  
this channel. The  
system is working  
properly.  
NO TEXT  
NO TEXT  
NO SIGNAL  
Song title information Song title information  
not available.  
not available at this  
time on this channel.  
The system is working  
properly.  
Category information  
not available.  
Category information  
not available at this  
time on this channel.  
The system is working  
properly.  
Loss of signal from  
the SIRIUS satellite or  
SIRIUS tower to the  
vehicle antenna.  
You are in a location  
that is blocking the  
SIRIUS signal (i.e.,  
tunnel, under an  
overpass, dense foliage,  
etc). The system is  
working properly. When  
you move into an open  
area, the signal should  
return.  
UPDATING  
Update of channel  
programming in  
progress.  
No action required. The  
process may take up to  
three minutes.  
CALL SIRIUS  
1–888–539–7474  
Satellite service has  
been deactivated by  
SIRIUS Satellite  
Radio.  
Call SIRIUS at  
1–888–539–7474 to  
re-activate or resolve  
subscription issues.  
67  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
FAMILY ENTERTAINMENT DVD SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Family Entertainment System  
(FES) which allows you to listen to audio CDs, MP3 discs, watch DVDs  
and to plug in and play a variety of standard video game systems. The  
DVD player is capable of playing standard DVDs, CDs, MP3s and is  
compatible with CD-R/W, CD-R and certain CD-ROM media.  
Please review this material to become familiar with the FES features and  
controls as well as the very important safety information.  
Note: Any notations or restrictions on individual DVD system controls  
are applicable to the overhead controls as well as to duplicate controls  
found on the remote control.  
Quick start  
Your Family Entertainment System includes a DVD system, two sets of  
wireless infrared (IR) headphones and a wireless infrared (IR) remote  
control.  
Note: To disable the DVD rear-seat controls:  
If your vehicle is equipped with the navigation system, press the  
MEDIA or RADIO hard button. Select the ’Rear Zone’ tab on the  
touchscreen. Press the ’disabled’ button. (Press the ’enabled’ button to  
turn the rear controls on again.)  
If your vehicle is equipped with an audio system, press the 3 and 5  
preset buttons simultaneously. (Press again to enable the controls).  
To play a DVD in the DVD system:  
The DVD system can play DVD-Video, DVD-R, DVD-R/W discs as well as  
audio CDs. To ensure proper disc operation, check the disc for finger  
prints, scratches and cleanliness. Clean with a soft cloth, wiping from  
center to edge.  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Insert a DVD into the system, label-side up to turn on the system. It  
will load automatically.  
68  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
3. Press the power button on the  
DVD player, then press Play  
begin to play the disc.  
to  
If a DVD is already loaded into the  
system, press PLAY on the DVD  
player.  
Note: If sound can be heard, but no video is present, press VIDEO to  
select the video source (DVD or aux-inputs).  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, when a disc  
is inserted, the DVD system will automatically switch to dual-play mode;  
the rear speakers will turn off, and the headphones will turn on. To turn  
the rear speakers on again, press  
on the DVD system bezel.  
Press VIDEO to change the source  
displayed on the screen. Press  
repeatedly to cycle through:  
DVD-DISC, DVD-AUX, NON-DVD,  
OFF.  
Press the power button to turn the  
system off. The indicator light will  
turn off indicating the system is off.  
Note: The audio from the DVD system will play over all vehicle speakers  
and can be adjusted by the radio volume control.  
To play a CD in the DVD system:  
The DVD system can play audio CDs, CD-R and CD-R/W, CD-ROM and  
video CDs. To ensure proper disc operation, check the disc for finger  
prints and scratches. Clean the disc with a soft cloth, wiping from the  
center to the edge.  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Insert a CD into the system,  
label-side up to turn on the DVD  
system. It will load and  
automatically begin to play. If there  
is already a CD in the system, press  
PLAY on the DVD player.  
69  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
3. The disc will begin to play and  
the ‘CD Audio Disc’ screen will  
display. From this screen, you can  
also select from COMPRESSION,  
SHUFFLE and SCAN features.  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped  
with a navigation system, when a  
disc is inserted, the DVD system will  
automatically switch to dual-play mode; the rear speakers will turn off,  
and the headphones will turn on. To turn the rear speakers on again,  
press  
on the DVD system bezel.  
To play an MP3 disc in the DVD system:  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Insert an MP3 disc into the  
system, label-side up to turn on the  
DVD system. It will load and  
automatically begin to play. If there  
is already a disc in the system, press  
PLAY on the DVD player.  
3. The disc will begin to play and  
the ‘MP3 Audio Disc’ screen will  
display and allow you to access the  
COMPRESSION, SHUFFLE, SCAN  
and FOLDER MODE features.  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped  
with a navigation system, when a  
disc is inserted, the DVD system will  
automatically switch to dual-play mode; the rear speakers will turn off,  
and the headphones will turn on. To turn the rear speakers on again,  
press  
on the DVD system bezel.  
To play an auxiliary source through the DVD system  
The DVD system can be used to connect and play auxiliary electronic  
devices such as game systems, personal camcorders, video cassette  
recorders, etc.  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
70  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
2. Press the power button to turn  
the DVD system on. The indicator  
light next to the power button will  
illuminate.  
3. Connect an auxiliary audio/video  
source by connecting RCA cords  
(not included) to the RCA jacks on  
the left hand side of the system.  
Yellow (1) — video input  
White (2) — left channel audio  
input  
Red (3) — right channel audio  
input  
4. Press MEDIA on the DVD system to change the media source to AUX.  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, the MEDIA  
button is only active in dual play mode.  
5. Press VIDEO on the DVD system to change the video source to  
DVD-AUX. If your source is properly plugged in, it will appear on the  
LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) screen. If your auxiliary source does not  
have a video signal, or if the DVD system does not detect a video signal  
from the auxiliary source, the screen will remain black. If the video  
source is set to DVD-AUX, the display will automatically turn on if a  
video signal is detected.  
To listen to audio over the headphones (Dual play mode):  
You may listen to channels A and B over wired or wireless headphones.  
Refer to Using the infrared wireless headphones and Using wired  
headphones for further information.  
Black (4) — wired headphone output (wired headphones not  
included)  
You can access dual play mode in any of the following ways:  
If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system:  
a. Ensure that the vehicle ignition is turned on. Inserting a DVD into  
the system will automatically activate dual play mode.  
b. Press the RADIO or MEDIA hard button on the navigation system.  
Select the ‘Rear Zone’ tab on the touchscreen and select ‘On’ for the  
headphones and ‘Enabled’ for the rear controls. To return to single  
zone, select ‘Off’ for the headphones and ‘Disabled’ for the rear  
controls.  
71  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
If your vehicle is equipped with a radio:  
a.Press the headphone/speaker (  
/
) button on the remote  
control or DVD system. Press again to return to single play mode.  
b.Press the 2 and 4 memory presets on the radio at the same time.  
Press again to return to single play mode.  
A green light will illuminate next to either the A or B Headphone Control  
Button to indicate which channel is active (able to be controlled).  
Press MEDIA to change the audio source of the active channel (A or  
B). The audio source will be shown on the display. You may change  
the active channel by pressing the A or B headphone control button.  
Note: Channel A can access any possible media source (AM, FM1, FM2,  
SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, AUX). Channel B can only access DVD and  
AUX sources.  
Note: Refer to Single play/Dual play for more information.  
Using the infrared (IR) wireless headphones:  
1. Press the power control on the earpiece to turn the headphones ON.  
2. Select Channel A or B for each set of wireless headphones by using  
the A/B control on the ear piece.  
3. Adjust the headphone volume using the rotary dial on the earpiece.  
Using wired headphones (not included):  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children operate the system while unsupervised. If  
wired headphones or auxiliary systems are used, children may become  
entangled in the cords and seriously injure themselves.  
1. Connect the wired headphones in to the headphone jacks on either  
side of the DVD system. Each side is labeled  
A or  
B. Headphones  
plugged into jack A will listen to Channel A and headphones plugged into  
jack B will listen to Channel B.  
2. Adjust the volume levels using  
the volume controls on the DVD  
system.  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, volume  
controls are only active in dual play mode  
72  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
To adjust display brightness:  
To decrease/increase the brightness  
level on the display screen, press  
the brightness control on the DVD  
system. A display will appear at the  
bottom of the screen indicating the  
brightness level. The brightness display will only appear when the menu  
is not displayed.  
DVD player controls  
16  
1
2
6
4
3
5
A
B
ENTER  
MENU  
RETURN  
MEDIA  
VIDEO  
VOLUME  
10  
14  
12  
7
15 13  
11  
8
9
1. Headphone control A/B: While  
in Dual Play mode, press to select  
either the A or B headphone source.  
Then press MEDIA to select the  
desired playing media for that  
headset. When a headphone channel has been selected (A or B),  
selections will affect the source on that channel only.  
Note: Headphone A can access any possible media (AM, FM1, FM2, SAT  
(if equipped), CD, DVD, DVD-AUX). Headphone B can only access DVD  
and DVD-AUX.  
For further information, refer to Single play/Dual play later in this  
section.  
73  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
2.  
/
(Stop/Eject): Press  
once to stop and press a second  
time to eject a disc from the DVD  
system.  
3.  
(Reverse): Press and  
release for the previous chapter or  
track. Press and hold to reverse  
search a DVD, Video CD, or FES CD in DVD/CD mode.  
4.  
(Fast forward): Press and  
release for the next chapter or  
track. Press and hold to forward  
search a DVD, Video CD, or FES CD in DVD/CD mode.  
5.  
/
(Play/Pause): Press  
(Play) to select DVD mode (and to  
turn the DVD system on if it is off).  
If a disc is present, it will resume or begin to play. Press (Pause) while  
playing a disc to pause a DVD or CD.  
6. On/Off: Press to turn the DVD  
system On/Off.  
7. VIDEO: Press repeatedly to cycle  
through the following video state  
options which will be indicated on  
the bottom right hand corner of the  
display: DVD DISC, DVD-AUX,  
NON-DVD and Off (no indicator). If you select the DVD-AUX video  
source, the display will turn off if there is no video signal detected. When  
a video signal is detected on the auxiliary video input, and the display is  
in the DVD-AUX video mode, the display will automatically turn on.  
8. Infrared (IR) Receiver & Transmitter: System sensor which reads  
the signals from the remote control and sends audio signals to the  
infrared (IR) wireless headphones.  
9. LCD screen: The eight inch diagonal screen rotates down to view and  
up into housing to store when not in use. Ensure that the screen is  
latched into the housing when being stored.  
74  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
10. Volume: If your vehicle is  
equipped with a navigation system,  
this function is only available when  
in dual play mode. For all other  
vehicles, when in single play mode,  
press to increase (  
) or decrease (  
) the volume over all speakers.  
When in Dual Play, press to increase (  
) or decrease (  
) the volume  
for the wired headphones. (Wireless headphone volume is controlled  
with the rotary dial on the right ear piece.)  
11.  
/
(Headphones/Speakers): Press once for Dual Play  
(Headphone mode- the rear speakers are muted) and press again for  
Single Play (same media playing through all speakers). You can also  
press the 2 and 4 memory preset buttons on the audio system at the  
same time to perform the same function. For further interaction  
information, refer to Single Play/Dual play under Operation later in  
this section.  
12. MEDIA: Press repeatedly to  
select from the various possible  
playing media sources (AM, FM1,  
FM2, SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, DVD-AUX). The media will show in  
the status display on the top of the screen when in Dual Play mode.  
When in Single Play mode, the media source will be displayed on the  
radio.  
Note: Channel A can access any possible media source (AM, FM1, FM2,  
SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, DVD-AUX). Channel B can only access  
DVD and DVD-AUX sources.  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, this function  
is only active in dual play mode.  
13. RETURN: Press to return to the  
playing media or to resume  
playback.  
14. MENU: When playing a DVD,  
press MENU once to enter the DVD  
disc menu (if available) and press  
twice to enter the system set-up menu. From the set-up menu, you may  
select from Angle, Aspect Ratio, Language, Subtitles, Disc resume,  
Compression, Restore Defaults and Back. For more detailed information,  
refer to Menu mode.  
75  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
15. ENTER: Press to select/confirm  
the current selection.  
16. Cursor /Brightness controls:  
Use the cursor controls to make  
various selections when in any  
menu. When not in a menu, and in  
DVD mode, press  
/
to adjust  
the brightness. A display bar will appear at the bottom of the screen  
indicating the brightness levels.  
Remote control  
Unless otherwise stated, all operations can be carried out with the  
remote control. Always point the remote control directly at the player.  
Ensure that there are no obstructions between the remote and player.  
1. Power control: Press to turn the FES (Family Entertainment  
System) ON/OFF.  
2. Cursor controls: Use in various active menus to advance the cursor  
up/down/left/right. When not in a Menu, the left and right cursor controls  
decrease and increase the display brightness.  
76  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
3. DISPLAY: Press to access the on-screen display of the FES functions  
and adjustments.  
4. RETURN: Press to return to the previous menu screen.  
5. ANGLE (DVD dependent): Press to select the angle to view the  
scene.  
6. Channel A/B: Press to select either A or B headphones and then use  
the MEDIA control to select the desired playing media for the  
headphones.  
7. VOL (Volume): When in Single Play, press to increase (  
) or  
) the volume over all speakers. When in Dual Play, press to  
) or decrease ( ) the volume for the wired headphones.  
decrease (  
increase (  
(Wireless headphone volume is controlled with the rotary dial on the  
right ear piece.)  
8. Fast Forward/Next: In DVD mode, press and hold for a quick  
advance within the DVD. Press and release to advance to the next  
chapter. In CD/MP3 mode, press to access the next track.  
9. Play/Pause: Press to play or pause a DVD.  
10. SHUFFLE: Press to play all tracks on the current CD/MP3 disc in  
random order.  
11. STOP: Press to stop the current DVD or CD/MP3.  
12.  
/
Speaker/Headphone (Single/Dual Play): Press to toggle  
between Single Play (same media playing through all speakers) and Dual  
Play (headphone mode — the rear speakers are muted). You can also  
press the 2 and 4 memory presets on the audio system at the same time  
to perform the same function.  
13. Numeric Keypad: Use the numeric controls to enter in a specific  
CD/MP3 track or DVD chapter to be played.  
14. C (Cancel): Press to cancel/clear the numeric input (i.e. chapter  
number).  
15. MEDIA: Press to cycle through the possible media sources: AM,  
FM1, FM2, SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, LINE IN (if equipped),  
DVD-AUX.  
Channel B can only access DVD and AUX sources.  
16. VIDEO: Press to cycle through video states: DVD-DISC, DVD-AUX,  
NON-DVD, Off.  
17. EJECT: Press to eject a disc from the FES.  
77  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
18. Fast reverse/Previous: When a DVD is playing, press and hold for a  
quick reverse within the DVD. Press and release for the previous  
chapter. Press PLAY to resume normal playback speed and volume.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press to access the previous track.  
19. MENU: Press to access the DVD disc menu for selections. Press MENU  
again when in the DVD disc menu to access the system set-up menu.  
20. SUBTITLE (DVD dependent): Press to turn the subtitle feature ON  
or OFF.  
21. LANGUAGE (DVD dependent): Press to select the desired language.  
22. ENTER: Press to select the highlighted menu option.  
23. ILLUMINATION: Press to illuminate the remote control and  
backlight all of the buttons.  
Battery replacement  
Batteries are supplied with the  
remote control unit. Since all  
batteries have a limited shelf life,  
replace them when the unit fails to  
control the DVD player.  
Remove the screw and unlatch the battery cover to access the batteries.  
The remote control unit uses two AAA batteries which are supplied with  
the unit.  
78  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Headphones  
Wireless headphones  
WARNING: The driver should never use the headphones while  
driving the vehicle. Using headphones may prevent the driver  
from hearing audible warnings such as horns or emergency sirens,  
which could result in a crash causing serious injury. Give your full  
attention to driving and to the road.  
Your FES system is equipped with  
two sets of battery powered,  
infrared wireless headphones. Two  
AAA batteries are needed to operate  
the headphones. (Batteries are  
included.)  
Additional infrared wireless  
headphones may be purchased for  
use with the system. Also, wired  
headphones may be purchased and  
plugged in where indicated on the  
left and right hand sides of the  
system. Refer to Wired  
Headphones following.  
79  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
To install the batteries, remove the screw at the bottom of the cover.  
Then, lightly press down on top and slide the cover off.  
When replacing the batteries, use two new batteries (alkaline  
recommended) and install them with the correct orientation as indicated  
in the battery housing.  
80  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
To operate the headphones:  
Press POWER on the ear piece to turn on the headphones. A red  
indicator light will illuminate indicating the headphones are ON. Press  
POWER again to turn the headphones off.  
Adjust the headphones to comfortably fit your head using the  
headband adjustment.  
Select the desired audio source (Channel A or B) for each set of  
wireless headphones by using the A/B selection switch on the ear  
piece.  
Adjust the volume control to the desired listening level.  
Ensure that the headphones are turned off when not in use. After  
approximately one minute of not being in use (no infrared signal is  
received), the wireless headphones will automatically turn off. They will  
also turn off after two hours of continuous use as a power save feature.  
If this happens, simply turn the headphones on again and continue use.  
81  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Wired headphones  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children operate the system while unsupervised. If  
wired headphones or auxiliary systems are used, children may become  
entangled in the cords and seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: The driver should never use the headphones while  
driving the vehicle. Using headphones may prevent the driver  
from hearing audible warnings such as horns or emergency sirens,  
which could result in a crash causing serious injury. Give your full  
attention to driving and to the road.  
You may purchase wired headphones for your FES (Family  
Entertainment System). Plug them into the 3.5 mm headphone jack(s)  
located on the left and right sides of the system. (Channel A is located  
on the left side and Channel B is located on the right side.) These  
headphones will be active when in Dual Play mode.  
To listen to the audio on wired headphones (not included), connect the  
wired headphones into the headphone jacks on the sides of the DVD  
system. The wired headphone jack for Channel A is located on the left  
side of the FES and is labeled  
A. Headphones plugged into this  
headphone jack will hear audio from the audio source selected to be the  
Channel A source. The wired headphone jack for Channel B is located on  
the right side of the FES and is labeled  
B. Headphones plugged into  
this headphone jack will hear audio from the audio source selected to be  
the Channel B source.  
Adjust the headphone volume using  
the volume control on the DVD  
system.  
Operation  
Single play/Dual play  
Your DVD and audio system work together with the infrared headphones  
and wired headphones (not included) to allow the rear seat passengers  
to listen to the radio (and other media sources) over the headphones.  
This enables the front and rear seat passengers to listen to a variety of  
sources a variety of ways.  
82  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Single Play: Single play consists of all occupants in the vehicle listening  
to the same playing media over the front and rear speakers. When the  
DVD system is on, and the same source is playing through the front and  
rear speakers, SINGLE PLAY will appear in the front radio display.  
Dual Play: Dual play is when the rear seat passengers choose to listen  
to a different playing media than the front seat passengers. With the  
DVD and Rear Seat Controls turned ON, the rear seat passengers may  
choose to listen to the radio, CD, MP3, DVD, DVD-AUX or SYNC(if  
equipped) media sources over headphones while the front speakers play  
the chosen selection for the front audio system, they may listen to  
another over the headphones. DUAL PLAY will appear in the radio  
display.  
When both the front seat passengers and the rear seat passengers listen  
to the same audio source, SHARED MODE will appear on the radio.  
Note: If the front seat passengers are listening to the radio, the rear seat  
passengers can also listen to the radio; however, they will be limited to  
listening to the same radio channel.  
You can access dual play mode in any of the following ways:  
If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system:  
a. Ensure that the vehicle ignition is turned on. Inserting a DVD into  
the system will automatically activate dual play mode.  
b. Press the RADIO or MEDIA hard button on the navigation system.  
Select the ‘Rear Zone’ tab on the touchscreen and select ‘On’ for the  
headphones and ‘Enabled’ for the rear controls. To return to single  
zone, select ‘Off’ for the headphones and ‘Disabled’ for the rear  
controls.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a radio:  
a.Press the headphone/speaker (  
/
) button on the remote  
control or DVD system. Press again to return to single play mode.  
b.Press the 2 and 4 memory presets on the radio at the same time.  
Press again to return to single play mode.  
The headphone control will now be active and a green light next to the  
A or B headphone control buttons will illuminate. The system can output  
two different audio sources over the headphones. These are called  
Channel A and Channel B. Both Channel A and Channel B can be  
listened to on the wired headphones (not included) or on the infrared  
(IR) wireless headphones.  
83  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Press the Headphone Control button  
A to change the audio source for  
Channel A.  
Press MEDIA to change the audio  
source for Channel A. This  
information will display on the DVD  
system screen.  
Press the Headphone Control button  
B to change the audio source for  
Channel B.  
Press MEDIA to change the audio source for Channel B. This information  
will display on the DVD system screen. Channel B can listen to either  
the DVD media or the DVD system auxiliary inputs (DVD-AUX).  
When in Dual play mode, you can press  
(Reverse),  
(Fast  
forward) or  
/
(Play/pause) to access different features in the  
various modes.  
Operation with an aftermarket audio system  
(Headphone only mode)  
When the Family Entertainment System (FES) detects that the original  
radio supplied by Ford Motor Company has been removed from the  
vehicle, the Family Entertainment System will work in a state referred to  
as “Headphone Only Mode”.  
While operating in Headphone Only Mode, the system will have limited  
functionality.  
The system will only output audio to the headphones. It will not be  
capable of providing audio to the speakers.  
The available sources in FES Headphone Only Mode are DVD-DISC  
and DVD-AUX, regardless of headphone channel (A or B).  
When a disc is inserted into the FES while in Headphone Only Mode,  
both headphone channels (A&B) will be connected to FES-DISC.  
84  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Menu mode  
Press MENU once on the DVD system to access the DVD disc menu if  
available.  
Press MENU twice to access the DVD set-up menu and the following  
features:  
1. ZOOM  
2. ANGLE  
3. ASPECT RATIO  
4. LANGUAGE  
5. SUB TITLES  
Angle mode  
Select ANGLE to select various  
angles of view for the DVD.  
This is disc dependent — some  
DVD discs may have more viewing  
angles to select from. Once you  
have made your selection, press  
ENTER to confirm. The system  
default is Angle 1.  
Aspect ratio  
Select ASPECT RATIO to select the  
viewing size and shape of the video  
displayed on the LCD screen. This is  
disc dependent.  
85  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
You can select from: WIDE, LETTER  
BOX or PAN SCAN. Once you have  
made your selection, press ENTER  
to confirm. The LCD screen display  
will immediately change to your  
selection after the system resumes  
playback of the DVD. The system  
default is WIDE (16:9).  
Language  
Select LANGUAGE to select the  
language you would like to use for  
audio output (English, Spanish,  
French). This is disc dependent.  
Once you have made your selection,  
press ENTER to confirm. The  
system default is English.  
Subtitles  
Select SUBTITLES to turn the  
subtitle option on or off. The system  
default is OFF.  
86  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Once you have made your selection,  
press ENTER to confirm. This is  
disc dependent.  
Audio CDs  
To play audio CDs on your DVD system:  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Ensure that the DVD system is on.  
3. Insert an audio CD into the DVD system, label side up.  
4. The track and elapsed time will  
appear in the status bar. Use the  
DVD cursor controls on the bezel to  
highlight which track you would like  
to play. You can also use the cursor  
controls to highlight  
COMPRESSION, SHUFFLE or  
SCAN. Once you have highlighted  
the desired track or function, press ENTER on the DVD bezel to confirm  
your selection.  
COMP (Compression): Compression brings soft and loud CD passages  
together for a more consistent listening level when in CD mode. Press to  
turn the feature on/off.  
SHUFFLE: Press to hear all tracks on the current CD in random order.  
Press again to stop.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all tracks on the current CD. Press  
again to stop.  
Playing MP3 discs  
To play an MP3 disc on your DVD system:  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Ensure that the DVD system is on.  
3. Insert the MP3 disc into the DVD system, label side up.  
87  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
4. The folder, track and elapsed  
time will appear in the status bar.  
The screen will list the Artist, Title,  
Album and File Name.  
COMP (Compression):  
Compression brings soft and loud  
CD/MP3 passages together for a  
more consistent listening level when  
in CD mode. Press to turn the feature on/off.  
SHUFFLE: Press to hear all tracks on the current MP3 folder in random  
order. Press again to stop.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all tracks on the current MP3 folder.  
Press again to stop.  
FOLDER LIST: Press access folder mode and to go to the previous/next  
folder in the MP3 disc.  
MP3 disc quality factors  
Several factors can effect disc playback quality:  
Disc capacity — Each disc contains about 650 MB of storage capacity.  
We do not recommend using high capacity discs containing 700MB of  
storage.  
Disc type — Some CD-RW discs may operate inconsistently and may  
cause an error message to appear. We recommend burning MP3 files  
onto CD-R discs.  
Disc finalization — The disc may be left open for the purpose of  
adding sessions to it at a later time, but be sure to close each session  
or the disc will not play.  
Bit rate — The player supports bit rates from 32–320 kbps, as well as  
variable bit rate MP3 files, but lower bit rates will have a noticeable  
effect on sound quality and are recommended only for speech or low  
fidelity music material. We recommend that you encode MP3 files  
using a high quality encoder.  
PC configuration — Encoding MP3 files requires intensive use of your  
computer’s resources. Follow the PC configuration recommendations  
of the encoder software vendor. We recommend that you avoid  
running other software applications on your PC during MP3 encoding  
to avoid undesirable noise and distortion.  
88  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
CD, MP3 and CD player care  
Handle discs by their edges only. Never touch the playing surface.  
Do not expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended  
periods of time.  
Do not insert more than one disc into the slot of the CD player (if  
equipped).  
Always store discs out of direct sunlight. Excessive heat may damage  
or warp discs.  
Use care when handling and playing CD-R and CD-RW discs, which  
are more susceptible to damage from heat, light and stress than are  
regular CDs.  
Always insert and remove a disc by holding the disc flat, with the  
playing surface facing down, in order to prevent damage to the disc or  
the player.  
Never insert any object other than a compact disc (CD) or digital  
versatile disc (DVD) into the player, as doing so may damage the  
player and may cause injury to you.  
Do not disassemble the player. The laser used in disc playback is  
extremely harmful to the eyes.  
The FES DVD system is designed to play commercially pressed  
12 cm (4.75 in) audio compact discs and digital versatile discs  
(DVD), DVD-R and R/W discs only. Due to technical  
incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact  
discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD and DVD  
players. Irregular shaped CDs or DVDs, CDs or DVDs with a  
scratch protection film attached, and CDs with homemade paper  
(adhesive) labels should not be inserted into the FES DVD  
system. The label may peel and cause the CD or DVD to become  
jammed. It is recommended that homemade CDs or DVDs be  
identified with permanent felt tip marker rather than adhesive  
labels. Ball point pens may damage CDs or DVDs. Please contact  
your authorized dealer for further information.  
Playing a DVD  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Ensure that the navigation system is on.  
3. Insert a DVD label-side up into the system.  
89  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
4. Use the DVD bezel controls to:  
Press to play or pause a DVD.  
Press to stop or eject a DVD.  
Press and release to go to the  
previous chapter. Press and hold for  
a fast reverse search.  
Press and release to go to the next  
chapter. Press and hold for a fast  
forward search.  
Press when not in menu mode to  
adjust brightness, or when in menu  
mode to navigate through the menu  
selections.  
Press to adjust volume levels.  
Slow play  
1. With a DVD playing, press pause.  
2. Press and hold the reverse or  
advance button to enter into slow  
play mode. Once in slow play mode,  
press and release the reverse or advance button repeatedly to cycle  
through 1/4 and 1/2. These will display on the status bar on top of the  
screen as the screens cycle through at this rate.  
Frame by frame  
1. With a DVD playing, press pause.  
90  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
2. Press the right cursor button. The  
DVD will advance one frame. Each  
press of the right cursor button will  
advance the DVD video by one  
frame.  
Headphone/auxiliary jacks  
There are wired headphones (not included) and auxiliary jacks on the  
left and right side of your DVD system. They can be used to plug in  
wired headphones or to connect and play auxiliary electronic devices  
such as game systems, personal camcorders, video cassette recorders,  
etc.  
On the left side of the system is the  
Headphone A input jack. This  
headphone will listen to the media  
selected on the Channel A source.  
When you need to make any  
adjustments to the media, volume,  
etc, ensure that the Channel A  
source is highlighted.  
Also located here are the various  
auxiliary jacks which can be used to  
plug in a VCR, camcorder, video  
games, etc. The specific jacks are as follows:  
1. Yellow: video input  
2. White: left channel audio input  
3. Red: right channel audio input  
4. Black: wired headphone jack (not included)  
The B headphone jack (5) is located  
on the right side of the DVD system.  
Plug in wired headphones (not  
included) here.  
Note: The B headphones can only  
access DVD and AUX modes. They  
cannot access radio sources.  
91  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Audio displays  
Your DVD system interacts closely with the front audio system. Status  
messages will appear in the radio display showing the DVD status. Some  
possible radio display messages:  
SINGLE PLAY or DUAL PLAY  
DVD LOAD  
DVD MENU  
DVD STOP  
Audio interaction  
You can then also use the front audio controls to advance, reverse, play  
and pause a DVD. While a DVD is playing you may use the following  
controls on the front radio:  
SEEK: Press to advance to the previous (  
) or next (  
) DVD  
chapters.  
: Press to play a DVD or to pause the DVD.  
When the radio displays “DVD MENU”, press PLAY on the radio  
(memory preset #6), to play the disc.  
Parental control for the DVD system  
Your Family Entertainment System (FES) allows you to have control  
over the rear seat controls in a few different ways. The DVD system is  
automatically activated when the vehicle ignition is ON, which allows the  
rear seat passengers to use the DVD system.  
There are three levels of control of  
the FES buttons. The states are  
FULL (enabled), LOCAL or  
LOCKED (disabled). To change the level of control, press the memory  
preset controls 3 and 5 simultaneously on the front audio controls. The  
control level will cycle each time the buttons are pressed simultaneously.  
The three states are described as:  
FULL (enabled): The FES has control over the primary (speaker) and  
secondary (headphone) audio sources.  
LOCAL: The FES has control over the secondary source (headphones)  
only. The radio will ignore button presses that affect the primary  
(speaker) audio source.  
92  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
LOCKED (disabled): The FES buttons are locked and all FES button  
presses are ignored by the radio and the FES except for load and eject.  
When the DVD system is ON, you  
can then press the memory preset  
controls 2 and 4 simultaneously to  
1
2
3
4
5
6
toggle between Single Play and Dual Play. In Single Play mode, all  
speakers listen to the same media. In Dual Play mode, rear seat  
passengers can use the infrared wireless, or wired (not included)  
headphones to listen to a different playing media than the front seat  
passengers.  
General information  
Note: DVDs are formatted by  
regions. US and Canada systems can  
only play region 1 DVDs and Mexico  
systems can only play region 4  
DVDs. Systems sold in vehicles  
targeted for other parts of the world  
would have different regions. If a  
playback problem is encountered,  
please ensure that you are using a  
disc designed for your vehicle. The  
region coding can be found stamped  
on the disc or on the box, and can say ‘region-1’ or ‘region 4’, etc. They  
may also be marked by a numerical symbol.  
Macrovision: This product incorporates copyright protection technology  
that is protected by method claims of certain U.S. patents and other  
intellectual property rights owned by Macrovision Corporation and other  
rights owners. Use of this copyright protection technology must be  
authorized by Macrovision Corporation, and is intended for home and  
other limited viewing uses only unless otherwise authorized by  
Macrovision Corporation. Reverse engineering or disassembly is  
prohibited.  
MP3: Supply of this product only conveys a license for private,  
non-commercial use and does not convey a license nor imply any right to  
use this product in any commercial (i.e. revenue generating) real time  
broadcasting (terrestrial, satellite, cable and /or any other media)  
broadcasting/streaming via internet, intranets and/or other networks or in  
other electronic content distribution systems, such as pay-audio or  
audio-on-demand applications. An independent license for such use is  
required. For details, please visit http:// www.mp3licensing.com.  
93  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Safety information  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Read all of the safety and operating instructions before operating the  
system and retain for future reference.  
Do not attempt to service, repair or modify the Family Entertainment  
System (FES). See your dealer.  
Do not insert foreign objects into the DVD compartment.  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children operate the system while unsupervised. If  
wired headphones or auxiliary systems are used, children may become  
entangled in the cords and seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: The front glass on the liquid crystal display (LCD)  
flip-down screen may break when hit with a hard surface. If the  
glass breaks, do not touch the liquid crystalline material. In case of  
contact with skin, wash immediately with soap and water.  
WARNING: The driver should not attempt to operate any  
function of the DVD system while the vehicle is in motion. Give  
full attention to driving and to the road. Pull off the road in a safe  
place before inserting or extracting DVDs from the system. A remote  
control is included in the system to allow the rear seat occupants to  
operate the FES functions without distracting the driver.  
Do not expose the liquid crystal display (LCD) flip-down screen  
to direct sunlight or intensive ultraviolet rays for extensive  
periods of time. Ultraviolet rays deteriorate the liquid crystal.  
Be sure to review User Manuals for video games and video game  
equipment when used as auxiliary inputs for your Family Entertainment  
System (FES).  
Do not operate video games or video equipment if the power cords  
and/or cables are broken, split or damaged. Carefully place cords and/or  
94  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
cables where they will not be stepped on or interfere with the operation  
of seats and/or compartments.  
Disconnect video games and video equipment power cords and/or cables  
when not in use.  
Avoid touching auxiliary input jacks with your fingers. Do not blow on  
them or allow them to get wet or dirty.  
Do not clean any part of the DVD player with benzene, lacquer thinner,  
acetone, or any other solvent.  
Federal Communication Commission (FCC) Compliance  
Changes or modifications not approved by Ford Lincoln-Mercury could  
void user’s authority to operate the equipment. This equipment has been  
tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,  
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a  
residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate  
radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with  
the instructions, may cause harmful interference and radio  
communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a  
particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference  
to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the  
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to consult the dealer or an  
experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
Care and service of the DVD player  
Environmental extremes  
DVD players which are subjected to harsh environmental conditions may  
be damaged or perform at less than maximum capability. To avoid these  
outcomes, whenever possible avoid exposing your DVD player to:  
extremely hot or cold temperatures.  
direct sunlight.  
high humidity.  
a dusty environment.  
locations where strong magnetic fields are generated.  
Temperature extremes  
When the vehicle is parked under direct sunlight or in an extremely cold  
place for a long period of time, wait until the cabin temperature of the  
vehicle is at normal temperature before operating the system.  
95  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Humidity and moisture condensation  
Moisture in the air will condense in the DVD player under extremely  
humid conditions or when moving from a cold place to a warm one.  
Moisture condensation may cause damage to the DVD and/or player. If  
moisture condensation occurs, do not insert a CD or DVD into the  
player. If one is already in the player, remove it. Turn the DVD player ON  
to dry the moisture before inserting a DVD. This could take an hour or  
more.  
Foreign substances  
Exercise care to prevent dirt and foreign objects from entering the DVD  
player compartment. Be especially careful not to spill liquids of any kind  
onto the media controls or into the system. If liquid is accidentally  
spilled onto the system, immediately turn the system OFF and consult a  
qualified service technician.  
Cleaning the liquid crystal display (LCD) flip-down screen  
Clean the display screen by applying a small amount of water or any  
ammonia-based household glass cleaner directly to a soft cloth. Rub the  
screen gently until the dust, dirt or fingerprints are removed. Do not  
spray the screen directly with water or glass cleaning solvents. Overspray  
from these fluids could drip down into the internal electronics of the  
screen and cause damage. Do not apply excessive pressure while  
cleaning the screen.  
Cleaning DVD and CD discs  
Inspect all discs for contamination before playing. If necessary, clean  
discs only with an approved DVD and CD cleaner and wipe from the  
center out to the edge. Do not use circular motion.  
Compatibility with aftermarket audio systems  
(headphone only mode)  
When the Family Entertainment System (FES) detects that the original  
radio supplied by Ford Motor Company has been removed from the  
vehicle, the FES will work in a state referred to as “Headphone Only  
Mode.” This mode allows the FES to operate as a standalone system,  
without interface to the radio.  
While operating in Headphone Only Mode, the system will have limited  
functionality.  
The system will only output audio to the headphones. It will not be  
capable of providing audio to the speakers.  
The available sources in FES Headphone Only Mode are DVD-DISC  
and DVD-AUX, regardless of headphone channel (A or B).  
96  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
When a disc is inserted into the FES while in Headphone Only Mode,  
both headphone channels (A and B) will be connected to FES-DISC.  
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a navigation system. Refer to the  
Navigation System supplement for further information.  
SYNC(IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with SYNC, a hands-free communications  
and entertainment system with special phone and media features. For  
more information, please refer to the SYNCsupplement or to the  
SYNCsection in the Navigation System supplement (if equipped).  
97  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
HEATER ONLY SYSTEM  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
1. Fan speed adjustment: Controls  
the volume of air circulated in the  
vehicle.  
2. Temperature selection:  
Controls the temperature of the  
airflow in the vehicle.  
3. Air flow selections: Controls the direction of the airflow in the  
vehicle. See the following for a brief description on each control.  
: Distributes outside air through the instrument panel vents.  
: Distributes outside air through the instrument panel vents and the  
floor vents.  
(OFF): Outside air is shut out and the climate system is turned off.  
: Distributes outside air through the floor vents.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents and  
floor vents.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents and  
demister vents. Can be used to clear the windshield of fog and thin ice.  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather, place  
the air flow selector in the  
position.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the air  
flow to the back seats.  
To reduce humidity build-up inside the vehicle, do not drive in  
the  
(OFF) position.  
Under normal weather conditions, do not leave the airflow selector  
in  
(OFF). This allows the vehicle to breathe using the outside air  
inlets.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To aid in side window defogging/demisting in cold weather:  
1. Select  
.
2. Adjust the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
98  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
3. Set the fan speed to the highest setting.  
4. Direct the outer instrument panel vents towards the side windows.  
To increase airflow to the outer instrument panel vents, close the vents  
located in the middle of the instrument panel.  
MANUAL HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEMS  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
Manual heating and air  
conditioning system  
Manual heating and air  
conditioning system with heated  
mirrors  
Manual heating and air  
conditioning system with heated  
mirrors and heated seats  
1. Fan speed adjustment: Controls the volume of air circulated in the  
vehicle.  
99  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
2. Temperature selection: Controls the temperature of the airflow in  
the vehicle.  
3. Air flow selections: Controls the direction of the airflow in the  
vehicle. See the following for a brief description on each control.  
MAX A/C: Distributes recirculated air through the instrument panel  
vents only to cool the vehicle. This re-cooling of the interior air is more  
economical and efficient. Recirculated air may also help reduce  
undesirable odors from entering the vehicle.  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents.  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents and the floor  
vents.  
O (OFF): Outside air is shut out and the fan will not operate.  
: Distributes air through the floor vents.  
: Distributes air through the windshield defroster vents and floor  
vents.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents. Can  
be used to clear ice or fog from the windshield.  
4.  
(Recirculated air): Press to activate/deactivate air  
recirculation in cabin. Recirculated air may reduce the amount of time to  
cool down the interior of the vehicle and may also help reduce undesired  
odors from reaching the interior of the vehicle. Recirculation engages  
automatically with selection of MAX A/C or can be engaged manually in  
any other airflow selection except defrost. Recirculation may turn off  
automatically in all airflow selections except MAX A/C.  
5. A/C: Press to activate/deactivate air conditioning. Use with  
recirculated air to improve cooling performance and efficiency. Engages  
automatically in MAX A/C,  
and  
.
6. (Heated mirrors): Press to turn the heated mirrors on and off.  
The heated mirrors turn off automatically after 10 minutes.  
7. (Heated seats): Press to turn the heated seats on and off. The  
heated seats turn off when the ignition is turned off.  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather, place  
the air flow selector in the  
position.  
To reduce humidity build up inside the vehicle, do not drive with the  
air flow selector in the O (Off) position.  
100  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the  
airflow to the rear seats.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To improve the A/C cool down, drive with the windows slightly open  
for 2–3 minutes after start up or until the vehicle has been “aired out.”  
During extreme high ambient temperatures when idling stationary for  
extended periods of time in gear, it is recommended to run the A/C in  
the MAX A/C position, reduce blower fan speed from the highest setting  
and put the vehicle’s transmission into the P (PARK) gear position  
(automatic transmission only) to continue to receive cool air from your  
A/C system.  
For maximum cooling performance in MAX A/C mode:  
1. Move the temperature control to the coolest setting.  
2. Set the fan to the highest speed initially, then adjust in order to  
maintain comfort.  
To aid in side window defogging and demisting in cold weather:  
1. Select  
.
2. Select A/C.  
3. Set the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
4. Set the fan speed to highest setting.  
5. Direct the outer instrument panel vents towards the side windows.  
101  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
DUAL AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL (DATC) SYSTEMS  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
DATC  
DATC with heated mirrors  
102  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
DATC with heated seats and heated mirrors  
Temperature conversion: To switch between Fahrenheit and Celsius,  
refer to Units (English/Metric) under either Standard Message Center  
or Optional Message Center in the Driver Controls chapter  
In order to achieve maximum cooling performance, press  
and set the temperature to 60°F (16°C) and the highest blower setting.  
1. Defrost: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster  
and demister vents. Can be used to clear thin ice or fog from the  
windshield. To exit select another mode.  
, A/C,  
,
2. Passenger temperature control: Press to increase/decrease the  
passenger side temperature in the vehicle cabin.  
3A. Dual: (Single/dual electric temperature control): Allows the driver to  
have full control of the cabin temperature settings (single zone) or  
allows the passenger to have control of their individual temperature  
settings (dual zone control). Press to turn on dual zone mode, press  
again to return to single zone.  
3B.  
Heated mirrors: Press to defrost the outside rear view  
mirrors. The heated mirrors will turn off after 10 minutes or can be  
turned off by pressing the button again. Refer to Power mirrors in the  
Driver Controls chapter for more information.  
103  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
4.  
Recirculation control: Press to activate/deactivate air  
recirculation in cabin. Recirculated air may reduce the amount of time to  
cool down the interior of the vehicle and may also help reduce undesired  
odors from reaching the interior of the vehicle. Recirculation can be  
engaged manually in any other airflow selection except  
(defrost).  
Recirculation may turn off automatically in all airflow selections except  
MAX A/C.  
5. A/C control: Press to activate/deactivate air conditioning. Use with  
recirculated air to improve cooling performance and efficiency. Engages  
automatically in AUTO,  
(defrost) and  
(floor/defrost).  
6. Manual override controls: Press this control to manually select  
where you want the airflow directed. To return to full automatic control,  
press AUTO.  
7.  
: Distributes air through the windshield defroster vents and floor  
vents.  
8.  
: Distributes air through the floor vents.  
9.  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents and the floor  
vents.  
10.  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents.  
11.  
Fan speed control: Press to manually increase or decrease the  
fan speed. To return to automatic fan operation, press AUTO.  
12. EXT: Press to display outside temperature. Press again to display  
cabin temperature settings.  
13. OFF: Outside air is shut out and the fan will not operate.  
14. Driver temperature control: Press to increase/decrease the driver  
side temperature in the vehicle cabin.  
15. AUTO: To engage automatic temperature control, press AUTO and  
select the desired temperature using the temperature control. The  
system will automatically determine fan speed, airflow location, A/C on  
or off, and outside or recirculated air, to heat or cool the vehicle to reach  
the desired temperature.  
16.  
Heated seat controls: Press to turn the heated seats on and off.  
The heated seats turn off when the ignition is turned off.  
104  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather, place  
the air flow selector in the position.  
To reduce humidity build up inside the vehicle, do not drive with the  
system off, or with recirculated air engaged and A/C off.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the  
airflow to the back seats.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To improve the A/C cool down, drive with the windows slightly open  
for 2-3 minutes after start up or until the vehicle has been “aired out”.  
During extreme high ambient temperatures when idling stationary for  
extended periods of time in gear, it is recommended to run the A/C in  
the max A/C position, reduce blower fan speed from the highest setting  
and put the vehicle’s transmission into the P (PARK) gear position  
(automatic transmission only) to continue to receive cool air from your  
A/C system.  
For maximum cooling performance (MAX A/C):  
Automatic operation:  
1. Press AUTO for full automatic operation.  
2. Do not override A/C or  
(recirculated air).  
3. Set the temperature to 60°F (16°C).  
Override operation:  
1. Select air distribution.  
2. Select A/C and  
(recirculated air). Use  
(recirculated air) with  
A/C to provide colder airflow.  
3. Set the temperature to 60°F (16°C).  
4. Set highest fan speed initially, then adjust to maintain comfort.  
105  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
In  
(panel) or  
(panel/floor) modes:  
1. Move temperature control to full cold.  
2. Select A/C and  
(recirculated air). Use recirculated air with A/C to  
provide colder airflow.  
3. Set highest fan speed initially, then adjust to maintain comfort.  
To aid in side window defogging/demisting in cold weather:  
1. Select  
.
2. Select A/C.  
3. Adjust the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
4. Set the fan speed to the highest setting.  
5. Direct the outer instrument panel vents towards the side windows.  
To increase airflow to the outer instrument panel vents, close the vents  
located in the middle of the instrument panel.  
106  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
HEADLAMP CONTROL  
Turns the lamps off.  
Turns on the parking lamps,  
instrument panel lamps, license  
plate lamps and tail lamps.  
Turns the headlamps on.  
Autolamp control (if equipped)  
The autolamp system provides light  
sensitive automatic on-off control of  
the exterior lights normally  
controlled by the headlamp control.  
The autolamp system also keeps the  
lights on for approximately  
20 seconds or on vehicles equipped  
with a message center, you can  
select a delay from 0–180 seconds,  
after the ignition switch is turned to  
off.  
To turn autolamps on, rotate the control counterclockwise.  
To turn autolamps off, rotate the control clockwise to the off position.  
Fog lamp control (if equipped)  
The headlamp control also operates  
the fog lamps. The fog lamps can be  
turned on only when the headlamp  
control is in the  
,
or  
position and the high beams are not  
turned on.  
Pull headlamp control towards you  
to turn fog lamps on. The fog lamp  
indicator light  
will illuminate.  
107  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Daytime running lamps (DRL) (if equipped)  
Turns the headlamps on with a reduced output.  
To activate:  
the ignition must be in the on position,  
the headlamp control is in the off or parking lamp position and  
the parking brake must be disengaged.  
WARNING: Always remember to turn on your headlamps at  
dusk or during inclement weather. The Daytime Running Lamp  
(DRL) system does not activate the tail lamps and generally may not  
provide adequate lighting during these conditions. Failure to activate  
your headlamps under these conditions may result in a collision.  
High beams  
Push the lever toward the  
instrument panel to activate. Pull  
the lever towards you to deactivate.  
F
OF  
Flash to pass  
Pull toward you slightly to activate  
and release to deactivate.  
108  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
PANEL DIMMER CONTROL  
Use to adjust the brightness of the  
instrument panel and all applicable  
illuminated switches in the vehicle  
during headlamp and parklamp  
operation.  
Move the control to the full upright  
position, past detent, to turn on the  
interior lamps.  
Note: If the battery is disconnected,  
discharged, or a new battery is  
installed, the dimmer switch requires re-calibration. Rotate the dimmer  
switch from the full dim position to the full dome/on position to reset.  
This will ensure that your displays are visible under all lighting  
conditions  
AIMING THE HEADLAMPS  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a sealed beam or aerodynamic  
headlamp system. Sealed beam headlamps may be aimed in the vertical  
(up/down) and the horizontal (left/right) directions using the procedures  
following. The aerodynamic headlamps can only be aimed in the vertical  
direction (up/down) using the procedures following. The headlamps on  
your vehicle are properly aimed at the assembly plant and should not  
normally need adjusting.  
109  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Vertical and horizontal aim adjustment (sealed beam headlamps)  
The headlamps on your vehicle are intended to be aimed using  
mechanical aimers. If mechanical aimers are used and the cross-car sight  
line is in any way blocked, set the legs of the universal adaptor all to the  
same setting, such that the cross-car sight line is no longer blocked, per  
the instructions for the brand of mechanical aimer used. You can also  
aim the headlamps visually using the procedure below.  
To adjust the headlamps:  
1. Park your vehicle on a level  
surface about 25 feet (7.6 meters)  
away from a vertical plain surface  
(3). Check your headlamp alignment  
at night or in a dark area so that  
you can see the headlamp beam  
pattern.  
(1) 8 feet (2.4 meters)  
(2) Center height of lamp to  
ground  
(3) 25 feet (7.6 meters)  
(4) Horizontal reference line  
(5) Center of headlamps  
(6) Center line of the vehicle  
2. The center of the headlamp is marked either on the lens (a circle or  
cross marker) or on the bulb shield, internal to the lamp (mark or  
feature). Measure the height from the center of your headlamp to the  
ground (2) and mark an 8 foot (2.4 meter) long horizontal line on the  
wall or screen (1) at this height (masking tape works well).  
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps  
and open the hood.  
4. Locate the high intensity area of  
the beam pattern and place the top  
edge of the intensity zone even with  
the horizontal reference line (4). If  
the top edge of the high intensity  
area is not even with the horizontal  
line, follow the next step to adjust  
it.  
110  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
5. Locate the vertical adjuster (2)  
for each headlamp. Adjust the aim  
by turning the adjuster control  
either clockwise (to adjust up) or  
counterclockwise (to adjust down).  
6. In addition to the horizontal line  
marked in step 2, a pair of vertical  
lines (5) must be marked at the  
center line of the headlamps on the  
wall or screen.  
7. On the wall or screen, locate the high intensity area of the beam  
pattern. The left edge of the high intensity area should be even with the  
vertical line corresponding to the headlamp under adjustment. If the left  
edge of the high intensity area is not even with the vertical line, follow  
the next step to adjust it.  
8. Locate the horizontal adjuster (1) for each headlamp. Turn it  
clockwise or counterclockwise, to place the left edge of the high  
intensity area even with the vertical line corresponding to the headlamp  
under adjustment.  
Vertical aim adjustment (aerodynamic headlamps)  
The headlamps on your vehicle can only be vertically adjusted. Your  
vehicle does not require horizontal aim adjustments.  
To adjust the headlamps:  
1. Park the vehicle directly in front of a wall or screen on a level surface,  
approximately 25 feet (7.6 meters) away.  
(1) 8 feet (2.4 meters)  
(2) Center height of lamp to ground  
(3) 25 feet (7.6 meters)  
111  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
(4) Horizontal reference line  
2. Measure the height from the  
center of your headlamp (indicated  
by a 3.0 mm circle on the lens) to  
the ground and mark an 8 foot  
(2.4 meter) horizontal reference line  
on the vertical wall or screen at this  
height (a piece of masking tape  
works well).  
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps  
to illuminate the wall or screen and open the hood. Cover one of the  
headlamps so no light from that lamp hits the wall.  
4. On the wall or screen you will  
observe a light pattern with a  
distinct horizontal edge towards the  
right. If this edge is not at the  
horizontal reference line, the beam will need to be adjusted so the edge  
is at the same height as the horizontal reference line.  
5. Locate the vertical adjuster on  
each headlamp, then use a E5 Torx  
socket to turn the adjuster either  
counterclockwise (to adjust down)  
or clockwise (to adjust up) aligning  
the upper edge of the light pattern  
up to the horizontal line.  
6. Repeat Steps 3–5 for the other  
headlamp.  
7. Close the hood and turn off the  
lamps.  
TURN SIGNAL CONTROL  
Push down to activate the left  
turn signal.  
Push up to activate the right turn  
signal.  
112  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
MAP LAMPS (IF EQUIPPED)  
The dome lamp turns on when:  
any door is opened,  
the instrument panel dimmer  
switch is rotated up until the  
courtesy lamps come on, and  
any of the remote entry controls  
are pressed and the ignition is  
off.  
BULB REPLACEMENT  
Lamp assembly condensation  
Exterior lamps are vented to accommodate normal changes in pressure.  
Condensation can be a natural by-product of this design. When moist air  
enters the lamp assembly through the vents, there is a possibility that  
condensation can occur when the temperature is cold. When normal  
condensation occurs, a thin film of mist can form on the interior of the  
lens. The thin mist eventually clears and exits through the vents during  
normal operation. Clearing time may take as long as 48 hours under dry  
weather conditions.  
Examples of acceptable condensation are:  
Presence of thin mist (no streaks, drip marks or droplets)  
Fine mist covers less than 50% of the lens  
Examples of unacceptable moisture (usually caused by a lamp water  
leak) are:  
Water puddle inside the lamp  
Large water droplets, drip marks or streaks present on the interior of  
the lens  
Take your vehicle to dealer for service if any of the above conditions of  
unacceptable moisture are present.  
113  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Replacing exterior bulbs  
Check the operation of all the bulbs frequently.  
Function  
Number Trade number  
of bulbs  
Headlamps (aerodynamic)  
Headlamps (sealed beam)  
Park lamp with aerodynamic headlamp  
Park lamp with sealed beam headlamp  
Sidemarker  
Tail/stop/turn/sidemarker (pick-up only)  
Tail/stop/turn/sidemarker (chassis cabs  
only; if equipped)  
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
H13/9008  
H6054  
3157A or 3157AK  
3157  
194  
3157  
3157  
Back-up (pick-ups only)  
Back-up (chassis cabs only)  
High-mount stoplamp  
Fog lamp  
License plate lamp  
Cargo lamp  
Mirror turn signal  
Mirror clearance lamp  
*Front clearance lamps (2) and front  
identification lamps (3)  
*Rear fender clearance  
Interior visor lamp (if equipped)  
*Rear identification  
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
5
921  
3157  
922  
9145  
194  
906  
2825  
2825  
194  
4
4
3
194  
194  
194  
All replacement bulbs are clear in color except where noted.  
To replace all instrument panel lights - see your authorized dealer  
* Dual rear wheels, or if equipped.  
114  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing headlamp bulbs (aerodynamic)  
1. Make sure that the headlamps are off, then open the hood.  
2. Remove the bolts from the top,  
side and bottom of the headlamp  
assembly.  
3. Pull the assembly straight out  
disengaging two snap clips from the  
fender.  
4. Disconnect the electrical  
connector by squeezing the release  
tab and pushing the connector  
forward, then pulling it rearward.  
5. Remove the bulb assembly by  
turning it counterclockwise and  
pulling it straight out.  
WARNING: Handle a halogen headlamp bulb carefully and keep  
out of children’s reach. Grasp the bulb only by its plastic base  
and do not touch the glass. The oil from your hand could cause the  
bulb to break the next time the headlamps are operated.  
Install the new bulb(s) in reverse order.  
115  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Replacing park/turn and sidemarker lamp bulbs (aerodynamic)  
1. Make sure that the headlamps are off, then open the hood.  
2. Remove the bolts from the top, side and bottom of the headlamp  
assembly.  
3. Pull the assembly straight out.  
4. Remove the bulb assembly,  
sidemarker or park/turn bulb by  
turning it counterclockwise and  
pulling it straight out.  
5. Pull the old bulb out from the  
socket.  
Install the new bulb(s) in reverse order.  
Replacing headlamp bulbs (sealed beam)  
1. Make sure that the headlamps are off, then open the hood.  
2. Remove the three screws and one  
bolt from the top and bottom of the  
park lamp/bezel assembly.  
3. Remove the four screws and the  
headlamp retaining ring from  
headlamp.  
4. Disconnect the electrical  
connector from the headlamp.  
Install the new bulb(s) in reverse order.  
116  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing park/turn/sidemarker bulbs (sealed beam)  
1. Make sure that the headlamps are off, then open the hood.  
2. Remove the three screws and one bolt from the top and bottom of the  
park lamp/bezel assembly.  
3. Pull the assembly straight out disengaging snap clip.  
4. Remove the bulb assembly,  
sidemarker or park/turn by turning  
it counterclockwise. (Top view of  
assembly shown.)  
5. Pull the old bulb out from the  
socket.  
Install the new bulb(s) in reverse order.  
Replacing brake/tail/turn/back-up lamp bulbs - Pick-ups only  
1. Make sure the headlamps are off,  
then open the tailgate to expose the  
lamp assemblies.  
2. Remove the two bolts from the  
tail lamp assembly and carefully pull  
the lamp assembly from the tailgate  
pillar by releasing the two retaining  
tabs.  
3. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise and remove from lamp  
assembly.  
4. Pull the bulb straight out of the socket.  
Install the new bulb(s) in reverse order.  
117  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing brake/tail/turn/back-up lamp bulbs - Chassis cabs only  
(if equipped)  
1. Make sure the headlamps are off.  
2. Remove the four screws and the  
lamp lens from lamp assembly.  
3. Carefully pull the bulb straight  
out of the socket and push in the  
new bulb.  
Replacing cargo lamp and high-mount brakelamp bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamps are off.  
2. Remove the screws and lamp  
assembly from vehicle as wiring  
permits.  
3. Remove the bulb socket by  
rotating counterclockwise.  
4. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket.  
Replacing front clearance and identification lamp bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamps are off.  
2. Remove the screw and lens from  
the lamp assembly.  
3. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket.  
Install the bulb(s) in reverse order.  
118  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing fog lamp bulbs (if equipped)  
1. Make sure the headlamps are off.  
2. Remove the bulb socket from the  
fog lamp by turning  
counterclockwise.  
3. Disconnect the electrical  
connector from the fog lamp bulb.  
Install the new bulb(s) in reverse order.  
Replacing license plate lamp bulbs  
The license plate bulbs are located  
behind the rear bumper. To change  
the license plate lamp bulbs:  
1. Reach behind the rear bumper to  
locate the bulb.  
2. Twist the bulb socket  
counterclockwise and carefully pull  
to remove it from the lamp  
assembly.  
3. Pull out the old bulb from the  
socket and push in the new bulb.  
4. Install the bulb socket in lamp assembly by turning it clockwise.  
119  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
MULTI-FUNCTION LEVER  
Windshield wiper: Rotate the end  
of the control away from you to  
increase the speed of the wipers;  
rotate towards you to decrease the  
speed of the wipers.  
Speed dependent wipers: When the wiper control is set on the  
intermittent settings, the speed of the wipers will automatically adjust  
with the vehicle speed. The faster your vehicle is travelling the faster the  
wipers will go.  
Windshield washer: Press the end  
of the stalk:  
briefly: causes a single swipe of  
the wipers without washer fluid.  
a quick press and hold: the  
wipers will swipe three times with  
washer fluid.  
a long press and hold: the wipers  
and washer fluid will be activated  
for up to ten seconds.  
Courtesy wipe feature: One extra wipe will occur a few seconds after  
washing the front window to clear any excess washer fluid remaining on  
the windshield.  
Note: Do not operate the washer when the washer reservoir is empty.  
This may cause the washer pump to overheat. Check the washer fluid  
level frequently. Do not operate the wipers when the windshield is dry.  
This may scratch the glass, damage the wiper blades and cause the wiper  
motor to burn out. Before operating the wiper on a dry windshield,  
always use the windshield washer. In freezing weather, be sure the wiper  
blades are not frozen to the windshield before operating the wipers.  
Windshield wiper rainlamp feature (if equipped with Autolamp)  
When the windshield wipers are turned on during daylight, and the  
headlamp control is in the autolamp position, the exterior lamps will turn  
on after a brief delay and will remain on until the wipers are turned off.  
120  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
TILT STEERING WHEEL  
1. Pull and hold the steering wheel  
release control toward you.  
2. Move the steering up or down  
until you find the desired location.  
3. Release the steering wheel  
release control. This will lock the  
steering wheel in position.  
WARNING: Never adjust the steering column when the vehicle  
is moving.  
ILLUMINATED VISOR MIRROR (IF EQUIPPED)  
Lift the mirror cover to turn on the  
visor mirror lamp.  
OVERHEAD CONSOLE (IF EQUIPPED)  
The appearance of your vehicle’s overhead console will vary according to  
your option package. If your vehicle is equipped with a moon roof, refer  
to Moon roof later in this chapter for information on its operation.  
121  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Storage compartment (if equipped)  
Press the release on the door to  
open the storage compartment.  
The storage compartment may be  
used to secure sunglasses or a  
similar object and the front tab can  
be used for holding tickets, paper,  
envelopes, etc. The front bin may be  
used to store small objects.  
CENTER CONSOLE (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a variety of console features. These  
include:  
Utility compartment with  
cassette/CD holder  
Coin holder  
Pen holder  
Writing surface  
A power point inside the utility  
compartment and on the rear of  
the console  
Laptop storage  
Hanging file folder supports  
Rear cupholders (Crew Cab only)  
WARNING: Use only soft cups in the cupholder. Hard objects  
can injure you in a collision.  
122  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Center console/under-seat storage-Cabela’s Edition (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a lockable compartment in the center  
console and a lockable storage area under the rear seats.  
Center console storage  
Use the vehicle’s ignition key to  
lock/unlock the compartment.  
Under-seat storage  
Flip the rear seat cushion up to  
access the rear under-seat storage  
area. See Seating in the Seating  
and Safety Restraints chapter for  
more information.  
Use the vehicle’s ignition key to  
lock/unlock the compartment.  
Release the lid latches to open the  
storage area.  
123  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
AUXILIARY POWER POINT (12VDC)  
Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs only. Do not insert  
any other object in the power outlet for this will damage the  
outlet and blow the fuse. Do not hang any type of accessory or  
accessory bracket from the plug. Improper use of the power  
outlet can cause damage not covered by your warranty.  
Auxiliary power points can be found in the following locations:  
On the instrument panel  
On the rear of the center console (if equipped) (SuperCab and Crew  
Cab models)  
Do not use the power point for operating the cigarette lighter element (if  
equipped).  
To prevent the fuse from being blown, do not use the power point(s)  
over the vehicle capacity of 12 VDC/180W. If the power point or cigar  
lighter socket is not working, a fuse may have blown. Refer to Fuses and  
relays in the Roadside Emergencies chapter for information on  
checking and replacing fuses.  
To have full capacity usage of your power point, the engine is required to  
be running to avoid unintentional discharge of the battery. To prevent  
the battery from being discharged:  
do not use the power point longer than necessary when the engine is  
not running,  
do not leave battery chargers, video game adapters, computers and  
other devices plugged in overnight or when the vehicle is parked for  
extended periods.  
Always keep the power point caps closed when not being used.  
POWER WINDOWS (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children play with the power windows. They may  
seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: When closing the power windows, you should verify  
they are free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or  
pets are not in the proximity of the window openings.  
124  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Press and pull the window switches  
to open and close windows.  
Press down (to the first detent)  
and hold the switch to open.  
Pull up (to the first detent) and  
hold the switch to close.  
Rear Window Buffeting: When one or both of the rear windows are  
open, the vehicle may demonstrate a wind throb or buffeting noise. This  
noise can be alleviated by lowering a front window approximately two to  
three inches.  
One-touch down  
Allows the driver’s window to open  
fully without holding the control  
down. Press the switch completely  
down to the second detent and  
release quickly. The window will  
open fully. Momentarily press the  
switch to any position to stop the  
window operation.  
Window lock (if equipped)  
The window lock feature allows only  
the driver to operate the power  
windows.  
To lock out all the window controls  
(except for the driver’s) press the  
right side of the control. Press the  
left side to restore the window  
controls.  
Power rear slider window (if equipped)  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children play with the power windows. They may  
seriously injure themselves.  
125  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
WARNING: When closing the power windows, you should verify  
they are free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or  
pets are not in the proximity of the window openings.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a  
power rear slide window, the switch  
is located on the instrument panel  
behind the right-hand side of the  
steering wheel.  
Press the right side of the control  
to open the window.  
Pull the right side of the control  
to close the window.  
Accessory delay  
With accessory delay, the window switches may be used for up to  
10 minutes after the ignition switch is turned to the off position or until  
either front door is opened.  
INTERIOR MIRROR  
The interior rear view mirror has two pivot points on the support arm  
which lets you adjust the mirror up or down and from side to side.  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
Automatic dimming interior rear view mirror (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with an interior rear view mirror which  
has an auto-dimming function. The electronic day/night mirror will  
change from the normal (high reflective) state to the non-glare  
(darkened) state when bright lights (glare) reach the mirror. When the  
mirror detects bright light from behind the vehicle, it will automatically  
adjust (darken) to minimize glare.  
The mirror will automatically return to the normal state whenever the  
vehicle is placed in R (Reverse) to ensure a bright clear view when  
backing up.  
Do not block the sensors on the front and back of the interior rear  
view mirror since this may impair proper mirror performance.  
126  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
Note: If equipped with a rearview camera system (RCS), a video image  
will display in the mirror or the navigation system (if equipped) when  
the vehicle is put in (R) Reverse. As you shift into any other gear from R  
(Reverse), the image will remain for a few seconds and then turn off.  
Refer to Rearview camera system (RCS) in the Driving chapter.  
EXTERIOR MIRRORS  
Power side view mirrors (if equipped)  
To adjust your mirrors:  
1. Rotate the control clockwise to  
adjust the right mirror and rotate  
the control counterclockwise to  
adjust the left mirror.  
2. Move the control in the direction  
you wish to tilt the mirror.  
3. Return to the center position to lock mirrors in place.  
The spotter mirror below the main glass (if equipped) must be adjusted  
manually.  
Heated outside mirrors  
(if equipped)  
The main mirror glass and lower  
convex spotter mirror are heated to  
remove ice, mist and fog. To activate  
the heated mirrors, press the heated  
mirror control  
located on the  
climate control panel. The heated  
mirrors will operate for 10 minutes,  
then automatically shut off (or shut  
off when the engine is turned off).  
In cases of extreme ice and cold,  
the heater control may need  
pressing again after 10 minutes in order to fully clear the glass.  
Do not remove ice from the mirrors with a scraper or attempt to  
re-adjust the mirror glass if it is frozen in place. These actions  
could cause damage to the glass and mirrors.  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
127  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Fold-away mirrors  
Fold the side mirrors in carefully before driving through a narrow space,  
like an automatic car wash.  
Powerfold mirrors  
If equipped with powerfold mirrors,  
you can fold the side mirrors  
simultaneously using the power  
mirror switch.  
To operate the powerfold mirrors:  
1. Rotate the switch to the center/neutral position.  
2. Momentarily pull the switch rearward to auto fold in.  
3. Momentarily pull the switch rearward again to fold back to design  
position.  
Note: When powerfolding the mirrors, it is normal to hear the sound of  
the motors.  
Powerfold mirror positions, from left to right: Position 1, Position 2,  
Position 3  
The powerfold mirrors may be folded forward/rearward manually to any  
of the three positions shown and electrically to positions 1 and 2 only. If  
a mirror is folded manually forward to position 3, you must manually fold  
it back to position 1 or 2 in order for the powerfold function to continue  
functioning. Note: Although it is possible to electrically fold the mirror  
from position 3 to 2, it was not designed for this functionality and may  
not always work under all conditions.  
128  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Note: Ten or more switch activations within one minute, or repeated  
fold/unfolding of the mirrors while holding the switch rearward during the  
full travel may cause the system to disable the fold/unfold function to  
protect the motors from overheating. Should this occur, wait approximately  
312 minutes for the system to reset and function to return to normal.  
Note: The powerfold mirrors are designed to operate while the vehicle is  
stationary or traveling at moderate speeds. If you attempt to powerfold  
the mirrors at high speeds, they may not fully fold forward/rearward -  
slow down and powerfold or manually fold the mirrors in order to  
complete the fold operation.  
Note: If the power fold/telescope mirror glass appears loose or vibrates  
when driving, it is possible that the mirrors have been manually folded or  
telescoped. To minimize the vibration, ensure that the mirrors are  
electronically folded and telescoped in/out with the switches on the door  
trim panel. If the power fold mirrors are out of sync, electronically  
powerfold the mirrors to re-sync the motors. This will cause a loud “click”  
and the mirrors will jerk during re-synchronization. This is normal.  
Telescoping mirrors (if equipped)  
The telescoping feature allows the  
mirror to extend approximately  
2.75 inches (70 mm). This feature is  
especially useful to the driver when  
towing a trailer. Mirrors can be  
manually pulled out or pushed in to  
the desired telescopic position.  
If equipped with power telescoping  
mirrors, you can simultaneously  
position both mirrors using the  
power telescope switch found on  
the door trim panel.  
To telescope the mirrors  
outboard, press and hold the left  
side of the power telescope  
switch until the mirrors reach their desired position. When the end of  
travel is reached, it is normal to hear the power telescoping motors  
running as long as you continue to hold the switch.  
129  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
To telescope the mirrors inboard, press and hold the right side of the  
power telescope switch until the mirrors reach their desired position.  
Memory mirrors (if equipped)  
This system allows automatic positioning of the outside rearview mirrors.  
For more information on this feature, refer to Memory seats/power  
mirrors/adjustable pedals in the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter.  
Mirror mounted side turn signal indicator (if equipped)  
When the vehicle turn signals are  
activated, the outer portion of the  
mirror housing will blink amber.  
The turn signal feature can be seen  
by other drivers who may approach  
from the rear of the vehicle.  
Clearance lamps (if equipped)  
Illuminates when the headlamps or  
parking lamps are switched on.  
This provides additional visibility of  
your vehicle to other drivers on the  
road.  
130  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
POWER ADJUSTABLE FOOT PEDALS (IF EQUIPPED)  
The accelerator and brake pedal  
should only be adjusted when the  
vehicle is stopped and the gearshift  
lever is in the P (Park) position.  
Press and hold the rocker control to  
adjust accelerator and brake pedal  
toward you or away from you.  
WARNING: Never adjust the accelerator and brake pedal with  
feet on the pedals while the vehicle is moving.  
The accelerator and brake pedal positions are saved when doing a  
memory set function and can be recalled along with the vehicle  
personality features when a memory position is selected through the  
remote entry transmitter, keyless entry keypad or memory switch on the  
driver’s door (if equipped with memory feature). Refer to Memory  
seats/power mirrors/adjustable pedals in the Seating and Safety  
Restraints chapter.  
SPEED CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)  
With speed control set, you can maintain a set speed without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator pedal.  
WARNING: Do not use the speed control in heavy traffic or on  
roads that are winding, slippery or unpaved.  
131  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Setting speed control  
The controls for using your speed  
control are located on the steering  
wheel for your convenience.  
1. Press the ON control and release  
it.  
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.  
3. Press the SET + control and  
release it.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator  
pedal.  
5. The indicator light  
on the  
instrument cluster will turn on.  
Note:  
Vehicle speed may vary momentarily when driving up and down a  
steep hill.  
If the vehicle speed increases above the set speed on a downhill, you  
may want to apply the brakes to reduce the speed.  
If the vehicle speed decreases more than 10 mph (16 km/h) below  
your set speed on an uphill, your speed control will disengage.  
132  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Resuming a set speed  
Press the RES (resume) control and  
release it. This will automatically  
return the vehicle to the previously  
set speed.  
Increasing speed while using speed control  
There are two ways to set a higher  
speed:  
Press and hold the SET + control  
until you get to the desired  
speed, then release the control.  
You can also use the SET +  
control to operate the Tap-Up  
function. Press and release this  
control to increase the vehicle set  
speed in small amounts by 1 mph  
(1.6 km/h).  
Use the accelerator pedal to get to the desired speed. When the  
vehicle reaches that speed press and release the SET + control.  
Reducing speed while using speed control  
There are two ways to reduce a set  
speed:  
Press and hold the SET - control  
until you get to the desired  
speed, then release the control.  
You can also use the SET -  
control to operate the Tap-Down  
function. Press and release this  
control to decrease the vehicle  
set speed in small amounts by  
1 mph (1.6 km/h).  
Depress the brake pedal until the desired vehicle speed is reached,  
press the SET + control.  
133  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Turning off speed control  
There are two ways to turn off the speed control:  
Depress the brake pedal. This will not erase your vehicle’s previously  
set speed.  
Press the speed control OFF  
control.  
Note: When you turn off the speed  
control or the ignition, your speed  
control set speed memory is erased.  
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS (IF EQUIPPED)  
These controls allow you to operate some radio and climate control  
features.  
Audio control features  
Press MEDIA to select:  
AM, FM1, FM2  
CD (if equipped)  
DVD (if equipped)  
SAT1, SAT2 or SAT3 (Satellite  
Radio mode, if equipped).  
LINE IN (Auxiliary input jack)  
134  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
In AM, FM1, or FM2 mode:  
SEEK to  
Press  
select preset stations within the  
selected radio band or press and  
hold to select the next/previous  
radio frequency.  
In Satellite radio mode (if  
equipped):  
Press  
SEEK  
to  
advance through preset channels or subscribed channels.  
In CD mode:  
Press  
SEEK  
to select the next selection on the CD or  
press and hold to forward or reverse the CD.  
In any mode:  
Press VOL + or − to adjust  
volume.  
Navigation system hands free  
control features (if equipped)  
Press and hold VOICE briefly until  
the voice  
icon appears on the  
Navigation display to use the voice  
command feature.  
Press VOICE to complete a voice  
command.  
For further information on the  
Navigation system, refer to the  
Navigation System supplement.  
135  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
SYNCsystem hands free  
control feature (if equipped)  
Press VOICE briefly until the  
voice  
icon appears on the display  
to use the voice command feature.  
You will hear a tone and LISTENING  
will appear in the radio display.  
Press and hold VOICE to exit voice  
command.  
Press  
to activate phone mode or  
answer a phone call. Press and hold  
to end call or exit phone mode.  
Press to scroll through various menus and selections. Press  
OK to confirm your selection.  
For further information on the SYNCsystem, refer to the SYNC௡  
supplement.  
Navigation system/SYNChands  
free control features (if  
equipped)  
Press VOICE briefly until the  
voice  
icon appears on the  
Navigation display to use the voice  
command feature.  
Press  
to activate phone mode or  
answer a phone call. Press and  
hold  
call.  
to exit phone mode or end  
For further information on the Navigation system/SYNCsystem, refer to  
the Navigation System and SYNCsupplements.  
136  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
UPFITTER CONTROLS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with  
the Upfitter option package which  
will provide four switches, mounted  
in the center of the instrument  
panel, labeled AUX 1, AUX 2, AUX 3  
and AUX 4. These switches will only  
operate while the ignition is in the  
on position, whether the engine is  
running or not. It is, however, recommended that the engine remain  
running to maintain battery charge when using the Upfitter switches for  
extended duration or higher current draws. (This is even more important  
for vehicles with diesel engines since the glow plugs are also draining  
battery power when the ignition key is in the on position.)  
When switched on by the operator they provide 10 amps, 15 amps or  
30 amps of electrical battery power for a variety of personal or  
commercial uses.  
If your vehicle is equipped with this option, there will also be a relay box  
located on the driver side end of the instrument panel. See your  
authorized dealer for service.  
The relays are coded as shown in  
the accompanying illustration.  
RELAY  
4
RELAY  
3
RELAY  
2
RELAY  
1
137  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
There will also be one power lead  
for each switch found as a blunt-cut  
and sealed wire located below the  
instrument panel and to the left of  
the steering column.  
They are coded as follows:  
Switch  
AUX 1  
Circuit number  
CAC05  
Wire color  
Yellow  
Fuse  
30A  
AUX 2  
AUX 3  
AUX 4  
CAC06  
Green with  
Brown Trace  
Violet with  
Green Trace  
Brown  
30A  
CAC07  
10A  
CAC08  
15A  
More detailed information about Upfitter switches can be found at  
https://www.fleet.ford.com/truckbbas/.  
MOON ROOF (IF EQUIPPED)  
The moon roof control is located on the overhead console.  
WARNING: Do not let children play with the moon roof or leave  
children unattended in the vehicle. They may seriously hurt  
themselves.  
Note: The moon roof will open to  
the “comfort” position first before  
opening all the way. The “comfort”  
position helps to alleviate rumbling  
wind noise which may happen in the  
vehicle with the roof fully opened.  
To open the moon roof: The moon  
roof is equipped with a one-touch  
open feature. Press and release  
the  
control. The moon roof will open to the “comfort” position. Press  
138  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
and release the control again to fully open. To stop the one-touch open  
feature, press either the  
or  
control again.  
WARNING: When closing the moon roof, you should verify that  
it is free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or pets are  
not in the proximity of the moon roof opening.  
To close the moon roof: Press and hold the  
control until the glass  
panel stops at the “comfort” position. Press and hold the control again  
until the glass stops moving (the moon roof does not go to the comfort  
position). When fully closed, the rear portion of the glass panel will  
appear higher than the front portion.  
To vent the moon roof: Press and hold the  
control. The moon  
roof must be in the closed position in order to move it into the  
vent position. To close, press and hold the  
control until the glass  
panel stops moving.  
The moon roof has a built-in sliding shade that can be manually opened  
or closed when the glass panel is shut. To close the shade, pull it toward  
the front of the vehicle.  
HOMELINKWIRELESS CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The HomeLinkWireless Control  
System, located on the driver’s visor,  
provides a convenient way to  
replace up to three hand-held  
transmitters with a single built-in  
device. This feature will learn the  
radio frequency codes of most  
transmitters to operate garage  
doors, entry gate operators, security systems, entry door locks, and  
home or office lighting.  
WARNING: When programming your HomeLinkWireless  
Control System to a garage door or gate, be sure that people and  
objects are out of the way to prevent potential injury or damage.  
Do not use the HomeLinkWireless Control System with any garage  
door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by  
U.S. federal safety standards (this includes any garage door opener  
model manufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door which cannot  
139  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
detect an object, signaling the door to stop and reverse, does not meet  
current U.S. federal safety standards. For more information, contact  
HomeLinkat: www.homelink.com or 1–800–355–3515.  
Retain the original transmitter for use in other vehicles as well as for  
future programming procedures (i.e. new HomeLinkequipped vehicle  
purchase). It is also suggested that upon the sale of the vehicle, the  
programmed Homelinkbuttons be erased for security purposes, refer to  
Programming in this section.  
Programming  
Do not program HomeLinkwith the vehicle parked in the garage.  
Note: Your vehicle may require the ignition switch to be turned to the  
accessory position for programming and/or operation of the HomeLink.  
It is also recommended that a new battery be placed in the hand-held  
transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLinkfor quicker  
training and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal.  
1. Position the end of your  
hand-held transmitter 1–3 inches  
(2–8 cm) away from the HomeLink௡  
button you wish to program (located  
on your visor) while keeping the  
indicator light in view.  
2. Simultaneously press and hold  
both the chosen HomeLinkand  
hand-held transmitter buttons until the HomeLinkindicator light  
changes from a slow to a rapidly blinking light. Now you may release  
both the HomeLinkand hand-held transmitter buttons.  
Note: Some entry gates and garage door openers may require you to  
replace Step 2 with procedures noted in the Gate Operator and  
Canadian Programming in this section for Canadian residents.  
3. Firmly press and hold for five seconds and release the  
programmed HomeLinkbutton up to two separate times to activate the  
door. If the door does not activate, press and hold the just-trained  
HomeLinkbutton and observe the indicator light.  
If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete  
and your device should activate when the HomeLinkbutton is pressed  
and released.  
If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds and then turns  
to a constant light continue with “Programming” Steps 4 through  
6 to complete programming of a rolling code equipped device (most  
commonly a garage door opener).  
140  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
4. At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit) in the garage,  
locate the “learn” or “smart” button (usually near where the hanging  
antenna wire is attached to the unit).  
5. Firmly press and release the “learn” or “smart” button. (The name and  
color of the button may vary by manufacturer.)  
Note: There are 30 seconds in which to initiate Step 6.  
6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for two seconds and  
release the programmed HomeLinkbutton. Repeat the  
press/hold/release sequence again and, depending on the brand of the  
garage door opener (or other rolling code equipped device), repeat this  
sequence a third time to complete the programming.  
HomeLinkshould now activate your rolling code equipped device. To  
program additional HomeLinkbuttons begin with Step 1 in this section.  
For questions or comments, please contact HomeLinkat  
www.homelink.com or 1–800–355–3515.  
Gate Operator & Canadian Programming  
During programming, your  
hand-held transmitter may  
automatically stop transmitting —  
not allowing enough time for  
HomeLinkto accept the signal  
from the hand-held transmitter.  
After completing Step 1 outlined in  
the Programming section, replace  
Step 2 with the following:  
Note: If programming a garage door opener or gate operator, it is  
advised to unplug the device during the “cycling” process to prevent  
overheating.  
Continue to press and hold the HomeLinkbutton (note Step 2 in the  
Programming section) while you press and release — every two  
seconds (“cycle”) your hand-held transmitter until the frequency  
signal has been accepted by the HomeLink. The indicator light will  
flash slowly and then rapidly after HomeLinkaccepts the radio  
frequency signal.  
Proceed with Step 3 in the Programming section.  
141  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Operating the HomeLinkWireless Control System  
To operate, simply press and release  
the appropriate HomeLinkbutton.  
Activation will now occur for the  
trained product (garage door, gate  
operator, security system, entry  
door lock, or home or office lighting  
etc.). For convenience, the  
hand-held transmitter of the device  
may also be used at any time. In the event that there are still  
programming difficulties, contact HomeLinkat www.homelink.com or  
1–800–355–3515.  
Erasing HomeLinkbuttons  
To erase the three programmed  
buttons (individual buttons cannot  
be erased):  
Press and hold the two outer  
HomeLinkbuttons until the  
indicator light begins to  
flash-after 20 seconds. Release  
both buttons. Do not hold for  
longer that 30 seconds.  
HomeLinkis now in the train (or learning) mode and can be  
programmed at any time beginning with Step 1 in the Programming  
section.  
Reprogramming a single HomeLinkbutton  
To program a device to HomeLinkusing a HomeLinkbutton previously  
trained, follow these steps:  
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLinkbutton. Do NOT release the  
button.  
2. The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without  
releasing the HomeLinkbutton, follow Step 1 in the Programming  
section.  
For questions or comments, contact HomeLinkat www.homelink.com  
or 1–800–355–3515.  
142  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
TAILGATE LOCK (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a  
tailgate lock designed to help  
prevent theft of the tailgate.  
Insert ignition key and turn to the  
right to engage lock.  
Turn ignition key to the left to  
unlock.  
Tailgate removal  
Your tailgate is removable to allow more room for loading.  
WARNING: Always properly secure cargo to prevent shifting  
cargo or cargo falling from vehicle, which could result in  
compromised vehicle stability and serious personal injury to vehicle  
occupants or others.  
Note: If equipped with a rearview camera system (RCS), do Steps 1  
through 3 before removing the tailgate.  
1. Before removal of the tailgate,  
locate and disconnect the tailgate  
in-line connector under the pickup  
box on the passenger side of the  
vehicle near the spare tire.  
2. Install a protective cap (located  
in the glove box) onto the in-line  
RCS connector that remains under  
the pickup box.  
3. Partially lower tailgate and  
carefully feed tailgate harness up through the gap between the pickup  
box and the bumper. Place the tailgate harness out of the way under the  
pickup box.  
143  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
4. Lower the tailgate.  
5. Using a screwdriver, gently pry  
the spring clip (on each connector)  
past the head of the support screw.  
Disconnect cable.  
6. Disconnect the other cable.  
7. Lift tailgate to a 45-degree angle  
from horizontal.  
8. Lift right side off of its hinge.  
9. Lift tailgate to a 80-degree angle from horizontal.  
10. Remove tailgate from left side hinge by sliding tailgate to the right.  
To install, follow the removal procedures in reverse order.  
Tailgate step (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a feature that allows easier entry into  
the truck bed. To open the tailgate step:  
1. Flip down the tailgate.  
2. Pull the yellow latch lever to the  
unlock positon ( ) to release the  
grab handle from its stowed postion  
and raise the handle upright until  
you feel it latch and see the latch  
lever in the lock positon ( ). The  
yellow lever only needs to be used  
when releasing the grab handle.  
3. Rotate the center molding to  
unlatch the tailgate step and pull it  
towards you to extend it.  
4. Flip open the step panel to widen  
the step.  
Note: To reduce risk of falling:  
Operate step only when the  
vehicle is on level surface.  
Operate step only in areas with  
sufficient lighting  
Always open flip panel to widen step.  
144  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Always use grab handle when stepping up and down.  
Step not intended for bare-footed use.  
Keep step clean from contamination before use (e.g. snow, mud)  
Keep the step load (you + load) below 350 lb (159 kg).  
Never drive with step deployed.  
To close the tailgate step:  
1. Close the step panel, then lift and fully close the tailgate step into the  
tailgate.  
2. Slide the latch at the bottom of the handle, then lower the handle.  
Note:  
Fully close and latch the tailgate step before moving the vehicle.  
Never drive with the step or grab handle deployed.  
Replace slip resistance tape (serviceable item) if worn out.  
Replace handle molding (serviceable item) if damaged.  
Do not tow with grab handle or step frame.  
Bed extender (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a cargo management feature in the  
truck bed.  
Note: This feature is not intended for off-road usage.  
To open the bed extender into tailgate mode:  
1. Pull the locking pin toward the  
center of the vehicle.  
145  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
2. Open the latches to release the  
panels.  
3. Rotate the panels toward the  
tailgate.  
Repeat Steps 1–3 for the other side of the bed extender.  
4. Connect the two panels, then rotate both knobs a quarter-turn  
clockwise to secure the panels.  
146  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
5. Ensure the latch rod is inserted  
into the tailgate hole and the locking  
pins on both sides are engaged into  
their holes in the pick-up box.  
6. Reverse steps for storage of the  
bed extender.  
Note: When the vehicle is in motion, ensure the locking pins and knobs  
are fully engaged.  
Note: Ensure all cargo is secured.  
Note: When the vehicle is in motion, the tailgate load must not exceed  
150 lb (68 kg).  
Note: The bed extender should always be kept in the grocery mode or  
stowed position with the tailgate closed when not being used for the  
purpose of restraining cargo in the tailgate mode.  
To open the bed extender into grocery mode, follow Steps 1–4 by  
rotating the panels away from the tailgate. Close the tailgate.  
147  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
KEYS  
The key operates all locks on your vehicle. You should always carry a  
second key with you in a safe place in case you require it in an  
emergency.  
If your vehicle is equipped with the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft  
system, your keys are electronically coded to your vehicle; using a  
non-coded key will not permit your vehicle to start. If you lose your  
dealer supplied keys, replacement keys are available through your  
authorized dealer.  
POWER DOOR LOCKS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Press control to unlock all doors.  
Press control to lock all doors.  
Smart locks (if equipped)  
This feature prevents you from locking yourself out of the vehicle if your  
key is still in the ignition.  
When you open the driver’s door and you lock the vehicle with the  
power door lock control, all the doors will lock, then the driver’s door  
will automatically unlock reminding you that your key is still in the  
ignition.  
The vehicle can still be locked, with the key in the ignition, using the  
manual lock button on the door, locking the driver’s door with a key, by  
simultaneously pressing button 7 8 and the 9 0 controls on the  
remote entry keypad (if equipped), or using the  
remote entry transmitter (if equipped).  
button on the  
148  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Autolock feature (if equipped)  
The autolock feature will lock all the doors when:  
all the doors are closed,  
the ignition is in the on position,  
you shift into any gear putting the vehicle in motion, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h) for greater  
than two seconds.  
The autolock feature repeats when:  
any door is opened then closed while the ignition is in the on position  
and the vehicle speed is 9 mph (15 km/h) or lower, and  
the vehicle then attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h) for  
greater than two seconds.  
Deactivating/activating autolock feature  
There are four methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer,  
by using a power door unlock/lock procedure,  
using a keypad procedure (if equipped), or  
or by using the instrument cluster message center (if equipped). Refer  
to Optional message center in the Driver controls chapter.  
Note: The autolock feature can be activated/deactivated independently  
of the autounlock feature.  
Power door lock switch autolock enable/disable procedure  
Before starting, ensure the ignition is in the off position and all vehicle  
doors are closed. You must complete Steps 1–5 within 30 seconds or the  
procedure will have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be  
repeated, wait a minimum of 30 seconds before beginning again.  
1. Place the key in the ignition and  
turn the ignition to the on position.  
2. Press the power door unlock  
control on the door panel three  
times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on  
position to the off position.  
4. Press the power door unlock control on the door panel three times.  
149  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp one time  
to confirm programming mode has been entered and is active.  
6. To enable/disable the autolock feature, press the unlock control, then  
press the lock control. The horn will chirp once if autolock was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autolock was  
activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
Keyless entry keypad autolock enable/disable procedure  
1. Turn the ignition to the off  
position.  
2. Close all the doors.  
3. Enter factory–set 5–digit entry  
code.  
4. Press and hold the 3 4. While holding the 3 4 press the 7 8.  
5. Release the 7 8.  
6. Release the 3 4.  
The user should receive a horn chirp to indicate the system has been  
disabled or a chirp followed by a honk to indicate the system has been  
enabled.  
Autounlock feature (if equipped)  
The autounlock feature will unlock all the doors when:  
the ignition is in the on position, all the doors are closed, and the  
vehicle has been in motion at a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h);  
the vehicle has then come to a stop and the ignition is turned to the  
off ) or accessory position; and  
the driver door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being  
transitioned to the off or accessory position.  
Note: The doors will not autounlock if the vehicle has been  
electronically locked before the driver door is opened.  
Deactivating/activating autounlock feature  
There are three methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer,  
by using a power door unlock/lock sequence,  
150  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
using a keypad procedure (if equipped)  
Note: The autounlock feature can be activated/deactivated  
independently of the autolock feature.  
Power door lock switch autounlock enable/disable procedure  
Before starting, ensure the ignition is in the off position and all vehicle  
doors are closed. You must complete Steps 1–5 within 30 seconds or the  
procedure will have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be  
repeated, wait a minimum of 30 seconds before beginning again.  
1. Place the key in the ignition and  
turn the ignition to the on position.  
2. Press the power door unlock  
control on the door panel three  
times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on  
position to the off position.  
4. Press the power door unlock control on the door panel three times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp one time  
to confirm programming mode has been entered and is active.  
6. To enable/disable the autounlock feature, press the lock control, then  
press the unlock control. The horn will chirp once if autounlock was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autounlock was  
activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
Keyless entry keypad autounlock enable/disable procedure  
1. Turn the ignition to the off  
position.  
2. Close all the doors.  
3. Enter factory–set 5–digit entry  
code.  
4. Press and hold the 3 4. While holding the 3 4, press and release  
the 7 8. While still holding the 3 4, press and release the 7 8 a  
second time.  
5. Release the 3 4.  
The user should receive a horn chirp to indicate the system has been  
disabled or a chirp followed by a honk to indicate the system has been  
enabled.  
151  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
CHILDPROOF DOOR LOCKS (IF EQUIPPED)  
When these locks are set, the  
rear doors cannot be opened from  
the inside.  
The rear doors can be opened  
from the outside when the doors  
are unlocked.  
The childproof locks are located on  
rear edge of each rear door and  
must be set separately for each  
door. Setting the lock for one door  
will not automatically set the lock  
for both doors.  
Move lock control up to engage  
the childproof lock.  
Move lock control down to  
disengage the childproof lock.  
REMOTE ENTRY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and with RS-210 of  
Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device  
must accept any interference received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
The typical operating range for your remote entry transmitter is  
approximately 33 feet (10 meters). A decrease in operating range could  
be caused by:  
weather conditions,  
nearby radio towers,  
structures around the vehicle, or  
other vehicles parked next to your vehicle.  
152  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Your vehicle is equipped with a remote entry system which allows you to:  
unlock the vehicle doors without  
a key.  
lock all the vehicle doors without  
a key.  
activate the personal alarm.  
If there are problems with the  
remote entry system, make sure to  
take ALL remote entry  
transmitters with you to your  
authorized dealer in order to aid in  
troubleshooting the problem.  
Two step door unlocking  
1. Press  
and release to unlock the driver’s door. Note: The parking  
lamps and interior lamps will illuminate (refer to the Illuminated entry  
feature later in this section) if the control on the overhead lamp is not  
set to the off position.  
2. Press  
and release again within three seconds to unlock the  
passenger doors.  
The battery saver feature will turn off the lamps 10 minutes after the  
ignition is turned to the off position.  
One step door unlocking  
If the one step door unlocking feature is activated, press  
and release  
once to unlock all of the doors. Note: The parking lamps and interior  
lamps will illuminate (refer to the Illuminated entry feature later in this  
section) if the control on the overhead lamp is not set to the off position.  
Switching from two step to one step door unlocking  
Your vehicle comes with two step unlocking enabled. Unlocking can be  
switched between two step and one step door unlocking by pressing and  
holding both the  
and  
buttons simultaneously on the remote entry  
transmitter for approximately four seconds. The hazard lamps will flash  
twice to indicate that the vehicle has switched to one step unlocking.  
Repeat the procedure to switch back to two-step unlocking.  
Locking the doors  
1. Press  
and release to lock all the doors. The parking lamps will  
illuminate if all the doors are closed and locked.  
153  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
2. Press  
and release again within three seconds to confirm that all  
the doors are closed and locked. Note: The doors will lock again, the  
horn will chirp once, and the parking lamps will illuminate once more.  
If any of the doors are not properly closed the horn will make two quick  
chirps and the parking lamps will not flash.  
Car finder  
Press  
twice within three seconds. The horn will chirp and the turn  
lamps will flash. It is recommended that this method be used to locate  
your vehicle, rather than using the panic alarm.  
Sounding a panic alarm  
Press to activate the alarm. Press again or turn the ignition to on to  
deactivate.  
Note: The panic alarm will only operate when the ignition is in the off  
position.  
Memory seats/adjustable pedals/mirrors (if equipped)  
The remote entry system can also control the memory seat/adjustable  
pedals/mirrors.  
Press  
to automatically move the seat, adjustable pedals and mirrors to  
the desired memory position (the seat position corresponds to the  
transmitter being used).  
Activating the memory feature  
To activate this feature:  
1. Position the seat, adjustable pedals and mirrors to the position  
desired.  
2. Press and hold either memory 1  
button or memory 2 button for five  
seconds. A tone will be heard after  
112 seconds when the memory store  
is done, continue to hold until a  
second tone is heard after five  
seconds.  
3. Within three seconds press  
the  
button on the keyfob.  
The keyfob unlock will now recall  
the memory position.  
154  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Deactivating the memory feature  
To deactivate this feature:  
1. Press and hold either memory 1 button or memory 2 button for five  
seconds. A tone will be heard after 112 seconds when the memory store  
is done, continue to hold until a second tone is heard after five seconds.  
2. Within three seconds press the  
button on the keyfob  
The keyfob unlock will not recall the memory position.  
Replacing the battery  
The remote entry transmitter uses one coin type three-volt lithium  
battery CR2032 or equivalent.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Twist a thin coin between the two  
halves of the remote entry  
transmitter near the key ring. DO  
NOT TAKE THE RUBBER COVER  
AND CIRCUIT BOARD OFF THE  
FRONT HOUSING OF THE  
REMOTE ENTRY TRANSMITTER.  
2. Do not wipe off any grease on the  
battery terminals on the back  
surface of the circuit board.  
3. Remove the old battery.  
Note: Please refer to local  
regulations when disposing of  
transmitter batteries.  
4. Insert the new battery. Refer to  
the diagram inside the remote entry  
transmitter for the correct  
orientation of the battery. Press the battery down to ensure that the  
battery is fully seated in the battery housing cavity.  
5. Snap the two halves back together.  
Note: Replacement of the battery will not cause the remote transmitter  
to become deprogrammed from your vehicle. The remote transmitter  
should operate normally after battery replacement.  
155  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Replacing lost remote entry transmitters  
If you would like to have your remote entry transmitter reprogrammed  
because you lost one, or would like to buy additional remote entry  
transmitters, you can either reprogram them yourself, or take all  
remote entry transmitters to your authorized dealer for  
reprogramming.  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with the memory seats/power  
mirrors/adjustable pedals feature, you can associate a remote entry  
transmitter to each memory position using this procedure. The first  
transmitter that is programmed will recall Driver 1 settings, and the  
second transmitter that is programmed will recall Driver 2 settings.  
How to program your remote entry transmitters  
You must have all remote keyless entry keypads and remote entry  
transmitters (maximum of four) available before beginning this  
procedure. Note: Do not press the brake pedal anytime during this  
sequencing, as doing so will invalidate the procedure.  
To reprogram the remote entry  
transmitters:  
1. Ensure the vehicle is  
electronically unlocked.  
2. Put the key in the ignition.  
3. Cycle eight times rapidly (within  
10 seconds) between the off  
position and on.  
Note: The eighth turn must end in  
the on position. The doors will lock,  
then unlock, to confirm that the programming mode has been activated.  
4. Within 20 seconds press any button on the remote entry transmitter.  
Note: If more than 20 seconds have passed you will need to start the  
procedure over again. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that  
this remote entry transmitter has been programmed.  
5. Repeat Step 4 to program each additional remote entry transmitter.  
6. Turn the ignition to the off position after you have finished  
programming all of the remote entry transmitters.  
Note: After 20 seconds, you will automatically exit the programming  
mode. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that the programming  
mode has been exited.  
156  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Illuminated entry  
The interior lamps and parking lamps illuminate when the remote entry  
system is used to unlock the door(s).  
The illuminated entry system will turn off the lights if:  
the ignition switch is turned to the on position, or  
the remote transmitter lock control is pressed, or  
the 7 8 and the 9 0 controls on the keyless entry keypad are  
pressed, or  
after 25 seconds of illumination.  
The dome lamp control (if equipped) must not be set to the off position  
for the illuminated entry system to operate.  
The lights will not turn off if:  
they have been turned on with the dimmer control, or  
any door is open.  
The battery saver will shut off the interior lamps 30 minutes after the  
ignition has been turned to the off position, 10 minutes after if the dome  
lamp is off, and 30 minutes after if the dome lamp switch is left on.  
SECURICODE™ KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM  
You can use the keyless entry  
keypad to lock or unlock the doors  
without using a key.  
The keypad can be operated with  
the factory set 5–digit entry code;  
this code is located on the owner’s wallet card in the glove box, is  
marked on the computer module, and is available from your authorized  
dealer. You can also create your own 5–digit personal entry code.  
When pressing the controls on the keypad, press the middle of the  
controls to ensure a good activation.  
Programming a personal entry code and keypad association to  
memory seats, mirrors and pedals  
To create your own personal entry code:  
1. Enter the factory set code.  
2. Within five seconds press the 1 2 on the keypad.  
3. Enter your personal 5-digit code. Each number must be entered  
within five seconds of each other.  
157  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
4. To associate the entry code with a memory setting, enter a sixth digit  
to indicate which driver should be set in a memory recalled by the  
personal entry code:  
Pressing 1 2 recalls Driver 1 settings.  
Pressing 3 4 recalls Driver 2 settings.  
Pressing other keypad buttons or not pressing a keypad button as a  
sixth digit does not set a driver and will not recall a memory setting.  
Note: The factory-set code cannot be associated with a memory  
setting.  
5. The doors will again lock then unlock to confirm that your personal  
keycode has been programmed to the module.  
Tips:  
Do not set a code that uses five of the same number.  
Do not use five numbers in sequential order.  
The factory set code will work even if you have set your own personal  
code.  
Erasing personal code  
1. Enter the factory set 5–digit code.  
2. Within five seconds, press the 1 2 on the keypad and release.  
3. Press and hold the 1 2 for two seconds. This must be done within  
five seconds of completing Step 2.  
Your personal code is now erased and only the factory set 5–digit code  
will work.  
Anti-scan feature  
If an incorrect code has been entered seven times (35 consecutive  
button presses), the keypad will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode  
disables the keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp will flash during  
this time.  
The anti-scan feature will turn off after:  
one minute of keypad inactivity.  
pressing the  
control on the remote entry transmitter.  
the ignition is turned to the on position.  
158  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Unlocking and locking the doors using keyless entry  
To unlock the driver’s door, enter the factory set 5-digit code or your  
personal code. Each number must be pressed within five seconds of each  
other. The interior lamps will illuminate after entering a valid keypad  
entry code.  
To unlock all doors, press the 3 4 control within five seconds.  
To lock all doors, press the 7 8 and the 9 0 at the same time. You  
do not need to enter the keypad code first. Note: The interior lamps  
will turn off.  
SECURILOCKPASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is an engine immobilization  
system. This system is designed to help prevent the engine from being  
started unless a coded key programmed to your vehicle is used. The  
use of the wrong type of coded key may lead to a “no-start” condition.  
Your vehicle comes with two coded keys; additional coded keys may be  
purchased from your authorized dealer. The authorized dealer can  
program your spare keys to your vehicle or you can program the keys  
yourself. Refer to Programming spare keys for instructions on how to  
program the coded key.  
Note: The SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is not compatible with  
non-Ford aftermarket remote start systems. Use of these systems may  
result in vehicle starting problems and a loss of security protection.  
Note: Large metallic objects, electronic devices that are used to  
purchase gasoline or similar items, or a second coded key on the same  
key chain may cause vehicle starting issues. You need to prevent these  
objects from touching the coded key while starting the engine. These  
objects will not cause damage to the coded key, but may cause a  
momentary issue if they are too close to the key when starting the  
engine. If a problem occurs, turn the ignition off, remove all objects on  
the key chain away from the coded key and restart the engine.  
Note: Do not leave a duplicate coded key in the vehicle. Always  
take your keys and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle.  
159  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Anti-theft indicator  
The anti-theft indicator is located in the instrument cluster.  
Vehicles equipped with the  
SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft  
system behave as follows:  
When the ignition is in the off  
position, the indicator will flash once every two seconds for a total of  
10 seconds to indicate the SecuriLocksystem is functioning as a  
theft deterrent.  
When the ignition is in the on position, the indicator will glow for  
three seconds to indicate a programmed key has been validated and  
the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft system has enabled the engine.  
Vehicles without the SecuriLockPassive Anti-theft system behave as  
follows:  
When the ignition is in the off position, the indicator will not flash.  
When the ignition is in the on position, the indicator will glow for  
three seconds to indicate the engine is enabled.  
Automatic arming  
The vehicle is armed immediately after switching the ignition to the off  
position.  
The theft indicator will flash every  
two seconds to act as a theft  
deterrent when the vehicle is  
armed.  
Automatic disarming  
Switching the ignition to the on position with a coded key disarms the  
vehicle.  
Replacement keys  
If your keys are lost or stolen and you don’t have an extra coded key,  
you will need to have your vehicle towed to an authorized dealer. The  
key codes need to be erased from your vehicle and new coded keys will  
need to be programmed.  
Replacing coded keys can be very costly. Store an extra programmed key  
away from the vehicle in a safe place to help prevent any  
inconveniences. Please visit an authorized dealer to purchase additional  
spare or replacement keys.  
160  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Programming spare keys  
A maximum of eight keys can be coded to your vehicle. Only  
SecuriLockkeys can be used. To program a coded key yourself, you  
will need two previously programmed coded keys (keys that already  
operate your vehicle’s engine) and the new unprogrammed key(s) readily  
accessible for timely implementation of each step in the procedure.  
If two previously programmed coded keys are not available, you must  
bring your vehicle to your authorized dealer to have the spare coded  
key(s) programmed.  
Please read and understand the entire procedure before you begin.  
1. Insert the first previously  
programmed coded key into the  
ignition and turn the ignition from  
the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on)  
position (maintain ignition in the 3  
(on) position for at least one  
second, but no more than  
10 seconds).  
2. Turn ignition from the 3 (on)  
position back to the 1 (off) position  
in order to remove the first coded  
key from the ignition.  
3. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of removing the first coded  
key, insert the second previously programmed coded key into the  
ignition and turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on)  
position (maintain ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least one second  
but no more than 10 seconds).  
4. Turn the ignition from the 3 (on) position back to the 1 (off) position  
in order to remove the second coded key from the ignition.  
5. After three seconds but within 10 seconds of removing the second  
coded key, insert the new unprogrammed key (new key/valet key) into  
the ignition and turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on)  
position (maintain ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least one second,  
but no more than 10 seconds). This step will program your new key to a  
coded key.  
6. To program additional new unprogrammed key(s), repeat Steps 1  
through 5.  
If successful, the new coded key(s) will start the vehicle’s engine and the  
theft indicator will illuminate for three seconds and then go out.  
161  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
If not successful, the new coded key(s) will not start the vehicle’s engine  
and the theft indicator will flash on and off and you may repeat Steps 1  
through 5. If failure repeats, bring your vehicle to your authorized dealer  
to have the new spare key(s) programmed.  
PERIMETER ALARM SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The perimeter anti-theft system will warn you in the event of an  
unauthorized entry to your vehicle.  
If there is any potential perimeter anti-theft problem with your vehicle,  
ensure ALL remote entry transmitters are taken to the authorized  
dealer to aid in troubleshooting.  
Arming the system  
When armed, this system will respond if unauthorized entry is  
attempted. When unauthorized entry occurs, the system will flash the  
park/turn lamps and will sound the horn.  
The system is ready to arm whenever the key is removed from the  
ignition. Either of the following actions will prearm the alarm system:  
Press the  
control on the remote entry transmitter.  
Open a door and press the power door lock control to lock all the  
doors, and then close the door.  
Disarming the system  
You can disarm the system by any of the following actions:  
Unlock the doors by pressing the  
control on your remote entry  
transmitter.  
Turn the ignition to the on position with a programmed coded ignition  
key.  
Triggering the anti-theft system  
The armed system will be triggered if any door or hood is opened  
without using the key or the remote entry transmitter.  
162  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SEATING  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to  
reduce the risk of injury in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
Non-adjustable head restraints  
Your vehicle is equipped with front row outboard non-adjustable head  
restraints.  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, the driver and passenger occupants should not sit in  
and/or operate the vehicle, until the seatback is placed in its proper  
position. The driver should never adjust the seatback while the vehicle  
is in motion.  
The non-adjustable head restraints  
consist of a trimmed foam covering  
over the upper structure of the  
seatback.  
Properly adjust the seatback to an upright driving/riding position, so that  
the head restraint is positioned as close as possible to the back of your  
head.  
163  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Full bench seat (if equipped)  
Lift the release bar to move the  
seat forward or backward. Ensure  
that the seat is relatched into  
place.  
Pull up on the lever located at  
the bottom of the seatback to  
quickly fold the seatback forward.  
Pull up on the lever located at  
the side of the seat cushion to  
recline the seatback and to return  
the seat to the upright position.  
40/20/40 split bench seat (if equipped)  
Lift the track release bar to move  
the seat forward or backward.  
Ensure the seat is relatched into  
place.  
Pull the handle on the side of the  
seat up to recline the seat.  
Push down the lever located at  
the bottom of the seatback to  
quickly fold the seatback forward.  
164  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
40/20/40 front seat armrest and console (if equipped)  
To release the armrest, pull forward  
on the strap and pull the armrest  
down.  
To gain access to the storage  
compartment in your armrest, lift  
the latch to open the lid. The lid  
cannot be opened in the upright  
position.  
Lift up armrest to return it to a  
center seatback.  
165  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Captain’s chair (if equipped)  
Lift the bar to move the seat  
forward or rearward. Make sure  
that the seat is relatched into  
place.  
To recline the seatback, pull the  
release lever handle located on  
the side of the seat up.  
Push down the lever (if  
equipped) located at the bottom  
of the seatback to quickly fold the  
seatback forward.  
Adjusting the front power seat (if equipped)  
WARNING: Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatback when the  
vehicle is moving.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to avoid  
injuring people in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
The control is located on the outboard side of the seat cushion.  
166  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Press front to raise or lower the  
front portion of the seat cushion.  
Press rear to raise or lower the rear  
portion of the seat cushion.  
Press the control to move the seat  
forward, backward, up or down.  
Using the manual lumbar support  
The lumbar support control is  
located on the outboard side of the  
seat  
Turn the lumbar support clockwise  
for more support.  
Turn the lumbar support  
counterclockwise for less support.  
167  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Heated seats (if equipped)  
The heated seat control is located on the climate control panel.  
WARNING: Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin  
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes, spinal cord  
injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical  
conditions, must exercise care when using the seat heater. The seat  
heater may cause burns even at low temperatures, especially if used  
for long periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that  
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion, because this may  
cause the seat heater to overheat. Do not puncture the seat with pins,  
needles, or other pointed objects because this may damage the heating  
element which may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated  
seat may cause serious personal injury.  
Note: Do not do the following:  
Place heavy objects on the seat.  
Operate the seat heater if water or any other liquid is spilled on the  
seat. Allow the seat to dry thoroughly.  
To operate the heated seats, do the following (engine must be running):  
Press  
to activate; push  
again to deactivate.  
The indicator light on the control will illuminate when activated.  
Memory seats/power mirrors/adjustable pedals (if equipped)  
This system allows automatic  
positioning of the driver seat, power  
mirrors, and adjustable pedals to  
two programmable positions.  
The memory seat control is located  
on the driver door.  
To save memory positions:  
1. Place the key in the ignition to  
move the features to the drive  
position.  
2. Move all the memory features to the desired positions.  
3. Press and hold one of the memory buttons for approximately two  
seconds.  
4. A tone will be heard when the memory save is complete.  
168  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To recall a memory position:  
Press and release either memory 1 button or memory 2 button.  
A position can be recalled:  
in any gearshift position if the ignition is not in the on position.  
only in P (Park) or N (Neutral) if the ignition is in the on position.  
A memory seat position may be programmed at any time.  
The memory positions are also recalled when you press your remote  
entry transmitter  
(unlock) control (if the transmitter is programmed  
to a memory position) or, when you enter a valid personal entry code  
that is programmed to a memory position.  
To program the memory feature to a remote entry transmitter and for  
more information on how to use the keypad, refer to Remote entry  
system in the Locks and Security chapter.  
REAR SEATS  
Adjustable head restraints (if equipped)  
The purpose of these head restraints is to help limit head motion in the  
event of a rear collision. To properly adjust your head restraints, lift the  
head restraint so that it is located directly behind your head or as close  
to that position as possible.  
The head restraints can be moved  
up and down. Lift the head restraint  
so that it is located directly or as  
close as possible behind your head.  
169  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Push control to lower head restraint.  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, the driver and passenger occupants should not sit in  
and/or operate the vehicle, until the head restraint is placed in its  
proper position. The driver should never adjust the head restraint  
while the vehicle is in motion.  
Cabela’sseat  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Cabela’s seat, you will not have the  
load floor option. A lockable stowage box is located under the rear seat.  
For more information on the stowage box, see Center  
console/under-seat storage-Cabela’s edition in the Driver controls  
chapter.  
Rear folding seat system with load floor (if equipped)  
The rear seatback has a split 60/40 seat. Each seat cushion can be  
flipped up into the seatback position.  
Note: The Crew Cab rear 60/40 split bench seatback is not intended to  
support a cargo load in the forward-folded position.  
To fold the seatback down, pull  
down the latch lever located on the  
bottom seatback to fold the  
seatback forward.  
170  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To flip the seat cushion up, pull  
up on the lever located on the side  
of the seat cushion to rotate the  
cushion up until it locks into a  
vertical storage position, gaining  
access to the grocery hook located  
on the underside of the driver-side  
seat cushion. The maximum load is  
25 lb. (11 kg).  
Returning the seat to seating position  
Pull lever on the side of the seat to release seat cushion from storage  
position.  
Push seat cushion down until it locks into horizontal position.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
underneath the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
To gain access to the cupholders  
and tray, pull down on the armrest.  
171  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To gain access to the 60/40 load  
floor, store the cushion in the  
upright locked position. Pull up on  
the straps located at the sides of the  
load floor, and rotate forward until  
resting on the carpet.  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS  
Safety restraints precautions  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of injury, make sure children sit  
in a rear seating position where they can be properly restrained.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an  
airbag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in  
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not  
allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped  
with seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a  
seat and using a safety belt properly.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a safety  
belt.  
172  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific  
safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one  
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt  
on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the  
arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside  
shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: Safety belts and seats can become hot in a vehicle  
that has been closed up in sunny weather; they could burn a  
small child. Check seat covers and buckles before you place a child  
anywhere near them.  
WARNING: Front and rear seat occupants, including pregnant  
women, should wear safety belts for optimum protection in an  
accident.  
Combination lap and shoulder belts  
1. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) until you hear a snap and feel  
it latch. Make sure the tongue is  
securely fastened in the buckle.  
173  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. To unfasten, push the release  
button and remove the tongue from  
the buckle.  
Vehicle sensitive mode  
Combination lap and shoulder belts in normal retractor mode allow free  
shoulder belt length adjustment to your movements and locking in  
response to vehicle movement. For example, if the driver brakes  
suddenly or turns a corner sharply, or the vehicle receives an impact of  
approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) or more, the combination safety belts will  
lock to help reduce forward movement of the driver and passengers.  
Belt sensitive mode  
Combination lap and shoulder belts can also be made to lock manually by  
quickly pulling on the shoulder belt.  
Automatic locking mode  
When to use the automatic locking mode  
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The belt will  
still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The automatic  
locking mode is not available on the driver safety belt.  
This mode should be used any time a child safety seat (except a  
booster) is installed in a passenger front or outboard rear seating  
position (if equipped). Children 12 years old and under should be  
properly restrained in the rear seat whenever possible. Refer to Safety  
restraints for children or Safety seats for children later in this chapter.  
174  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How to use the automatic locking mode  
Buckle the combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
Grasp the shoulder portion and  
pull downward until the entire  
belt is pulled out.  
Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will hear a clicking  
sound. This indicates the safety belt is now in the automatic locking  
mode.  
How to disengage the automatic locking mode  
Disconnect the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it to retract  
completely to disengage the automatic locking mode and activate the  
vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode.  
WARNING: After any vehicle collision, the front passenger and  
rear outboard safety belt systems must be checked by an  
authorized dealer to verify that the “automatic locking retractor”  
feature for child seats is still functioning properly. In addition, all safety  
belts should be checked for proper function.  
175  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: BELT AND RETRACTOR ASSEMBLY MUST BE  
REPLACED if the safety belt assembly “automatic locking  
retractor” feature or any other safety belt function is not operating  
properly when checked by an authorized dealer. Failure to replace the  
belt and retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in  
collisions.  
Energy management feature  
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an energy management  
feature at the front outboard seating positions to help further reduce  
the risk of injury in the event of a head-on collision.  
The front outboard safety belt systems have a retractor assembly that  
is designed to pay out webbing in a controlled manner. This feature is  
designed to help reduce the belt force acting on the occupant’s chest.  
Safety belt pretensioner  
Your vehicle is equipped with safety belt retractor pretensioners at the  
driver and front outboard passenger seating positions.  
The driver and front outboard passenger safety belt pretensioners are  
designed to activate only during certain frontal or near-frontal collisions  
with sufficient longitudinal deceleration. A safety belt pretensioner is a  
device which tightens the webbing of the lap and shoulder belts during  
some collisions in such a way that they fit more snugly against the body.  
The driver and front outboard passenger safety belt system (including  
retractors, buckles and height adjusters) must be replaced if the vehicle  
is involved in a collision that results in the activation of the safety belt  
pretensioners. Refer to the Safety belt maintenance section in this  
chapter.  
WARNING: Failure to replace the safety belt assembly under  
the above conditions could result in severe personal injuries in  
the event of a collision.  
176  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Front safety belt height adjustment  
The front outboard seating positions are equipped with safety belt height  
adjusters.  
Adjust the height of the shoulder belt so the belt rests across the middle  
of your shoulder.  
WARNING: Position the safety belt height adjusters so that the  
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust  
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the seat belt  
and increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
To adjust the shoulder belt height,  
push the button and slide the height  
adjuster up or down. Release the  
button and pull down on the height  
adjuster to make sure it is locked in  
place.  
Safety belt with cinch tongue (Regular cab center seating position  
and Super Cab/Crew Cab rear center seating positions)  
The cinch tongue will slide up and down the belt webbing when the belt  
is stowed or while putting safety belts on. When the lap/shoulder safety  
belt is buckled, the cinch tongue will allow the lap portion to be  
shortened, but pinches the webbing to keep the lap portion from getting  
longer. The cinch tongue is designed to slip during a crash, so always  
wear the shoulder belt properly and don’t allow any slack in either the  
lap or shoulder portions.  
Before you can reach and latch a combination lap and shoulder belt  
having a cinch tongue into the buckle, you may have to lengthen the lap  
belt portion of it.  
177  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
1. To lengthen the lap belt, pull  
some webbing out of the shoulder  
belt retractor.  
2. While holding the webbing below  
the tongue, grasp the tip (metal  
portion) of the tongue so that it is  
parallel to the webbing and slide the  
tongue upward.  
3. Provide enough lap belt length so that the tongue can reach the  
buckle.  
How to fasten the cinch tongue (Regular cab center seating  
position and Super Cab/Crew Cab rear center seating positions)  
1. Pull the combination lap and shoulder belt from the retractor so that  
the shoulder belt portion of the safety belt crosses your shoulder and  
chest.  
2. Be sure the belt is not twisted. If the belt is twisted, remove the twist.  
3. Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle for your seating position  
until you hear a snap and feel it latch.  
4. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened to the buckle by pulling on  
the tongue.  
WARNING: The lap belt should fit snugly and as low as possible  
around the hips, not across the waist.  
While you are fastened in the safety belt, the combination lap/shoulder  
belt with a cinch tongue adjusts to your movement. However, if you  
brake hard, turn hard, or if your vehicle receives an impact of 5 mph  
(8 km/h) or more, the safety belt will become locked and help reduce  
your forward movement.  
178  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Lap belts  
Adjusting the lap belt  
WARNING: The lap belt should fit snugly and as low as possible  
around the hips, not across the waist.  
1st row center seating position on SuperCab and Crew Cab  
The lap belt does not adjust automatically.  
Insert the tongue into the correct  
buckle (the buckle closest to the  
direction the tongue is coming  
from). To lengthen the belt, turn the  
tongue at a right angle to the belt  
and pull across your lap until it  
reaches the buckle. To tighten the  
belt, pull the loose end of the belt  
through the tongue until it fits  
snugly across the hips.  
Shorten and fasten the belt when  
not in use.  
Safety belt warning light and indicator chime  
The safety belt warning light illuminates in the instrument cluster and a  
chime sounds to remind the occupants to fasten their safety belts.  
179  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Conditions of operation  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s safety belt is not  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light  
illuminates 1-2 minutes and the  
warning chime sounds 4-8 seconds.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
The safety belt warning light and  
buckled while the indicator light warning chime turn off.  
is illuminated and the warning  
chime is sounding...  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light and  
indicator chime remain off.  
Belt-Minderா  
The Belt-Minderfeature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt  
warning function. This feature provides additional reminders to the  
driver that the driver’s safety belt is unbuckled by intermittently  
sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning lamp in the  
instrument cluster.  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s safety belt is not  
buckled before the vehicle has  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated -  
the safety belt warning light illuminates  
reached at least 3 mph (5 km/h) and the warning chime sounds for  
and 1-2 minutes have elapsed  
since the ignition switch has  
6 seconds every 30 seconds, repeating  
for approximately 5 minutes or until  
been turned to the on position... safety belt is buckled.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled while the safety belt  
indicator light is illuminated and  
the safety belt warning chime is  
sounding...  
The Belt-Minderfeature will not  
activate.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The Belt-Minderfeature will not  
activate.  
180  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The following are reasons most often given for not wearing safety belts  
(All statistics based on U.S. data):  
Reasons given...  
Consider...  
“Crashes are rare events”  
36700 crashes occur every day. The  
more we drive, the more we are  
exposed to “rare” events, even for good  
drivers. 1 in 4 of us will be seriously  
injured in a crash during our  
lifetime.  
“I’m not going far”  
3 of 4 fatal crashes occur within 25  
miles (40 km) of home.  
“Belts are uncomfortable”  
We design our safety belts to enhance  
comfort. If you are uncomfortable - try  
different positions for the safety belt  
upper anchorage and seatback which  
should be as upright as possible; this  
can improve comfort.  
“I was in a hurry”  
Prime time for an accident.  
Belt-Minderreminds us to take a few  
seconds to buckle up.  
“Safety belts don’t work”  
Safety belts, when used properly,  
reduce risk of death to front seat  
occupants by 45% in cars, and by  
60% in light trucks.  
“Traffic is light”  
Nearly 1 of 2 deaths occur in  
single-vehicle crashes, many when  
no other vehicles are around.  
“Belts wrinkle my clothes”  
Possibly, but a serious crash can do  
much more than wrinkle your clothes,  
particularly if you are unbelted.  
“The people I’m with don’t wear Set the example, teen deaths occur 4  
belts”  
times more often in vehicles with TWO  
or MORE people. Children and younger  
brothers/sisters imitate behavior they  
see.  
181  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Reasons given...  
Consider...  
“I have an airbag”  
Airbags offer greater protection when  
used with safety belts. Frontal airbags  
are not designed to inflate in rear and  
side crashes or rollovers.  
“I’d rather be thrown clear”  
Not a good idea. People who are  
ejected are 40 times more likely to  
DIE. Safety belts help prevent ejection,  
WE CAN’T “PICK OUR CRASH”.  
WARNING: Do not sit on top of a buckled safety belt or insert a  
latchplate into the buckle to avoid the Belt-Minderchime. To  
do so may adversely affect the performance of the vehicle’s airbag  
system.  
One-time disable  
Any time the safety belt is buckled and then unbuckled during an ignition  
on cycle, the Belt-Minderwill be disabled for that ignition cycle only.  
Deactivating/activating the Belt-Minderfeature (Driver only)  
The Belt-Minderfeature can be deactivated/activated by performing the  
following procedure:  
Before following the procedure, make sure that the following conditions  
are met:  
the parking brake is set  
the gearshift is in P (Park) (automatic transmission) or the neutral  
position (manual transmission)  
the ignition switch is in the off position  
all vehicle doors are closed  
the driver’s safety belt is unbuckled  
the parklamps/headlamps are in the off position (If the vehicle is  
equipped with Autolamps, this will not affect the procedure)  
WARNING: While the design allows you to deactivate your  
Belt-Minder, this system is designed to improve your chances of  
being safely belted and surviving an accident. We recommend you  
leave the Belt-Mindersystem activated for yourself and others who  
may use the vehicle. To reduce the risk of injury, do not  
deactivate/activate the Belt-Minderfeature while driving the vehicle.  
182  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Belt-Minderactivation and deactivation procedure  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the on position. (DO NOT START THE  
ENGINE)  
2. Wait until the safety belt warning light turns off. (Approximately  
1 minute)  
Step 3 must be completed within 60 seconds after the safety belt  
warning light turns off.  
3. Buckle then unbuckle the safety belt 9 times at a moderate speed,  
ending with the safety belt in the unbuckled state.  
After Step 3 is complete, the safety belt warning light will be turned  
on for 3 seconds.  
If Step 4 does not occur within 10 seconds at the end of Step 3,  
Belt-Minderwill automatically exit programming mode without  
changing its enable status.  
4. Within 7 seconds of the light turning on, at a moderate speed, buckle  
then unbuckle the safety belt.  
This will disable the Belt-Minderfeature if it is currently enabled. As  
confirmation, the safety belt warning light will flash 4 times per  
second for 3 seconds.  
This will enable the Belt-Minderfeature if it is currently disabled. As  
confirmation, the safety belt warning light will flash 4 times per  
second for 3 seconds, followed by 3 seconds with the light off, then  
followed by the safety belt warning light flashing 4 times per second  
for 3 seconds again.  
5. After receiving confirmation, the deactivation/activation procedure is  
complete.  
Safety belt extension assembly  
If the safety belt is too short when fully extended, there is an 8 inch  
(20 cm) safety belt extension assembly that can be added (part number  
611C22). This assembly can be obtained from an authorized dealer.  
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety  
belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of the webbing on  
the label. Also, use the safety belt extension only if the safety belt is too  
short for you when fully extended.  
WARNING: Do not use extensions to change the fit of the  
shoulder belt across the torso.  
183  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
AIRBAG SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)  
Important SRS precautions  
The SRS is designed to work with  
the safety belt to help protect the  
driver and right front passenger  
from certain upper body injuries.  
Airbags DO NOT inflate slowly;  
there is a risk of injury from a  
deploying airbag.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) recommends a minimum distance of at least 10 inches  
(25 cm) between an occupant’s chest and the driver airbag module.  
184  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Never place your arm over the airbag module as a  
deploying airbag can result in serious arm fractures or other  
injuries.  
To properly position yourself away from the airbag:  
Move your seat to the rear as far as you can while still reaching the  
pedals comfortably.  
Recline the seat slightly one or two degrees from the upright position.  
WARNING: Do not put anything on or over the airbag module.  
Placing objects on or over the airbag inflation area may cause  
those objects to be propelled by the airbag into your face and torso  
causing serious injury.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag supplemental restraint systems or its fuses. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: The front passenger airbag is not designed to offer  
protection to an occupant in the center front seating position.  
WARNING: Modifying or adding equipment to the front end of  
the vehicle (including frame, bumper, front end body structure  
and tow hooks) may affect the performance of the airbag system,  
increasing the risk of injury. Do not modify the front end of the  
vehicle.  
WARNING: Additional equipment such as snowplow equipment  
may effect the performance of the airbag sensors increasing the  
risk of injury. Please refer to the Body Builders Layout Book for  
instructions about the appropriate installation of additional equipment.  
185  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and airbags  
For additional important safety information, read all information on  
safety restraints in this guide.  
Children must always be properly restrained. Failure to follow these  
instructions may increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
WARNING: An infant in a rear-facing seat faces a high risk of  
serious or fatal injuries from a deploying passenger airbag. Rear  
facing infant seats should NEVER be placed in the front seats, unless  
the passenger airbag is turned off. See Passenger airbag ON/OFF  
switch.  
WARNING: Front seating positions only: If seating two adults  
and a child, Ford recommends properly restraining the child in  
the center front seating position, but only if doing so will not interfere  
with driving the vehicle. This arrangement provides lap and shoulder  
belt and airbag protection for adult occupants and an attachment  
method for a child restraint. If the child seat interferes with driving the  
vehicle and the child restraint is forward-facing, the child may be  
restrained in the passenger seat. Move the seat as far rearward as  
possible to minimize the likelihood of interaction with the front  
passenger airbag. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an  
active airbag. Always properly restrain all occupants, including the  
child in an appropriate child seat or booster.  
How does the airbag supplemental restraint system work?  
The airbag SRS is designed to  
activate when the vehicle sustains  
sufficient longitudinal deceleration.  
The fact that the airbags did not  
inflate in a collision does not mean  
that something is wrong with the  
system. Rather, it means the forces  
were not of the type sufficient to  
cause activation. Airbags are  
designed to inflate in frontal and  
near-frontal collisions, not rollover,  
side-impact, or rear-impacts.  
186  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The airbags inflate and deflate  
rapidly upon activation. After airbag  
deployment, it is normal to notice a  
smoke-like, powdery residue or  
smell the burnt propellant. This may  
consist of cornstarch, talcum  
powder (to lubricate the bag) or  
sodium compounds (e.g., baking  
soda) that result from the  
combustion process that inflates the  
airbag. Small amounts of sodium  
hydroxide may be present which  
may irritate the skin and eyes, but  
none of the residue is toxic.  
While the system is designed to help  
reduce serious injuries, it may also  
cause minor abrasions, swelling or temporary hearing loss. Because  
airbags must inflate rapidly and with considerable force, there is the risk  
of death or serious injuries such as fractures, facial and eye injuries or  
internal injuries, particularly to occupants who are not properly  
restrained or are otherwise out of position at the time of airbag  
deployment. Thus, it is extremely important that occupants be properly  
restrained as far away from the airbag module as possible while  
maintaining vehicle control.  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the air bag has deployed, the air bag will not  
function again and must be replaced immediately. If the air  
bag is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
The SRS consists of:  
driver and passenger airbag modules (which include the inflators and  
airbags),  
one or more impact and safing sensors,  
a readiness light and tone  
and the electrical wiring which connects the components.  
187  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The diagnostic module monitors its own internal circuits and the  
supplemental airbag electrical system wiring (including the impact  
sensors), the system wiring, the airbag system readiness light, the airbag  
back up power and the airbag ignitors.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the condition of the system. Refer to Airbag readiness section  
in the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the airbag is  
not required.  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light will either  
flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not  
illuminate immediately after  
ignition is turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision.  
SOS Post-Crash Alert System™  
The system automatically flashes the turn signal lamps and sounds the  
horn three times at four second intervals in the event of a serious impact  
that deploys an airbag (front, side, side curtain or Safety Canopy) or  
the safety belt pretensioners.  
The system can be turned off when any one of the following actions are  
taken by the driver or any other person:  
pressing the hazard control button,  
or pressing the panic button on the remote entry transmitter.  
The feature will continue to operate until the vehicle runs out of power.  
Disposal of airbags and airbag equipped vehicles  
See authorized dealer. Airbags MUST BE disposed of by qualified  
personnel.  
188  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Passenger airbag ON/OFF switch (if equipped)  
WARNING: An airbag  
ON/OFF switch (if  
equipped) may be installed in this  
vehicle. Before driving, always  
look at the face of the switch to  
be sure the switch is in the proper  
position in accordance with these  
instructions and warnings. Failure  
to put the switch in a proper  
position can increase the risk of  
serious injury or death in a  
collision.  
Turning the passenger airbag off  
1. Insert the ignition key, turn the  
switch to OFF position and hold in  
OFF position while removing the  
key.  
2. When the ignition is turned to the  
ON position the OFF light  
illuminates briefly, momentarily  
shuts off and then turns back on.  
This indicates that the passenger  
airbag is deactivated.  
WARNING: If the light fails to illuminate when the passenger air  
bag switch is in the OFF position and the ignition switch is in  
ON, have the passenger air bag switch serviced at your authorized  
dealer immediately.  
WARNING: In order to avoid inadvertent activation of the  
switch, always remove the ignition key from the passenger air  
bag ON/OFF switch.  
189  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: An infant in a rear-facing seat faces a high risk of  
serious or fatal injuries from a deploying passenger airbag. Rear  
facing infant seats should NEVER be placed in the front seats, unless  
the passenger airbag is turned off.  
Turning the passenger airbag back on  
The passenger airbag remains OFF until you turn it back ON.  
1. Insert the ignition key and turn  
the switch to ON.  
2. The OFF light will briefly  
illuminate when the ignition is  
turned to On. This indicates that the  
passenger airbag is operational.  
WARNING: If the OFF light is illuminated when the passenger  
airbag switch is in the ON position and the ignition switch is in  
ON, have the passenger airbag switch serviced at your authorized  
dealer immediately.  
The passenger side airbag should always be ON (the airbag OFF light  
should not be illuminated) unless the passenger is a person who meets  
the requirements stated either in Category 1, 2 or 3 of the  
NHTSA/Transport Canada deactivation criteria which follows.  
WARNING: The safety belts for the driver and right front  
passenger seating positions have been specifically designed to  
function together with the airbags in certain types of crashes. When  
you turn OFF your airbag, you not only lose the protection of the  
airbag, you also may reduce the effectiveness of your safety belt  
system, which was designed to work with the airbag. If you are not a  
person who meets the requirements stated in the NHTSA/Transport  
Canada deactivation criteria turning OFF the airbag can increase the  
risk of serious injury or death in a collision.  
190  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: If your vehicle has rear seats, always transport  
children who are 12 and younger in the rear seat. Always use  
safety belts and child restraints properly. DO NOT place a child in a  
rear facing infant seat in the front seat unless your vehicle is equipped  
with an airbag ON/OFF switch and the passenger airbag is turned OFF.  
This is because the back of the infant seat is too close to the inflating  
airbag and the risk of a fatal injury to the infant when the airbag  
inflates is substantial.  
The vast majority of drivers and passengers are much safer with an  
airbag than without. To do their job and reduce the risk of life  
threatening injuries, airbags must open with great force, and this force  
can pose a potentially deadly risk in some situations, particularly when a  
front seat occupant is not properly buckled up. The most effective way  
to reduce the risk of unnecessary airbag injuries without reducing the  
overall safety of the vehicle is to make sure all occupants are properly  
restrained in the vehicle, especially in the front seat. This provides the  
protection of safety belts and permits the airbags to provide the  
additional protection they were designed to provide. If you choose to  
deactivate your airbag, you are losing the very significant risk reducing  
benefits of the airbag and you are also reducing the effectiveness of the  
safety belts, because safety belts in modern vehicles are designed to  
work as a safety system with the airbags.  
Read all airbag warning labels in the vehicle as well as the other  
important airbag instructions and warnings in this Owner’s Guide.  
NHTSA deactivation criteria (excluding Canada)  
1. Infant. An infant (less than 1 year old) must ride in the front seat  
because:  
the vehicle has no rear seat;  
the vehicle has a rear seat too small to accommodate a rear-facing  
infant seat; or  
the infant has a medical condition which, according to the infant’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the infant to ride in the front so that  
the driver can constantly monitor the child’s condition.  
191  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Child age 1 to 12. A child age 1 to 12 must ride in the front seat  
because:  
the vehicle has no rear seat;  
although children ages 1 to 12 ride in the rear seat(s) whenever  
possible, children ages 1 to 12 sometimes must ride in the front  
because no space is available in the rear seat(s) of the vehicle; or  
the child has a medical condition which, according to the child’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the child to ride in the front seat so  
that the driver can constantly monitor the child’s condition.  
3. Medical condition. A passenger has a medical condition which,  
according to his or her physician:  
causes the passenger airbag to pose a special risk for the passenger;  
and  
makes the potential harm from the passenger airbag in a crash greater  
than the potential harm from turning OFF the airbag and allowing the  
passenger, even if belted, to hit the dashboard or windshield in a crash.  
WARNING: This vehicle has special energy management safety  
belts for the driver and right front passenger. These particular  
belts are specifically designed to work with airbags to help reduce the  
risk of injury in a collision. The energy management safety belt is  
designed to give or release additional belt webbing in some accidents  
to reduce concentration of force on an occupant’s chest and reduce the  
risk of certain bone fractures and injuries to underlying organs. In a  
crash, if the airbag is turned OFF, this energy management safety belt  
might permit the person wearing the belt to move forward enough to  
incur a serious or fatal injury. The more severe the crash, and the  
heavier the occupant, the greater the risk is. Be sure the airbag is  
turned ON for any person who does not qualify under the NHTSA  
deactivation criteria.  
Transport Canada deactivation criteria (Canada Only)  
1. Infant: An infant (less than 1 year old) must ride in the front seat  
because:  
my vehicle has no rear seat;  
the rear seat in my vehicle cannot accommodate a rear-facing infant  
seat; or  
the infant has a medical condition which, according to the infant’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the infant to ride in the front seat so  
that the driver can monitor the infant’s condition.  
192  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Child age 12 or under: A child age 12 or under must ride in the  
front seat because:  
my vehicle has no rear seat;  
although children age 12 and under ride in the rear seat whenever  
possible, children age 12 and under have no option but to sometimes  
ride in the front seat because rear seat space is insufficient; or  
the child has a medical condition that, according to the child’s  
physician, makes it necessary for the child to ride in the front seat so  
that the driver can monitor the child’s condition.  
3. Medical condition: A passenger has a medical condition that,  
according to his or her physician:  
poses a special risk for the passenger if the airbag deploys; and  
makes the potential harm from the passenger airbag deployment  
greater than the potential harm from turning OFF the airbag and  
experiencing a crash without the protection offered by the airbag  
WARNING: This vehicle has special energy management safety  
belts for the driver and right front passenger. These particular  
belts are specifically designed to work with airbags to help reduce the  
risk of injury in a collision. The energy management safety belt is  
designed to give or release additional belt webbing in some accidents  
to reduce concentration of force on an occupant’s chest and reduce the  
risk of certain bone fractures and injuries to underlying organs. In a  
crash, if the airbag is turned OFF, this energy management safety belt  
might permit the person wearing the belt to move forward enough to  
incur a serious or fatal injury. The more severe the crash, and the  
heavier the occupant, the greater the risk is. Be sure the airbag is  
turned ON for any person who does not qualify under the NHTSA  
deactivation criteria.  
193  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS FOR CHILDREN  
See the following sections for directions on how to properly use safety  
restraints for children. Also see Airbag supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) in this chapter for special instructions about using airbags.  
Important child restraint precautions  
WARNING: Always make sure your child is secured properly in  
a device that is appropriate for their height, age and weight.  
Child safety restraints must be purchased separately from the vehicle.  
Failure to follow these instructions and guidelines may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
WARNING: All children are shaped differently. The  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints are based on probable  
child height, age and weight thresholds from NHTSA and other safety  
organizations or are the minimum requirements of law. Ford  
recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety  
Technician (CPST) and your pediatrician to make sure your child seat  
is appropriate for your child, and is compatible with and properly  
installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and CPST  
contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet at  
http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. Failure to properly restrain children in safety  
seats made especially for their height, age, and weight may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children  
Child size, height, weight, or  
age  
Recommended  
restraint type  
Infants  
or  
toddlers younger)  
Children weighing 40 lb (18 kg) or Use a child safety seat  
less (generally age four or  
(sometimes called an  
infant carrier,  
convertible seat, or  
toddler seat).  
194  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children  
Child size, height, weight, or  
age  
Recommended  
restraint type  
Small  
Children who have outgrown or no Use a belt-positioning  
children longer properly fit in a child safety booster seat.  
seat (generally children who are  
less than 4 feet 9 inches  
(1.45 meters) tall, are greater than  
age four (4) and less than age  
twelve (12), and between 40 lbs  
(18 kg) and 80 lbs (36 kg) and  
upward to 100 lbs (45 kg) if  
recommended by your child  
restraint manufacturer)  
Larger  
Children who have outgrown or no Use a vehicle safety  
children longer properly fit in a  
belt-positioning booster seat  
(generally children who are at  
belt having the lap belt  
snug and low across the  
hips, shoulder belt  
least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) centered across the  
tall or greater than 80 lb (36 kg) shoulder and chest, and  
or 100 lb (45 kg) if recommended seatback upright.  
by child restraint manufacturer)  
You are required by law to properly use safety seats for infants and  
toddlers in the U.S. and Canada.  
Many states and provinces require that small children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 ft 9 in  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg). Check your local and state or  
provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety of  
children in your vehicle.  
When possible, always properly restrain children twelve (12) years of  
age and under in a rear seating position of your vehicle. Accident  
statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in  
the rear seating positions than in a front seating position.  
195  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children  
Note: This vehicle is not equipped with LATCH lower anchors.  
Use any attachment method as indicated  
below by “X”  
LATCH LATCH Safety Safety  
(lower (lower belt belt and belt  
anchors anchors and  
Safety  
Restraint Child  
LATCH  
(lower  
only  
Type  
Weight  
and  
only)  
top  
top  
tether  
anchor)  
tether anchors  
anchor and top  
tether  
anchor)  
Rear  
facing  
Up to  
48 lb  
X
X
child seat (21 kg)  
Forward Up to  
facing  
child seat (21 kg)  
Forward Over  
facing  
48 lb  
X
X
X
X
X
48 lb  
child seat (21 kg)  
WARNING: Air bags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active air  
bag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
the vehicle seat all the way back. When possible, all children age 12  
and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. If  
all children cannot be seated and restrained properly in a rear seating  
position, properly restrain the largest child in the front seat.  
196  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Always carefully follow the instructions and  
warnings provided by the manufacturer of any child restraint to  
determine if the restraint device is appropriate for your child’s size,  
height, weight, or age. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions and warnings provided for installation and use in  
conjunction with the instructions and warnings provided by the vehicle  
manufacturer. A safety seat that is improperly installed or utilized, is  
inappropriate for your child’s height, age, or weight or does not  
properly fit the child may increase the risk of serious injury or death.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision, which may result in serious injury or  
death.  
WARNING: Never use pillows, books, or towels to boost a child.  
They can slide around and increase the likelihood of injury or  
death in a collision.  
WARNING: Always restrain an unoccupied child seat or booster  
seat. These objects may become projectiles in a collision or  
sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
WARNING: Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or pets  
unattended in your vehicle.  
Transporting children  
Always make sure your child is secured properly in a device that is  
appropriate for their age, height and weight. All children are shaped  
differently. The child height, age and weight thresholds provided are  
recommendations or the minimum requirements of law. The National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) provides education and  
197  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
training to ensure that all children ages 0 to 16 are properly restrained in  
the correct restraint system. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA  
Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician (CPST) and your  
pediatrician to make sure your seat is appropriate for your child and  
properly installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and  
CPST contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet  
at http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov.  
Follow all the safety restraint and airbag precautions that apply to adult  
passengers in your vehicle.  
If the child is the proper height, age, and weight (as specified by your  
child safety seat or booster manufacturer), fits the restraint and can be  
restrained properly, then restrain the child in the child safety seat or  
with the belt-positioning booster. Remember that child seats and  
belt-positioning boosters vary and may be designed to fit children of  
different heights, ages and weights. Children who are too large for child  
safety seats or belt-positioning boosters (as specified by your child safety  
seat manufacturer) should always properly wear safety belts.  
SAFETY SEATS FOR CHILDREN  
Infant and/or toddler seats  
Use a safety seat that is recommended for the size and weight of the child.  
When installing a child safety seat:  
Review and follow the information  
presented in the Airbag  
supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) section in this chapter.  
Carefully follow all of the  
manufacturer’s instructions  
included with the safety seat you  
put in your vehicle. If you do not  
install and use the safety seat  
properly, the child may be injured  
in a sudden stop or collision.  
Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. NEVER place a rear-facing  
child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a forward-facing  
child seat in the front seat, move the vehicle seat all the way back.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
198  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Installing child safety seats with automatic locking mode  
combination lap and shoulder belts  
(front passenger and rear outboard seating positions)  
Check to make sure the child seat is properly secured before each use.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
When installing a child safety seat with combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Use the correct safety belt buckle for that seating position.  
Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a snap  
and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the  
buckle.  
Keep the buckle release button pointing up and away from the safety  
seat, with the tongue between the child seat and the release button,  
to prevent accidental unbuckling.  
Place vehicle seat back in upright position.  
This vehicle does not require the use of a locking clip.  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
Installing the child safety seat  
Perform the following steps when installing the child seat in the  
outboard combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,  
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.  
199  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
1. Position the child safety seat in a  
seat with a combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
WARNING: An airbag can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
Child seats should NEVER be placed in the front seats, unless  
the passenger airbag switch is turned off, See Passenger airbag on/off  
switch.  
WARNING: Rear facing child seats should NEVER be placed in  
the front seats unless the passenger airbag switch is turned off.  
2. Pull down on the shoulder belt  
and then grasp the shoulder belt  
and lap belt together.  
200  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. While holding the shoulder and  
lap belt portions together, route the  
tongue through the child seat  
according to the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure  
the belt webbing is not twisted.  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) for that seating position until  
you hear and feel the latch engage.  
Make sure the tongue is latched  
securely by pulling on it.  
5. Put the safety belt in the  
automatic locking mode. To do so,  
grasp the shoulder portion of the  
belt and pull downward until all of  
the belt is pulled out.  
6. Allow the belt to retract to remove slack. The belt will click as it  
retracts to indicate it is in the automatic locking mode.  
7. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is  
in the automatic locking mode (you should not be able to pull more belt  
out). If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 5 and 6.  
201  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
8. Remove remaining slack from the  
belt. Force the seat down with extra  
weight, e.g., by pressing down or  
kneeling on the child restraint while  
pulling up on the shoulder belt in  
order to force slack from the belt.  
This is necessary to remove the  
remaining slack that will exist once  
the additional weight of the child is  
added to the child restraint. It also  
helps to achieve the proper  
snugness of the child seat to the  
vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean  
towards the buckle will additionally  
help to remove remaining slack from the belt.  
9. Attach the tether strap (if the  
child seat is equipped). Refer to  
Attaching child safety seats with  
tether straps later in this chapter.  
10. Before placing the child in the  
seat, forcibly move the seat forward  
and back to make sure the seat is  
securely held in place. To check  
this, grab the seat at the belt path  
and attempt to move it side to side  
and forward. There should be no  
more than one inch (2.5 cm) of movement for proper installation.  
11. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed. In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for  
referral to a CPST.  
Installing child safety seats in cinch tongue combination lap and  
shoulder belt seating positions (Regular Cab front center and  
Super/Crew cab rear center positions)  
The belt webbing below the tongue is the lap portion of the combination  
lap/shoulder belt, and the belt webbing above the tongue is the shoulder  
belt portion of the combination lap/shoulder belt.  
WARNING: Always use both lap and shoulder safety belt in the  
Regular Cab center seating position if applicable.  
202  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,  
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.  
1. Position the child safety seat in  
the center seat.  
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. If  
you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
seat all the way back.  
WARNING: Rear facing child seats should NEVER be placed in  
front of an active airbag.  
2. Slide the tongue up the webbing.  
3. While holding both shoulder and  
lap portions next to the tongue,  
route the tongue and webbing  
through the child seat according to  
the child seat manufacturer’s  
instructions. Be sure that the belt  
webbing is not twisted.  
203  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle for that seating  
positions until you hear a snap and  
feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is  
securely latched to the buckle by  
pulling on the tongue.  
5. Remove remaining slack from the  
belt. Force the seat down with extra  
weight, e.g., by pressing down or  
kneeling on the child restraint while  
pulling up on the shoulder belt in  
order to force slack from the belt.  
This is necessary to remove the  
remaining slack that will exist once  
the additional weight of the child is  
added to the child restraint. It also  
helps to achieve the proper  
snugness of the child seat to the vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean  
towards the buckle will additionally help to remove remaining slack from  
the belt.  
6. Attach the tether strap (if the child seat is equipped). Refer to  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps later in this chapter.  
204  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
7. Before placing the child in the  
seat, forcibly move the seat forward  
and back to make sure the seat is  
securely held in place. To check  
this, grab the seat at the belt path  
and attempt to move it side to side  
and forward. There should be no  
more than one inch (2.5 cm) of  
movement for proper installation.  
8. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed. In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for  
referral to a CPST.  
Installing child safety seats in the front row lap belt seating  
positions (Super Cab and Crew Cab)  
WARNING: Installing a child safety seat in the front row lap  
seating position should be avoided if at all possible.  
WARNING: Never place a rear-facing child seat in the front  
center seating position of a vehicle with rear seating positions.  
WARNING: Front seating positions only: If seating two adults  
and a child, Ford recommends properly restraining the child in  
the center front seating position, but only if doing so will not interfere  
with driving the vehicle. This arrangement provides lap and shoulder  
belt and airbag protection for adult occupants and an attachment  
method for a child restraint. If the child seat interferes with driving the  
vehicle and the child restraint is forward-facing, the child may be  
restrained in the passenger seat. Move the seat as far rearward as  
possible to minimize the likelihood of interaction with the front  
passenger airbag. Never place a rear-facing child seat in front of an  
active airbag. All occupants of the vehicle should always properly wear  
their safety belts. Ensure the child is properly restrained in an  
appropriate child seat or with the use of a booster.  
1. Lengthen the lap belt. To lengthen the belt, hold the tongue so that its  
bottom is perpendicular to the direction of webbing while sliding the  
tongue up the webbing.  
205  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Place the child safety seat in the center seating position.  
3. Route the tongue and webbing through the child seat according to the  
child seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle for the center seating  
position until you hear a snap and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is  
securely fastened to the buckle by pulling on the tongue.  
5. Push down on the child seat while pulling on the loose end of the lap  
belt webbing to tighten the belt.  
6. Before placing the child into the child seat, forcibly tilt the child seat  
from side to side and in forward direction to make sure that the seat is  
securely held in place. To check this, grab the seat at the belt path and  
attempt to move it side to side and forward and back. There should be  
no more than one inch (2.5 cm) of movement for proper installation.  
7. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed. In Canada, check with your local St. John Ambulance office for  
referral to a CPST.  
Note: For Super Cab and Crew Cab there is no top tether anchor for the  
front center seating position. See Attaching child safety seats with  
tether straps later in this chapter.  
Attaching child safety seats with LATCH  
(Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) attachments  
The LATCH system is composed of three vehicle anchor points: two (2)  
lower anchors located where the vehicle seat back and seat cushion meet  
(called the “seat bight”) and one (1) top tether anchor located behind  
that seating position. Your vehicle is not equipped with the lower anchor  
points in the seat bight. For this vehicle use the vehicle safety belt and  
upper tether to secure a child seat. See Attaching child safety seats  
with tether straps and Recommendations for attaching safety  
restraints for children in this chapter for more information.  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps  
Many forward-facing child safety seats include a tether strap which  
extends from the back of the child safety seat and hooks to an anchoring  
point called the top tether anchor. Tether straps are available as an  
accessory for many older safety seats. Contact the manufacturer of your  
child seat for information about ordering a tether strap, or to obtain a  
longer tether strap if the tether strap on your safety seat does not reach  
the appropriate top tether anchor in the vehicle.  
206  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The passenger seats of your vehicle may be equipped with built-in tether  
strap anchors located behind the seats as described below.  
The tether anchors in your vehicle may be straps on the seatback or an  
anchor bracket on the rear edge of the seat cushion or an anchor bracket  
mounted to the body shell on the back panel.  
The SuperCab rear seat has three straps behind the top of the seat back  
that function as both routing loops for the tether straps and anchor  
loops.  
The tether strap anchors in your vehicle are in the following positions  
(shown from top view):  
F-Series Regular Cab  
F-Series SuperCab  
F-Series Crew Cab  
Attach the tether strap only to the appropriate tether anchor as shown.  
The tether strap may not work properly if attached somewhere other  
than the correct tether anchor.  
Once the child safety seat has been installed using the safety belt, you  
can attach the top tether strap.  
207  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Tether strap attachment  
1. Route the child safety seat tether strap over the back of the seat.  
For vehicles with adjustable head restraints, route the tether strap under  
the head restraint and between the head restraint posts, other wise route  
the tether strap over the top of the seatback. If the top of the safety seat  
hits the head restraint, raise the head restraint to let the child seat fit  
further rearward.  
2. Locate the correct anchor for the selected seating position.  
3. You may need to pull the seatback forward to access the tether  
anchors. Make sure the seat is locked in the upright position before  
installing the child seat. Refer to the Rear folding seat system with load  
floor section in this chapter for information on how to operate the rear  
seats.  
4. Remove tether cover.  
5. Clip the tether strap to the anchor as shown.  
Front seats (Regular Cab)  
208  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Front seat (SuperCab)  
Rear seats (Crew Cab)  
If the tether strap is clipped incorrectly, the child safety seat may not be  
retained properly in the event of a collision.  
6. Refer to the Installing child safety seats with combination lap and  
shoulder belts section of this chapter for further instructions to secure  
the child safety seat.  
7. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a collision greatly increases.  
If your child restraint system is equipped with a tether strap, and the  
child restraint manufacturer recommends its use, Ford also recommends  
its use.  
Tether strap attachment (rear SuperCab only)  
There are three loops of webbing just above the back of the rear seat  
(along the bottom edge of the rear window) in the SuperCab. These  
loops are to be used as both routing loops and anchor loops for up to  
three child safety seat tether straps.  
209  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
These straps may be secured below the back of the seat with rubber  
bands. To access, reach below the back of the seat and pull tether loop  
out of the rubber band securing it.  
Many tether straps cannot be tightened if the tether strap is hooked to  
the loop directly behind the child seat. To provide a tight tether strap:  
1. Route the tether strap through  
the loop directly behind the child  
seat.  
2. Attach the strap hook onto the  
loop behind an adjacent seating  
position.  
3. Install the child safety seat tightly  
using the vehicle belts. Follow the  
instructions in this chapter.  
4. Tighten the tether strap  
according to the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
A single loop can be used to route and anchor more than one child seat.  
For example, the center loop can be used as a routing loop for a child  
safety seat in the center rear seat and as an anchoring loop for child  
seats installed in the outboard rear seats.  
210  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Child booster seats  
The belt-positioning booster (booster seat) is used to improve the fit of  
the vehicle safety belt. Children outgrow a typical child seat (e.g.,  
convertible or toddler seat) when they weigh about 40 lb (18 kg) and are  
around four (4) years of age. Consult your child safety seat owner guide  
for the weight, height, and age limits specific to your child safety seat.  
Keep your child in the child safety seat if it properly fits the child,  
remains appropriate for their weight, height and age AND if properly  
secured to the vehicle.  
Although the lap/shoulder belt will provide some protection, children  
who have outgrown a typical child seat are still too small for lap/shoulder  
belts to fit properly, and wearing an improperly fitted vehicle safety belt  
could increase the risk of serious injury in a crash. To improve the fit of  
both the lap and shoulder belt on children who have outgrown child  
safety seats, Ford Motor Company recommends use of a belt-positioning  
booster.  
Booster seats position a child so that vehicle lap/shoulder safety belts fit  
better. They lift the child up so that the lap belt rests low across the hips  
and the knees bend comfortably at the edge of the cushion, while  
minimizing slouching. Booster seats may also make the shoulder belt fit  
better and more comfortably. Try to keep the belt near the middle of the  
shoulder and across the center of the chest. Moving the child closer (a  
few centimeters or inches) to the center of the vehicle, but remaining in  
the same seating position, may help provide a good shoulder belt fit.  
When children should use booster seats  
Children need to use booster seats from the time they outgrow the  
toddler seat until they are big enough for the vehicle seat and  
lap/shoulder belt to fit properly. Generally this is when they reach a  
height of at least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall (around age eight to  
age twelve and between 40 lb (18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) or upward to  
100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by your child restraint manufacturer).  
Many state and provincial laws require that children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg).  
211  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Booster seats should be used until you can answer YES to ALL of these  
questions when seated without a booster seat:  
Can the child sit all the way back  
against the vehicle seat back with  
knees bent comfortably at the  
edge of the seat cushion?  
Can the child sit without  
slouching?  
Does the lap belt rest low across  
the hips?  
Is the shoulder belt centered on the shoulder and chest?  
Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?  
Types of booster seats  
There are generally two types of belt-positioning booster seats: backless  
and high back. Always use booster seats in conjunction with the vehicle  
lap/shoulder belt.  
Backless booster seats  
If your backless booster seat has a  
removable shield, remove the  
shield. If a vehicle seating position  
has a low seat back or no head  
restraint, a backless booster seat  
may place your child’s head (as  
measured at the tops of the ears)  
above the top of the seat. In this  
case, move the backless booster  
to another seating position with a  
higher seat back or head restraint and lap/shoulder belts, or consider  
using a high back booster seat.  
High back booster seats  
If, with a backless booster seat,  
you cannot find a seating position  
that adequately supports your  
child’s head, a high back booster  
seat would be a better choice.  
212  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and booster seats vary in size and shape. Choose a booster that  
keeps the lap belt low and snug across the hips, never up across the  
stomach, and lets you adjust the shoulder belt to cross the chest and  
rest snugly near the center of the shoulder. The drawings below compare  
the ideal fit (center) to a shoulder belt uncomfortably close to the neck  
and a shoulder belt that could slip off the shoulder. The drawings below  
also show how the lap belt should be low and snug across the child’s  
hips.  
If the booster seat slides on the vehicle seat, placing a rubberized mesh  
sold as shelf or carpet liner under the booster seat may improve this  
condition. Do not introduce any item thicker than this under the booster  
seat. Check with the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
The importance of shoulder belts  
Using a booster without a shoulder belt increases the risk of a child’s  
head hitting a hard surface in a collision. For this reason, you should  
never use a booster seat with a lap belt only. It is generally best to use a  
booster seat with lap/shoulder belts in the back seat.  
Move a child to a different seating location if the shoulder belt does not  
stay positioned on the shoulder during use.  
213  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Follow all instructions provided by the manufacturer of the booster seat.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
Child restraint and safety belt maintenance  
Inspect the vehicle safety belts and child safety seat systems periodically  
to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Inspect the  
vehicle and child seat safety belts to make sure there are no nicks, tears  
or cuts. Replace if necessary. All vehicle safety belt assemblies, including  
retractors, buckles, front safety belt buckle assemblies, buckle support  
assemblies (slide bar-if equipped), shoulder belt height adjusters (if  
equipped), shoulder belt guide on seatback (if equipped), child safety  
seat LATCH and tether anchors, and attaching hardware, should be  
inspected after a collision. Refer to the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions for additional inspection and maintenance information  
specific to the child restraint. Ford Motor Company recommends that all  
safety belt assemblies in use in vehicles involved in a collision be  
replaced. However, if the collision was minor and an authorized dealer  
finds that the belts do not show damage and continue to operate  
properly, they do not need to be replaced. Safety belt assemblies not in  
use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either  
damage or improper operation is noted.  
For proper care of soiled safety belts, refer to Interior in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
WARNING: Failure to inspect and if necessary replace the  
safety belt assembly or child restraint system under the above  
conditions could result in severe personal injuries in the event of a  
collision.  
214  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
NOTICE TO UTILITY VEHICLE AND TRUCK OWNERS  
Utility vehicles and trucks handle  
differently than passenger cars in  
the various driving conditions that  
are encountered on streets,  
highways and off-road. Utility  
vehicles and trucks are not designed  
for cornering at speeds as high as  
passenger cars any more than  
low-slung sports cars are designed  
to perform satisfactorily under  
off-road conditions.  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles. To reduce the risk of serious  
injury or death from a rollover or other crash you must:  
Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers;  
Drive at safe speeds for the conditions;  
Keep tires properly inflated;  
Never overload or improperly load your vehicle; and  
Make sure every passenger is properly restrained.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
All occupants must wear seat belts and children/infants must use  
appropriate restraints to minimize the risk of injury or ejection.  
Study your owner’s guide and any supplements for specific information  
about equipment features, instructions for safe driving and additional  
precautions to reduce the risk of an accident or serious injury.  
215  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
VEHICLE CHARACTERISTICS  
4WD and AWD Systems (if equipped)  
A vehicle equipped with AWD or 4WD (when selected) has the ability to  
use all four wheels to power itself. This increases traction which may  
enable you to safely drive over terrain and road conditions that a  
conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot.  
Power is supplied to all four wheels through a transfer case or power  
transfer unit. 4WD vehicles allow you to select different drive modes as  
necessary. Information on transfer case operation and shifting procedures  
can be found in the Driving chapter. Information on transfer case  
maintenance can be found in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. You should become thoroughly familiar with this information  
before you operate your vehicle.  
On some 4WD models, the initial shift from two-wheel drive to 4WD  
while the vehicle is moving can cause a momentary clunk and ratcheting  
sound. These sounds are normal as the front drivetrain comes up to  
speed and is not cause for concern.  
WARNING: Do not become overconfident in the ability of 4WD  
and AWD vehicles. Although a 4WD or AWD vehicle may  
accelerate better than two-wheel drive vehicle in low traction  
situations, it won’t stop any faster than two-wheel drive vehicles.  
Always drive at a safe speed.  
216  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
How your vehicle differs from other vehicles  
SUV and trucks can differ from  
some other vehicles in a few  
noticeable ways. Your vehicle may  
be:  
Higher – to allow higher load  
carrying capacity and to allow it  
to travel over rough terrain  
without getting hung up or  
damaging underbody components.  
Shorter – to give it the capability  
to approach inclines and drive  
over the crest of a hill without  
getting hung up or damaging  
underbody components. All other  
things held equal, a shorter  
wheelbase may make your vehicle  
quicker to respond to steering inputs than a vehicle with a longer  
wheelbase.  
Narrower — to provide greater  
maneuverability in tight spaces,  
particularly in off-road use.  
As a result of the above dimensional  
differences, SUV’s and trucks often  
will have a higher center of gravity  
and a greater difference in center of  
gravity between the loaded and  
unloaded condition.  
These differences that make your  
vehicle so versatile also make it  
handle differently than an ordinary  
passenger car.  
217  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
INFORMATION ABOUT UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new  
pneumatic passenger car tires. The  
Quality grades can be found where  
applicable on the tire sidewall  
between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For  
example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
These Tire Quality Grades are determined by standards that the United  
States Department of Transportation has set.  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new pneumatic passenger car tires. They do  
not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires, space-saver or  
temporary use spare tires, light truck or “LT” type tires, tires with  
nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches or limited production tires as  
defined in Title 49 Code of Federal Regulations Part 575.104(c)(2).  
U.S. Department of Transportation-Tire quality grades: The U.S.  
Department of Transportation requires Ford Motor Company to give you  
the following information about tire grades exactly as the government  
has written it.  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of  
the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one  
and one-half (112) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual  
conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices, and  
differences in road characteristics and climate.  
Traction AA A B C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The  
grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured  
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction  
performance.  
218  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics.  
Temperature A B C  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the  
tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire  
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to  
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance  
which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standard No. 139. Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by  
law.  
WARNING: The temperature grade for this tire is established  
for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive  
speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.  
TIRES  
Tires are designed to give many thousands of miles of service, but they  
must be maintained in order to get the maximum benefit from them.  
Glossary of tire terminology  
Tire label: A label showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire sizes,  
recommended inflation pressure and the maximum weight the vehicle  
can carry.  
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of  
each tire providing information about the tire brand and  
manufacturing plant, tire size and date of manufacture. Also referred  
to as DOT code.  
Inflation pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.  
Standard load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
maximum load at 35 psi [37 psi (2.5 bar) for Metric tires]. Increasing  
the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase the tire’s  
load carrying capability.  
219  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
heavier maximum load at 41 psi [43 psi (2.9 bar) for Metric tires].  
Increasing the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase  
the tire’s load carrying capability.  
kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pressure.  
PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard unit of air pressure.  
Cold inflation pressure: The tire pressure when the vehicle has  
been stationary and out of direct sunlight for an hour or more and  
prior to the vehicle being driven for 1 mile (1.6 km).  
Recommended inflation pressure: The cold inflation pressure found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label located on  
the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the  
front door.  
Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.  
Sidewall of the tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.  
Tread area of the tire: Area of the perimeter of the tire that  
contacts the road when mounted on the vehicle.  
Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly  
upon which the tire beads are seated.  
INFLATING YOUR TIRES  
Safe operation of your vehicle requires that your tires are properly  
inflated. Remember that a tire can lose up to half of its air pressure  
without appearing flat.  
Every day before you drive, check your tires. If one looks lower than the  
others, use a tire gauge to check pressure of all tires and adjust if  
required.  
At least once a month and before long trips, inspect each tire and check  
the tire pressure with a tire gauge (including spare, if equipped). Inflate  
all tires to the inflation pressure recommended by Ford Motor Company.  
You are strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as automatic  
service station gauges may be inaccurate. Ford recommends the use of a  
digital or dial-type tire pressure gauge rather than a stick-type tire  
pressure gauge.  
Use the recommended cold inflation pressure for optimum tire  
performance and wear. Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause  
uneven treadwear patterns.  
220  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Under-inflation is the most common cause of tire  
failures and may result in severe tire cracking, tread separation  
or ЉblowoutЉ, with unexpected loss of vehicle control and increased risk  
of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing and rolling  
resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It  
also may result in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of  
vehicle control and accidents. A tire can lose up to half of its air  
pressure and not appear to be flat!  
Always inflate your tires to the Ford recommended inflation pressure  
even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure information found  
on the tire. The Ford recommended tire inflation pressure is found on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label which is located  
on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. Failure to follow the tire  
pressure recommendations can cause uneven treadwear patterns and  
adversely affect the way your vehicle handles.  
Note: Do not reduce tire pressure to change the ride characteristics of  
the vehicle. If you do not maintain the inflation pressure at the levels  
specified by Ford, your vehicle may experience a condition known as  
ЉshimmyЉ. Shimmy is a severe vibration and oscillation in the steering  
wheel after the vehicle travels over a bump or dip in the road that does  
not dampen out by itself. Shimmy may result from significant  
under-inflation of the tires, improper tires (load range, size, or type), or  
vehicle modifications such as lift-kits. In the event that your vehicle  
experiences shimmy, you should slowly reduce speed by either lifting off  
the accelerator pedal or lightly applying the brakes. The shimmy will  
cease as the vehicle speed decreases.  
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure is the tire manufacturer’s  
maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at which the  
maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally  
higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure  
which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire  
Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than the  
recommended pressure on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or  
Tire Label.  
When weather temperature changes occur, tire inflation pressures also  
change. A 10°F (6°C) temperature drop can cause a corresponding drop  
of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check your tire pressures  
frequently and adjust them to the proper pressure which can be found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label.  
221  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
To check the pressure in your tire(s):  
1. Make sure the tires are cool, meaning they are not hot from driving  
even a mile.  
If you are checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, (i.e. driven more  
than 1 mile [1.6 km]), never “bleed” or reduce air pressure. The tires are  
hot from driving and it is normal for pressures to increase above  
recommended cold pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended cold  
inflation pressure could be significantly under-inflated.  
Note: If you have to drive a distance to get air for your tire(s), check  
and record the tire pressure first and add the appropriate air pressure  
when you get to the pump. It is normal for tires to heat up and the air  
pressure inside to go up as you drive.  
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, then firmly press the tire  
gauge onto the valve and measure the pressure.  
3. Add enough air to reach the recommended air pressure.  
Note: If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in  
the center of the valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.  
4. Replace the valve cap.  
5. Repeat this procedure for each tire, including the spare.  
Note: Some spare tires operate at a higher inflation pressure than the  
other tires. For T-type/mini-spare tires (see the Dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel information section for description): Store and maintain at  
60 psi (4.15 bar). For Full Size and Dissimilar spare tires (see the  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information section for description): Store  
and maintain at the higher of the front and rear inflation pressure as  
shown on the Tire Label.  
6. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other  
objects embedded that could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air  
leak.  
7. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts or bulges.  
222  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Tire inflation information  
All tires with Steel Carcass Plies (if equipped):  
This type of tire utilizes steel cords in the sidewalls. As such, they  
cannot be treated like normal light truck tires. Tire service, including  
adjusting tire pressure, must be performed by personnel trained,  
supervised and equipped according to Federal Occupational Safety and  
Health Administration (OSHA) regulations. For example, during any  
procedure involving tire inflation, the technician or individual must  
utilize a remote inflation device, and ensure that all persons are clear of  
the trajectory area.  
WARNING: An inflated tire and rim can be very dangerous if  
improperly used, serviced or maintained. To reduce the risk of  
serious injury, never attempt to re-inflate a tire which has been run flat  
or seriously under-inflated without first removing the tire from the  
wheel assembly for inspection. Do not attempt to add air to tires or  
replace tires or wheels without first taking precautions to protect  
persons and property.  
223  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Stay out of the trajectory (1) as indicated in the  
illustration.  
TIRE CARE  
Inspecting your tires and wheel valve stems  
Periodically inspect the tire treads for uneven or excessive wear and  
remove objects such as stones, nails or glass that may be wedged in the  
tread grooves. Check the tire and valve stems for holes, cracks, or cuts  
that may permit air leakage and repair or replace the tire and replace  
the valve stem. Inspect the tire sidewalls for cracking, cuts, bruises and  
other signs of damage or excessive wear. If internal damage to the tire is  
suspected, have the tire demounted and inspected in case it needs to be  
repaired or replaced. For your safety, tires that are damaged or show  
signs of excessive wear should not be used because they are more likely  
to blow out or fail.  
224  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear  
abnormally. Inspect all your tires, including the spare, frequently, and  
replace them if one or more of the following conditions exist:  
Tire wear  
When the tread is worn down to  
1/16th of an inch (2 mm), tires must  
be replaced to help prevent your  
vehicle from skidding and  
hydroplaning. Built-in treadwear  
indicators, or “wear bars”, which  
look like narrow strips of smooth  
rubber across the tread will appear  
on the tire when the tread is worn  
down to 1/16th of an inch (2 mm).  
When the tire tread wears down to  
the same height as these “wear bars”, the tire is worn out and must be  
replaced.  
Damage  
Periodically inspect the tire treads and sidewalls for damage (such as  
bulges in the tread or sidewalls, cracks in the tread groove and  
separation in the tread or sidewall). If damage is observed or suspected  
have the tire inspected by a tire professional. Tires can be damaged  
during off-road use, so inspection after off-road use is also  
recommended.  
WARNING: Age  
Tires degrade over time depending on many factors such as  
weather, storage conditions, and conditions of use (load, speed,  
inflation pressure, etc.) the tires experience throughout their lives.  
In general, tires should be replaced after six years regardless of tread  
wear. However, heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading  
conditions can accelerate the aging process and may require tires to be  
replaced more frequently.  
You should replace your spare tire when you replace the road tires or  
after six years due to aging even if it has not been used.  
225  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
This begins with the letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all  
federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code  
designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size  
code and the last four numbers represent the week and year the tire was  
built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After  
2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th  
week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for  
traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect  
requires a recall.  
Tire Replacement Requirements  
Your vehicle is equipped with tires designed to provide a safe ride and  
handling capability.  
WARNING: Only use replacement tires and wheels that are the  
same size, load index, speed rating and type (such as P-metric  
versus LT-metric or all-season versus all-terrain) as those originally  
provided by Ford. The recommended tire and wheel size may be found  
on either the Safety Compliance Certification Label or the Tire Label  
which is located on the B-Pillar or edge of the driver’s door. If this  
information is not found on these labels then you should contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Use of any tire or wheel not  
recommended by Ford can affect the safety and performance of your  
vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. Additionally the use  
of non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering,  
suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit failure. If you  
have questions regarding tire replacement, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
226  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: When mounting replacement tires and wheels, you  
should not exceed the maximum pressure indicated on the  
sidewall of the tire to set the beads without additional precautions  
listed below. If the beads do not seat at the maximum pressure  
indicated, re-lubricate and try again.  
When inflating the tire for mounting pressures up to 20 psi (138 kPa)  
greater than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the following  
precautions must be taken to protect the person mounting the tire:  
1. Make sure that you have the correct tire and wheel size.  
2. Lubricate the tire bead and wheel bead seat area again.  
3. Stand at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire wheel  
assembly.  
4. Use both eye and ear protection.  
For a mounting pressure more than 20 psi (138 kPa) greater than the  
maximum pressure, a Ford Dealer or other tire service professional  
should do the mounting.  
Always inflate steel carcass tires with a remote air fill with the person  
inflating standing at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire  
wheel assembly.  
Important: Remember to replace the wheel valve stems when the road  
tires are replaced on your vehicle.  
It is recommended that the two front tires or two rear tires generally be  
replaced as a pair.  
The tire pressure sensors mounted in the wheels are not designed to be  
used in aftermarket wheels.  
The use of wheels or tires not recommended by Ford Motor Company may  
affect the operation of your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (if equipped).  
If the TPMS indicator is flashing, your TPMS is malfunctioning. Your  
replacement tire might be incompatible with your TPMS, or some  
component of the TPMS may be damaged (if equipped).  
Safety practices  
Driving habits have a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety.  
Observe posted speed limits  
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns  
Avoid potholes and objects on the road  
Do not run over curbs or hit the tire against a curb when parking  
227  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: If your vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, sand, etc., do  
not rapidly spin the tires; spinning the tires can tear the tire and  
cause an explosion. A tire can explode in as little as three to five  
seconds.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
Highway hazards  
No matter how carefully you drive there’s always the possibility that you  
may eventually have a flat tire on the highway. Drive slowly to the  
closest safe area out of traffic. This may further damage the flat tire, but  
your safety is more important.  
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving, or you  
suspect your tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your  
speed. Drive with caution until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and  
inspect the tires for damage. If a tire is under-inflated or damaged,  
deflate it, remove wheel and replace it with your spare tire and wheel. If  
you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest repair  
facility or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.  
Tire and wheel alignment  
A bad jolt from hitting a curb or pothole can cause the front end of your  
vehicle to become misaligned or cause damage to your tires. If your  
vehicle seems to pull to one side when you’re driving, the wheels may be  
out of alignment. Have an authorized dealer check the wheel alignment  
periodically.  
Wheel misalignment in the front or the rear can cause uneven and rapid  
treadwear of your tires and should be corrected by an authorized dealer.  
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles and those with an independent rear  
suspension (if equipped) may require alignment of all four wheels.  
The tires should also be balanced periodically. An unbalanced tire and  
wheel assembly may result in irregular tire wear.  
Tire rotation  
Rotating your tires at the recommended interval (as indicated in the  
scheduled maintenance information that comes with your vehicle) will  
help your tires wear more evenly, providing better tire performance and  
longer tire life.  
228  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)  
vehicles/Four Wheel Drive  
(4WD)/All Wheel Drive (AWD)  
vehicles (front tires at top of  
diagram)  
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.  
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask an authorized dealer to check  
for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or mechanical  
problem involved before tire rotation.  
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. A  
dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that is  
different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If  
you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel it is intended for temporary use  
only and should not be used in a tire rotation.  
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked  
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.  
WARNING: If the tire label shows different tire pressures for  
the front and rear tires and the vehicle is equipped with TPMS  
(tire pressure monitoring system), then the settings for the TPMS  
sensors need to be updated. Always perform the TPMS reset procedure  
after tire rotation. If the system is not reset, it may not provide a low  
tire pressure warning when necessary. See the TPMS reset procedure  
in this chapter.  
229  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
DRW – Six tire rotation  
If your vehicle is equipped with dual  
rear wheels it is recommended that  
the front and rear tires (in pairs) be  
rotated only side to side. We do not  
recommend splitting up the dual  
rear wheels. Rotate them side to  
side as a set/pair. After tire rotation,  
inflation pressures must be adjusted  
for the tires new positions in  
accordance with vehicle  
requirements.  
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.  
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask your authorized dealer to  
check for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or  
mechanical problem involved before tire rotation.  
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. A  
dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that is  
different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If  
you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel it is intended for temporary use  
only and should not be used in a tire rotation.  
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked  
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.  
INFORMATION CONTAINED ON THE TIRE SIDEWALL  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
230  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “P” type tires  
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a  
tire size, load index and speed  
rating. The definitions of these  
items are listed below. (Note that  
the tire size, load index and speed  
rating for your vehicle may be  
different from this example.)  
1. P: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that may be used for  
service on cars, SUVs, minivans and  
light trucks.  
Note: If your tire size does not  
begin with a letter this may mean it  
is designated by either ETRTO  
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire  
Manufacturing Association).  
2. 215: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from  
sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the  
wider the tire.  
3. 65: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width.  
4. R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 15: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
6. 95: Indicates the tire’s load index. It is an index that relates to how  
much weight a tire can carry. You may find this information in your  
Owner’s Guide. If not, contact a local tire dealer.  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
7. H: Indicates the tire’s speed rating. The speed rating denotes the  
speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of  
time under a standard condition of load and inflation pressure. The tires  
on your vehicle may operate at different conditions for load and inflation  
pressure. These speed ratings may need to be adjusted for the difference  
in conditions. The ratings range from 81 mph (130 km/h) to 186 mph  
(299 km/h). These ratings are listed in the following chart.  
231  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
Letter rating  
Speed rating - mph (km/h)  
81 mph (130 km/h)  
87 mph (140 km/h)  
99 mph (159 km/h)  
106 mph (171 km/h)  
112 mph (180 km/h)  
118 mph (190 km/h)  
124 mph (200 km/h)  
130 mph (210 km/h)  
149 mph (240 km/h)  
168 mph (270 km/h)  
186 mph (299 km/h)  
M
N
Q
R
S
T
U
H
V
W
Y
Note: For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph  
(240 km/h), tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For  
those with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph (299 km/h), tire  
manufacturers always use the letters ZR.  
8. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN): This begins with the  
letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards. The  
next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it was  
manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last four  
numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example,  
the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers  
go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The  
numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This  
information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall.  
9. M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow, or  
AT: All Terrain, or  
AS: All Season.  
10. Tire Ply Composition and Material Used: Indicates the number of  
plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and  
sidewall. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the  
tire and the sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.  
232  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
11. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum load in kilograms and  
pounds that can be carried by the tire. Refer to the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label, which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door, for the correct tire pressure for your vehicle.  
12. Treadwear, Traction and Temperature Grades  
Treadwear: The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150  
would wear one and one-half (112) times as well on the government  
course as a tire graded 100.  
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B,  
and C. The grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement  
as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test  
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its  
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
13. Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure: Indicates the tire  
manufacturers’ maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at  
which the maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is  
normally higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation  
pressure which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door. The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than  
the recommended pressure on the vehicle label.  
The tire suppliers may have additional markings, notes or warnings such  
as standard load, radial tubeless, etc.  
233  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Additional information contained on the tire sidewall for “LT” type  
tires  
“LT” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below.  
Note: Tire Quality Grades do not  
apply to this type of tire.  
1. LT: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that is intended for service  
on light trucks.  
2. Load Range/Load Inflation  
Limits: Indicates the tire’s  
load-carrying capabilities and its  
inflation limits.  
3. Maximum Load Dual lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a dual; defined  
as four tires on the rear axle (a total of six or more tires on the vehicle).  
4. Maximum Load Single lb (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a single;  
defined as two tires (total) on the rear axle.  
234  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “T” type tires  
“T” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below:  
T145/80D16 is an example of a tire  
size.  
Note: The temporary tire size for  
your vehicle may be different from  
this example. Tire Quality Grades do  
not apply to this type of tire.  
1. T: Indicates a type of tire,  
designated by the Tire and Rim  
Association (T&RA), that is  
intended for temporary service on  
cars, SUVs, minivans and light  
trucks.  
2. 145: Indicates the nominal width  
of the tire in millimeters from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general,  
the larger the number, the wider the tire.  
3. 80: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width. Numbers of 70 or lower indicate a short sidewall.  
4. D: Indicates a “diagonal” type tire.  
R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 16: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
Location of the tire label  
You will find a Tire Label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size  
and other important information located on the B-Pillar or the edge of  
the driver’s door. Refer to the payload description and graphic in the  
Vehicle loading — with and without a trailer section.  
235  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS) (IF EQUIPPED)  
Each tire, including the spare (if  
provided), should be checked  
monthly when cold and inflated to  
the inflation pressure recommended  
by the vehicle manufacturer on the  
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires  
of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire  
inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure  
telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should  
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the  
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the  
tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces  
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling  
and stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire  
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire  
pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger  
illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator  
to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS  
malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.  
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated.  
This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as  
the malfunction exists.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be  
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions  
may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the  
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction  
telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to  
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the  
TPMS to continue to function properly.  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System complies with part 15 of the FCC  
rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
236  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
WARNING: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System is NOT a  
substitute for manually checking tire pressure. The tire pressure  
should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using a tire gauge,  
see Inflating your tires in this chapter. Failure to properly maintain  
your tire pressure could increase the risk of tire failure, loss of control,  
vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
Changing tires with TPMS  
Each road tire is equipped with  
a tire pressure sensor located  
inside the tire/wheel cavity. The  
pressure sensor is attached to  
the valve stem. The pressure  
sensor is covered by the tire and  
is not visible unless the tire is  
removed. Care must be taken  
when changing the tire to avoid  
damaging the sensor. It is  
recommended that you always have your tires serviced by an authorized  
dealer.  
The tire pressure should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using  
an accurate tire gauge, refer to Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
Understanding your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four  
road tires and sends the tire pressure readings to your vehicle. The Low  
Tire Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is significantly low.  
Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under inflated and need to be  
inflated to the manufacturer’s recommended tire pressure. Even if the  
light turns ON and a short time later turns OFF, your tire pressure still  
needs to be checked. Visit www.checkmytires.org for additional  
information.  
When your temporary spare tire is installed  
When one of your road tires needs to be replaced with the temporary  
spare, the TPMS system will continue to identify an issue to remind you  
that the damaged road wheel/tire needs to be repaired and put back on  
your vehicle.  
237  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
To restore the full functionality of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System,  
have the damaged road wheel/tire repaired and remounted on your  
vehicle. For additional information, refer to Changing tires with TPMS  
in this section.  
When you believe your system is not operating properly  
The main function of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System is to warn you  
when your tires need air. It can also warn you in the event the system is no  
longer capable of functioning as intended. Please refer to the following  
chart for information concerning your Tire Pressure Monitoring System:  
Low Tire Pressure Possible cause Customer Action Required  
Warning Light  
Solid Warning Light Tire(s)  
under-inflated  
1. Check your tire pressure to ensure  
tires are properly inflated; refer to  
Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
2. After inflating your tires to the  
manufacturer’s recommended  
inflation pressure as shown on the  
Tire Label (located on the edge of  
driver’s door or the B-Pillar), the  
vehicle must be driven for at least  
two minutes over 20 mph (32 km/h)  
before the light will turn OFF.  
Spare tire in  
use  
Your temporary spare tire is in use.  
Repair the damaged road wheel/tire  
and reinstall it on the vehicle to  
restore system functionality. For a  
description on how the system  
functions, refer to When your  
temporary spare tire is installed in  
this section.  
TPMS  
malfunction  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
your spare tire is not in use and the  
light remains ON, have the system  
inspected by your authorized dealer.  
Tire rotation  
On vehicles with different front and  
without sensor rear tire pressures, the TPMS system  
training  
must be retrained following every  
tire rotation. Refer to Tire rotation  
in this chapter.  
238  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Low Tire Pressure Possible cause Customer Action Required  
Warning Light  
Flashing Warning  
Light  
Spare tire in  
use  
Your temporary spare tire is in use.  
Repair the damaged road wheel and  
re-mount it on the vehicle to restore  
system functionality. For a  
description of how the system  
functions under these conditions,  
refer to When your temporary  
spare tire is installed in this  
section.  
TPMS  
malfunction  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
your spare tire is not in use and the  
TPMS warning light still flashes, have  
the system inspected by your  
authorized dealer.  
When inflating your tires  
When putting air into your tires (such as at a gas station or in your  
garage), the Tire Pressure Monitoring System may not respond  
immediately to the air added to your tires.  
It may take up to two minutes of driving over 20 mph (32 km/h) for the  
light to turn OFF after you have filled your tires to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
How temperature affects your tire pressure  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) monitors tire pressure in  
each pneumatic tire. While driving in a normal manner, a typical  
passenger tire inflation pressure may increase approximately 2 to 4 psi  
(14 to 28 kPa) from a cold start situation. If the vehicle is stationary  
over night with the outside temperature significantly lower than the  
daytime temperature, the tire pressure may decrease approximately 3 psi  
(20.7 kPa) for a drop of 30° F (16.6°C) in ambient temperature. This  
lower pressure value may be detected by the TPMS as being significantly  
lower than the recommended inflation pressure and activate the TPMS  
warning for low tire pressure. If the low tire pressure warning light is  
ON, visually check each tire to verify that no tire is flat. (If one or more  
tires are flat, repair as necessary.) Check air pressure in the road tires. If  
any tire is under-inflated, carefully drive the vehicle to the nearest  
location where air can be added to the tires. Inflate all the tires to the  
recommended inflation pressure.  
239  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TPMS reset procedure  
The TPMS reset procedure needs to be performed after each tire  
rotation on vehicles that require different recommended tire  
pressures in the front tires as compared to the rear tires.  
WARNING: To determine the required pressure(s) for your  
vehicle – refer to the Safety Compliance Certification Label or  
Tire Label located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. See  
Vehicle Loading in this chapter for more information.  
Overview  
To provide the vehicle’s load carrying capability, some vehicles require  
different recommended tire pressures in the front tires as compared to  
the rear tires. The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) equipped on  
these vehicles is designed to illuminate the Low Tire Pressure Warning  
indicator at two different pressures; one for the front tires and one for  
the rear tires.  
Since tires need to be rotated to provide consistent performance and  
maximum tire life, the Tire Pressure Monitoring System needs to know  
when the tires are rotated to determine which set of tires are on the  
front and which are on the rear. With this information, the system can  
detect and properly warn of low tire pressures.  
TPMS reset tips:  
To reduce the chances of interference from another vehicle, the TPMS  
reset procedure should be performed at least 3 feet (1 meter) away  
from another Ford Motor Company vehicle undergoing the TPMS reset  
procedure at the same time.  
Do not wait more than two (2) minutes between resetting each tire  
sensor or the system will timeout and the entire procedure will have  
to be repeated on all four wheels.  
A double horn chirp indicates the need to repeat the procedure.  
Performing the TPMS reset procedure  
It is recommended that you read the entire procedure before attempting.  
1. Drive the vehicle above 20 mph (32 km/h) for at least 2 minutes and  
then park in a safe location where you can easily get to all four tires and  
have access to an air pump.  
2. Place the ignition in the off position and keep the key in the ignition.  
240  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
3. Cycle the ignition to the on  
position with the engine off.  
4. Turn the hazard flashers on then  
off 3 times. This must be  
accomplished within ten seconds.  
If the reset mode has been entered successfully, the horn will sound  
once, the TPMS indicator  
will flash and the message center (if  
equipped) will display TRAIN LEFT FRONT TIRE. If this does not  
occur, please try again starting at step 2.  
If after repeated attempts to enter the reset mode, the horn does not  
sound, the TPMS indicator  
does not flash and the message center (if  
equipped) does not display TRAIN LEFT FRONT TIRE, seek service  
from your authorized dealer.  
5. Train the TPMS sensors in the tires using the following TPMS reset  
sequence starting with the left front tire in the following clockwise  
order:  
Left front (Driver’s side front tire)  
Right front (Passenger’s side front tire)  
Right rear (Passenger’s side rear tire)  
Left rear (Driver’s side rear tire)  
6. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the left front tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
Note: The single horn chirp confirms that the sensor identification code  
has been learned by the module for this position. If a double horn is  
heard, the reset procedure was unsuccessful, and must be repeated.  
7. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the right front tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
241  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
8. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the right rear tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
9. Remove the valve cap from the valve stem on the left rear tire.  
Decrease the air pressure until the horn sounds.  
Training is complete after the horn sounds for the last tire trained  
(driver’s side rear tire), the TPMS tell tale stops flashing, and the  
message center (if equipped) displays:  
TRAINING COMPLETE.  
10. Turn the ignition off. If two short horn beeps are heard, the reset  
procedure was unsuccessful and must be repeated.  
If after repeating the procedure and two short beeps are heard when the  
ignition is turned to off, seek assistance from your authorized dealer.  
11. Set all four tires to the recommended air pressure as indicated on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label located on the  
B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. See Vehicle Loading in this  
chapter for more information.  
SNOW TIRES AND CHAINS  
WARNING: Snow tires must be the same size, load index, speed  
rating as those originally provided by Ford. Use of any tire or  
wheel not recommended by Ford can affect the safety and  
performance of your vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of  
loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
Additionally, the use of non-recommended tires and wheels could  
cause steering, suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit  
failure.  
Note: Do not use snow chains on vehicles with 20 inch wheels and tires.  
The tires on your vehicle have all weather treads to provide traction in  
rain and snow. However, in some climates, you may need to use snow  
tires and chains. If you need to use chains, it is recommended that steel  
wheels (of the same size and specifications) be used, as chains may chip  
aluminum wheels.  
Follow these guidelines when using snow tires and chains:  
Use only SAE Class S chains.  
Install chains securely, verifying that the chains do not touch any  
wiring, brake lines or fuel lines.  
242  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Drive cautiously. If you hear the chains rub or bang against your  
vehicle, stop and re-tighten the chains. If this does not work, remove  
the chains to prevent damage to your vehicle.  
If possible, avoid fully loading your vehicle.  
Remove the tire chains when they are no longer needed. Do not use  
tire chains on dry roads.  
The suspension insulation and bumpers will help prevent vehicle  
damage. Do not remove these components from your vehicle when  
using snow tires and chains.  
VEHICLE LOADING – WITH AND WITHOUT A TRAILER  
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or  
trailer, to keep your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating  
capability, with or without a trailer. Properly loading your vehicle will  
provide maximum return of vehicle design performance. Before loading  
your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining  
your vehicle’s weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle’s  
Tire Label or Safety Compliance Certification Label:  
Base Curb Weight – is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of  
fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or  
optional equipment.  
Vehicle Curb Weight – is the weight of your new vehicle when you  
picked it up from your authorized dealer plus any aftermarket  
equipment.  
243  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Payload – is the combined weight of cargo and passengers that the  
vehicle is carrying. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found  
on the Tire Label on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door  
(vehicles exported outside the US and Canada may not have a Tire  
Label). Look for “THE COMBINED WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND  
CARGO SHOULD NEVER EXCEED XXX kg OR XXX lb.” for  
maximum payload. The payload listed on the Tire Label is the maximum  
payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If any aftermarket  
or authorized-dealer installed equipment has been installed on the  
vehicle, the weight of the equipment must be subtracted from the  
payload listed on the Tire Label in order to determine the new payload.  
WARNING: The appropriate loading capacity of your vehicle can  
be limited either by volume capacity (how much space is  
available) or by payload capacity (how much weight the vehicle should  
carry). Once you have reached the maximum payload of your vehicle,  
do not add more cargo, even if there is space available. Overloading or  
improperly loading your vehicle can contribute to loss of vehicle  
control and vehicle rollover.  
244  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
Cargo Weight – includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight,  
including cargo and optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load  
or king pin weight is also part of cargo weight.  
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) – is the total weight placed on each axle  
(front and rear) – including vehicle curb weight and all payload.  
245  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These  
numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. The total  
load on each axle must never exceed its GAWR.  
Note: For trailer towing information refer to Trailer towing found in  
this chapter or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer.  
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) – is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo +  
passengers.  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment,  
passengers and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the Safety  
Compliance Certification Label located on the B-Pillar or the  
edge of the driver’s door. The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.  
246  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
WARNING: Exceeding the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
vehicle weight rating limits could result in substandard vehicle  
handling or performance, engine, transmission and/or structural  
damage, serious damage to the vehicle, loss of control and personal  
injury.  
247  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCW (Gross Combined Weight) – is the weight of the loaded vehicle  
(GVW) plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer.  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the vehicle and the loaded trailer – including all cargo and  
passengers – that the vehicle can handle without risking damage.  
(Important: The towing vehicle’s braking system is rated for operation at  
GVWR, not at GCWR.) Separate functional brakes should be used for  
safe control of towed vehicles and for trailers where the GCW of the  
towing vehicle plus the trailer exceed the GVWR of the towing vehicle.  
The GCW must never exceed the GCWR.  
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight – is the highest possible weight of a  
fully loaded trailer the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only  
mandatory options, no cargo (internal or external), a tongue load of  
10–15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15–25% (fifth wheel  
trailer), and driver only (150 lb. [68 kg]). Consult your authorized  
dealer (or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer) for more detailed information.  
Tongue Load or Fifth Wheel King Pin Weight – refers to the amount  
of the weight that a trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.  
Examples: For a 5,000 lb. (2,268 kg) conventional trailer, multiply 5,000  
by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lb.  
(227 to 340 kg). For an 11,500 lb. (5,216 kg) fifth wheel trailer, multiply  
by 0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to  
2,875 lb. (782 to 1,304 kg)  
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label.  
248  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Do not use replacement tires with lower load  
carrying capacities than the original tires because they may  
lower the vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement tires  
with a higher limit than the original tires do not increase the GVWR  
and GAWR limitations.  
WARNING: Exceeding any vehicle weight rating limitation could  
result in serious damage to the vehicle and/or personal injury.  
Steps for determining the correct load limit:  
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo  
should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lb.” on your vehicle’s placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will  
be riding in your vehicle.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX  
kg or XXX lb.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage  
load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lb. and  
there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (1400-750 (5 x 150)  
= 650 lb.). In metric units (635-340 (5 x 68) = 295 kg.)  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on  
the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
The following gives you a few examples on how to calculate the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity:  
Another example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You decide to go golfing. Is there enough load  
capacity to carry you, 4 of your friends and all the golf bags? You and  
four friends average 220 lb. (99 kg) each and the golf bags weigh  
approximately 30 lb. (13.5 kg) each. The calculation would be: 1400 -  
(5 x 220) - (5 x 30) = 1400 - 1100 - 150 = 150 lb. Yes, you have  
enough load capacity in your vehicle to transport four friends and  
your golf bags. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (5 x  
99 kg) - (5 x 13.5 kg) = 635 - 495 - 67.5 = 72.5 kg.  
249  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
A final example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You and one of your friends decide to pick up  
cement from the local home improvement store to finish that patio  
you have been planning for the past 2 years. Measuring the inside of  
the vehicle with the rear seat folded down, you have room for  
12-100 lb. (45 kg) bags of cement. Do you have enough load capacity  
to transport the cement to your home? If you and your friend each  
weigh 220 lb. (99 kg), the calculation would be: 1400 - (2 x 220) - (12  
x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 1200 = - 240 lb. No, you do not have enough  
cargo capacity to carry that much weight. In metric units, the  
calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (12 x 45 kg) = 635 - 198 -  
540 = -103 kg. You will need to reduce the load weight by at least  
240 lb. (104 kg). If you remove 3-100 lb. (45 kg) cement bags, then  
the load calculation would be:  
1400 - (2 x 220) - (9 x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 900 = 60 lb. Now you have  
the load capacity to transport the cement and your friend home. In  
metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (9 x  
45 kg) = 635 - 198 - 405 = 32 kg.  
The above calculations also assume that the loads are positioned in your  
vehicle in a manner that does not overload the Front or the Rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating specified for your vehicle on the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label found on the edge of the driver’s door.  
Special loading instructions for owners of pickup trucks and  
utility-type vehicles  
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation  
of this type of vehicle, see the Preparing to drive your vehicle  
section in the Driving chapter of this Owner’s Guide.  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles may handle differently than  
unloaded vehicles. Extra precautions, such as slower speeds and  
increased stopping distance, should be taken when driving a heavily  
loaded vehicle.  
Your vehicle can haul more cargo and people than most passenger cars.  
Depending upon the type and placement of the load, hauling cargo and  
people may raise the center of gravity of the vehicle.  
250  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TRAILER TOWING  
Note: The trailer towing charts in this section apply to vehicles equipped  
with gasoline engines; for vehicles equipped with diesel engines, refer to  
your Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide  
Supplement.  
Your vehicle may tow a Conventional/Class IV trailer or fifth wheel trailer  
provided the maximum trailer weight is less than or equal to the  
maximum trailer weight listed for your engine and rear axle ratio on the  
following charts.  
To calculate your maximum trailer weight:  
For pickup trucks: Take curb weight, hitch hardware and the driver’s  
weight, then subtract them from the GCWR listed for your vehicle series,  
engine, transmission and drive axle ratio (refer to the chart/table in the  
following text). This calculation will give you the maximum trailer  
weight possible for your vehicle.  
For chassis cabs and pickup trucks with aftermarket equipment:  
Weigh your vehicle at a certified scale and subtract this actual curb  
weight, hitch hardware, and the driver’s weight from the GCWR listed for  
your vehicle series, engine, transmission and drive axle ratio (refer to  
the chart/table in the following text). This calculation will give you the  
maximum trailer weight possible for your vehicle.  
The weight of all additional cargo and passengers must be subtracted  
from the maximum trailer weight calculated above.  
Further trailer/hitch restrictions and limitations exist depending on the  
type of trailer and hitch used. These additional maximum trailer weight  
and tongue load limitations are listed in the chart/table that follows the  
listing of GCWRs.  
Towing a trailer places an additional load on your vehicle’s engine,  
transmission, axle, brakes, tires and suspension. Inspect these  
components carefully prior to and after any towing operation. Refer to  
Transmission fluid temperature gauge in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for the transmission fluid temperature information.  
Note: Do not exceed the GCWR listed for your vehicle on the following  
chart/table, or the GVWR, GAWR or tire ratings specified on the Tire  
Label or Safety Compliance Certification Label.  
WARNING: Towing trailers beyond the maximum recommended  
trailer weight which exceeds the limit of the vehicle’s GCWR,  
GVWR, GAWR or tire ratings could result in engine damage,  
transmission damage, structural damage, loss of vehicle control, vehicle  
rollover and personal injury.  
251  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Maximum GCWR - lb. (kg.)  
Engine  
Rear axle  
ratio  
Manual  
transmission  
Automatic  
transmission  
F–250 Pick-up  
5.4L  
6.8L  
3.73  
4.10  
4.10  
4.30  
15000 (6804)  
17000 (7711)  
20000 (9072)  
22000 (9979)  
16000 (7257)  
18000 (8165)  
21000 (9525)  
22500 (10206)  
F–350 Single Rear Wheel (SRW) Pick-up  
5.4L  
6.8L  
3.73  
4.10  
4.10  
4.30  
15000 (6804)  
17000 (7711)  
20000 (9072)  
22000 (9979)  
16000 (7257)  
18000 (8165)  
21000 (9525)  
23000 (10433)  
F–350 Dual Rear Wheel (DRW) Pick-up  
5.4L  
6.8L  
4.10  
4.10  
18500 (8391)  
23000 (10433)  
F–350 Single Rear Wheel (SRW) Chassis Cab  
5.4L  
6.8L  
5.4L  
6.8L  
3.73  
4.10  
4.10  
16000 (7257)  
18000 (8165)  
21000 (9525)  
F–350 Dual Rear Wheel (DRW) Chassis Cab  
3.73  
4.10  
4.10  
4.30  
15000 (6804)  
17500 (7938)  
20500 (9299)  
22500 (10206)  
16500 (7484)  
18500 (8391)  
21500 (9752)  
23000 (10433)  
F–450 Chassis Cab/F–550  
4.88/5.38 26000 (11793)  
6.8L  
26000 (11793)  
Preparing to tow  
Use the proper equipment for towing a trailer and make sure it is  
properly attached to your vehicle. Contact your authorized dealer or a  
reliable trailer dealer as soon as possible if you require assistance.  
252  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Hitches  
WARNING: ON PICK-UP TRUCKS, the trailer hitch provided on  
this vehicle enhances collision protection for the fuel system. DO  
NOT REMOVE!  
Do not mount a ball hitch (sometimes referred to as a trailer ball hitch  
or trailer ball) to the bumper or use hitches that clamp onto the vehicle’s  
bumper or attach to the axle. You must distribute the load in your trailer  
so that 10%–15% for conventional towing or 15%-25% fifth-wheel towing  
of the total weight of the trailer is on the tongue.  
Hitch rating  
The standard hitch has two ratings depending on mode of operation:  
Weight carrying - requires a draw bar and hitch ball. The draw bar  
supports all the vertical tongue load of the trailer.  
Weight distributing - requires an aftermarket weight distributing  
system which includes draw bar, hitch ball, spring bars and snap-up  
brackets. The vertical tongue load of the trailer is distributed between  
the truck and the trailer by this system.  
Maximum  
Maximum  
Gross Trailer  
Weight — lb.  
(kg)  
Hitch Type  
Tongue Weight  
— lb. (kg)  
6.8L DRW Pickup Weight carrying  
8000 (3629)  
800 (363)  
2.5” ID without  
Weight  
15000 (6804)  
1500 (680)  
adapter (requires  
distributing  
2.5” drawbar)  
6.8L DRW Pickup Weight carrying  
6000 (2721)  
12500 (5670)  
600 (272)  
2.5” ID with  
Weight  
1250 (567)  
adapter (requires  
distributing  
2” drawbar)  
All SRW Pickups Weight carrying  
6000 (2721)  
12500 (5670)  
600 (272)  
and 5.4L DRW  
Pickups  
Weight  
1250 (567)  
distributing  
2” receiver  
253  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Towing trailers beyond the maximum tongue weight  
exceeds the limit of the towing system and could result in  
vehicle structural damage, loss of vehicle control and personal injury.  
Weight distributing hitch  
When hooking up a trailer using a load equalizing hitch, always use the  
following procedure:  
1. Park the unloaded vehicle on a level surface. With the ignition on and  
all doors closed, allow the vehicle to stand for several minutes so that it  
can level.  
2. Measure the height of a reference point on the front and rear bumpers  
at the center of the vehicle.  
3. Attach the trailer to the vehicle and adjust the hitch equalizers so that  
1
the front bumper height is within 2 inch (13 mm) of the reference  
point. After proper adjustment, the rear bumper should be no higher  
than in Step 2.  
WARNING: Do not adjust a weight distributing hitch to any  
position where the rear bumper of the vehicle is higher than it  
was before attaching the trailer. Doing so will defeat the function of  
the weight distributing hitch, which may cause unpredictable handling,  
and could result in serious personal injury.  
Safety chains  
Always connect the trailer’s safety chains to the frame or hook retainers  
of the vehicle hitch. To connect the trailer’s safety chains, cross the  
chains under the trailer tongue and allow slack for turning corners.  
If you use a rental trailer, follow the instructions that the rental agency  
gives to you.  
Do not attach safety chains to the bumper.  
254  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Trailer brakes  
Electric brakes and manual, automatic or surge-type trailer brakes are  
safe if installed properly and adjusted to the manufacturer’s  
specifications. The trailer brakes must meet local and Federal  
regulations.  
WARNING: If you own a trailer with a hydraulic brake system,  
do not connect the trailer’s hydraulic brake system directly to  
your vehicle’s brake system. The vehicle’s brake system is only  
designed to carry the appropriate amount of brake fluid for the vehicle  
alone. Connecting a hydraulic trailer braking system could adversely  
affect your vehicle’s braking performance.  
The braking system of the tow vehicle is rated for operation at the  
GVWR not GCWR.  
Integrated trailer brake controller (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a fully integrated electronic Trailer  
Brake Controller (TBC). When used properly, the TBC helps ensure  
smooth and effective trailer braking by powering the trailer’s electric  
brakes with a proportional output based on the towing vehicle’s brake  
pressure.  
WARNING: The Ford TBC has only been verified to be  
compatible with trailers having electric-actuated drum brakes  
(one to four axles) and not hydraulic surge or electric-over-hydraulic  
types. It is the responsibility of the customer to ensure that the trailer  
brakes are adjusted appropriately, functioning normally and all electric  
connections are properly made.  
The TBC user interface consists of  
the following:  
1. +/- (GAIN adjustment  
buttons): Pressing these buttons  
will adjust the TBC’s power output  
to the trailer brakes (in  
0.5 increments). The GAIN setting  
can be increased to a maximum of  
10.0 or decreased to a minimum of 0 (no trailer braking). Pressing and  
holding a button will raise or lower the setting continuously. The gain  
setting will display in the message center as follows: TBC GAIN = XX.X.  
255  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
The trailer brake controller (TBC) is designed to display three items of  
information in the instrument cluster message center. These are: gain  
setting, output bar graph, and trailer connectivity status. They will  
appear as follows in the message center.  
TBC GAIN = XX.X NO TRAILER: The instrument cluster message  
center will display the current gain setting during a given ignition  
cycle and when adjusting the gain. This message is also displayed  
during manual activation without a trailer connected or when gain  
adjustments are made with no trailer connected.  
TBC GAIN = XX.X OUTPUT = //////: When the vehicle’s brake pedal  
is pushed, or when the manual control is activated, bar indicators will  
illuminate in the instrument cluster message center to indicate the  
amount of power going to the trailer brakes relative to the brake pedal  
or manual control input. One bar indicates the least amount of output  
with six bars indicating maximum output.  
TRAILER CONNECTED: This message is displayed when a correct  
trailer wiring connection (a trailer with electric trailer brakes) has  
been sensed during a given ignition cycle.  
TRAILER DISCONNECTED: This message is displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime, when a trailer connection was  
determined and then a disconnection, either intentionally or  
unintentionally, has been sensed during a given ignition cycle. It is also  
displayed if a truck or trailer wiring fault occurs causing the trailer to  
appear disconnected. This message is also displayed during manual  
activation without a trailer connected.  
2. Manual control lever: Slide the control lever to the left to activate  
power to the trailer’s electric brakes independent of the tow vehicle’s  
brakes (see the following Procedure for adjusting GAIN section for  
instructions on proper use of this feature). If the manual control is  
activated while the brake is also applied, the greater of the two inputs  
determines the power sent to the trailer brakes.  
Stop Lamps: Activating the TBC manual control lever will illuminate  
both the trailer brake lamps and the tow vehicle brake lamps except  
the Center High-Mount Stop Lamp (presuming proper trailer electrical  
connection). Pressing the vehicle brake pedal will also illuminate both  
trailer and vehicle brake lamps.  
Procedure for adjusting GAIN:  
The GAIN setting is used to set the TBC for the specific towing  
condition and should be changed as towing conditions change. Changes  
to towing conditions include trailer load, vehicle load, road conditions  
and weather.  
256  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
The GAIN should be set to provide the maximum trailer braking  
assistance while ensuring the trailer wheels do not lock when braking.  
Locked trailer wheels may lead to trailer instability.  
Note: This should only be performed in a traffic free environment at  
speeds of approximately 20–25 mph (30–40 km/h).  
1. Make sure the trailer brakes are in good working condition,  
functioning normally, and properly adjusted. See your trailer dealer if  
necessary.  
2. Hook up the trailer and make the electrical connections according to  
the trailer manufacturer’s instructions.  
3. When a trailer with electric brakes is plugged in, the TRAILER  
CONNECTED message will display in the instrument cluster message  
center.  
4. Use the GAIN adjustment (+/-) buttons to increase or decrease the  
GAIN setting to the desired starting point. A GAIN setting of 6.0 is a  
good starting point for heavier loads.  
5. In a traffic-free environment, tow the trailer on a dry, level surface at  
a speed of 20–25 mph (30–40 km/h) and squeeze the manual control  
lever completely.  
6. If the trailer wheels lock-up (indicated by squealing tires), reduce the  
GAIN setting; if the trailer wheels turn freely, increase the GAIN setting.  
Repeat Steps 5 and 6 until the GAIN setting is at a point just below  
trailer wheel lock-up. If towing a heavier trailer, trailer wheel lockup may  
not be attainable even with the maximum GAIN setting of 10.  
Explanation of instrument cluster warning messages:  
The TBC interacts with the instrument cluster message center to display  
the following messages:  
TRAILER BRAKE MODULE FAULT: This message is displayed and  
accompanied by a single chime, in response to faults sensed by the TBC.  
In the event this message is seen, please contact your authorized dealer  
as soon as possible for diagnosis and repair. The TBC may still function,  
but performance may be degraded.  
WIRING FAULT ON TRAILER: This message is displayed when a  
Short circuit on the electric brake output wire has occurred. If the  
WIRING FAULT ON TRAILER message is displayed and accompanied  
by a single chime, with no trailer connected, the problem is with the  
vehicle wiring from the TBC to the 7–pin connector in the bumper. If the  
message is only displayed with a trailer connected, the problem is related  
257  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
to the trailer wiring; consult your trailer dealer for assistance. This can  
be a short to ground (i.e., chaffed wire) or a short to voltage (i.e., pulled  
pin on trailer emergency break-away battery) or trailer brakes drawing  
too much current.  
Note: Your TBC can be diagnosed by your authorized dealer to  
determine exactly which trailer fault has occurred; however, if the fault  
is with the trailer this diagnosis is not covered under your Ford  
warranty.  
Points to Remember:  
Remember to adjust gain setting before using the TBC for the first  
time.  
Readjust GAIN setting on the TBC (according to procedure above)  
whenever road, weather and trailer or vehicle loading conditions  
change from those that existed when the gain was initially set.  
The sliding lever on the TBC should be used only for manual  
activation of trailer brakes to assist with proper adjustment of the  
GAIN. Misuse, such as application during trailer sway, could cause  
instability of trailer and/or tow vehicle.  
Avoid towing in adverse weather conditions. The TBC does not  
provide anti-lock control of the trailer wheels. Trailer wheels can  
lock-up on slippery surfaces, resulting in reduced stability of trailer  
and tow vehicle.  
The TBC interacts with the brake system of the vehicle, including  
ABS, in order to reduce the likelihood of trailer wheel lockup.  
Therefore, if these systems are not functioning properly the TBC may  
not function at full performance.  
When the vehicle is turned off, the TBC Output is disabled and the  
display is shut down. Reactivation of the ignition from OFF to ON will  
awaken the TBC module.  
The TBC is only a factory or dealer installed item. Ford is not  
responsible for warranty or performance of the TBC due to misuse or  
customer installation.  
Do not attempt removal of the TBC without consulting the  
Workshop Manual. Damage to the unit may result.  
Trailer lamps  
Trailer lamps are required on most towed vehicles. Make sure all running  
lights, brake lights, turn signals and hazard lights are working. Contact  
your authorized dealer or trailer rental agency for proper instructions  
and equipment for hooking up trailer lamps.  
258  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Driving while you tow  
When towing a trailer:  
Do not drive faster than 70 mph (113 km/h) during the first 500 miles  
(800 km) of trailer towing and don’t make full-throttle starts.  
Turn off the speed control. The speed control may shut off  
automatically when you are towing on long, steep grades.  
Consult your local motor vehicle speed regulations for towing a trailer.  
To eliminate excessive transmission shifting, activate the Tow/Haul  
feature. This will also assist in transmission cooling. For additional  
information, refer to Automatic transmission operation in the  
Driving chapter.  
Anticipate stops and brake gradually.  
Do not exceed the GCWR rating or transmission damage may occur.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a temporary or conventional spare  
tire. If the spare tire is different in size (diameter and/or width), tread  
type (All-Season or All-Terrain) or is from a different manufacturer  
other than the road tires on your vehicle, your spare tire is considered  
“temporary”. Consult information on the spare Tire Label or Safety  
Compliance Certification Label for limitations when using.  
Servicing after towing  
If you tow a trailer for long distances, your vehicle will require more  
frequent service intervals. Refer to your scheduled maintenance  
information for more information.  
Trailer towing safety tips  
General  
Ensure that the trailer, safety chains and 7–pin electrical connectors  
are securely fastened.  
Make sure the truck receiver, draw bar, and coupler are properly  
connected and adjusted.  
Check rear view and side mirrors for proper visibility especially when  
towing trailer wider than the truck.  
When towing, operate the vehicle at lower speeds than you would  
when not towing a trailer. The likelihood of trailer sway is greater at  
higher speeds.  
259  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
If you will be towing a trailer frequently in hot weather, hilly  
conditions, at GCWR, or any combination of these factors, consider  
refilling your rear axle with synthetic gear lubricant if not already so  
equipped. Refer to Maintenance Product Specifications and  
Capacities in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter for the  
proper axle lubricant. Remember that regardless of the rear axle  
lubricant used, do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles (800 km) of  
a new vehicle, and that the first 500 miles of towing be done at no  
faster than 70 mph (113 km/h) with no full-throttle starts.  
When turning make wide turns to allow trailer tires to properly clear  
any obstacles.  
Be prepared for trailer sway due to buffeting when larger vehicles  
pass in either direction.  
Loading  
Keep the center-of-gravity low for best handling.  
Trailer loads should be evenly distributed front to back and left to  
right.  
The load distribution within the trailer should be such that 10%–15%  
of the trailer weight is on the hitch. (15%–25% for fifth-wheel or  
gooseneck towing.)  
Never exceed truck, trailer, receiver, ball, tongue, tire or coupler  
loading recommendations.  
Braking  
The trailer brakes must be inspected and serviced at intervals  
specified by the manufacturer. This includes the shoes, drum and  
trailer brake magnets.  
Electric brakes also require periodic adjustment to keep the shoes  
properly spaced. If the brakes get hot when driving or if they will not  
hold, chances are that they need adjustment.  
Anticipate the need to stop; allow much more distance and time to  
stop than normal.  
Do not apply the trailer brakes for extended periods of time as they  
can overheat and lose effectiveness.  
260  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Backing up  
Practice backing up, particularly if you are a novice. Turn the steering  
wheel to the right to move the trailer’s rear end to the right.  
Sharp steering movements may cause the trailer to jackknife or go out  
of control.  
Tires  
All trailer tires should be of the same size, and construction.  
Select tires that meet the trailer loading requirements.  
Always check tow vehicle and trailer tire pressure before towing.  
Launching or retrieving a boat  
Disconnect the wiring to the trailer before backing the trailer  
into the water. Reconnect the wiring to the trailer after the  
trailer is removed from the water.  
When backing down a ramp during boat launching or retrieval:  
do not allow the static water level to rise above the bottom edge of  
the rear bumper.  
do not allow waves to break higher than 6 inches (15 cm) above the  
bottom edge of the rear bumper.  
Exceeding these limits may allow water to enter vehicle components:  
causing internal damage to the components.  
affecting driveability, emissions and reliability.  
Replace the rear axle lubricant any time the axle has been submerged in  
water. Rear axle lubricant quantities are not to be checked or changed  
unless a leak is suspected or repair required.  
261  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
RECREATIONAL TOWING  
Follow these guidelines if you have a need for recreational (RV) towing.  
An example of recreational towing would be towing your vehicle behind  
a motorhome. These guidelines are designed to ensure that your  
transmission is not damaged.  
Note: Put your climate control system in recirculated air mode to  
prevent exhaust fumes from entering the vehicle. Refer to the Climate  
controls chapter for more information.  
Transmission  
Drivetrain  
configuration  
Requirements for  
neutral towing  
Manual  
4x4 with manual-shift  
transfer case  
Transmission in (N)  
Neutral; Transfer case  
in (N) (Neutral);  
Automatic  
Manual  
Hublocks set to FREE1  
Do not tow your  
4X2 or 4x4 with  
electronic-shift  
transfer case  
vehicle with any  
wheels on the ground,  
as vehicle or  
transmission damage  
may occur. It is  
recommended to tow  
your vehicle with all  
four (4) wheels off the  
ground such as when  
using a car-hauling  
trailer. Otherwise, no  
recreational towing is  
permitted.  
Automatic  
1Always make sure that both hub locks are set to the same position.  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle, see Wrecker  
towing in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
262  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
STARTING  
Positions of the ignition  
1. Off— shuts off the engine and all  
accessories/locks the steering wheel  
and allows key removal.  
2. Accessory— allows the electrical  
accessories such as the radio to  
operate while the engine is not  
running. This position also unlocks  
the steering wheel.  
3. On— all electrical circuits  
operational. Warning lights  
illuminated. Key position when driving.  
4. Start— cranks the engine. Release the key as soon as the engine  
starts.  
Preparing to start your vehicle  
Engine starting is controlled by the powertrain control system.  
This system meets all Canadian interference-causing equipment standard  
requirements regulating the impulse electrical field strength of radio  
noise.  
When starting a fuel-injected engine, don’t press the accelerator before  
or during starting. Only use the accelerator when you have difficulty  
starting the engine. For more information on starting the vehicle, refer to  
Starting the engine in this chapter.  
WARNING: Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce  
very high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system,  
creating the risk of fire or other damage.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
WARNING: Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in  
other enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open  
the garage door before you start the engine. See Guarding against  
exhaust fumes in this chapter for more instructions.  
263  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important safety precautions  
When the engine starts, the idle RPM runs faster to warm the engine. If  
the engine idle speed does not slow down automatically, have the vehicle  
checked. If your vehicle is operated in a heavy snow storm or blowing  
snow conditions, the engine air induction may become partially clogged  
with snow and/or ice. If this occurs, the engine may experience a  
significant reduction in power output. At the earliest opportunity, clear  
all the snow and/or ice away from the air induction inlet. The following  
starting instructions are for vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine; if  
your vehicle is equipped with a Diesel engine, refer to Starting the  
engine in your 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo  
Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement.  
Before starting the vehicle:  
1. Make sure all occupants buckle their safety belts. For more  
information on safety belts and their proper usage, refer to the Seating  
and Safety Restraints chapter.  
2. Make sure the headlamps and electrical accessories are off.  
If starting a vehicle with an automatic transmission:  
1. Make sure the parking brake is  
set.  
2. Make sure the gearshift is in P  
(Park).  
264  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
If starting a vehicle with a manual  
transmission:  
1. Make sure the parking brake is  
set.  
2. Push the clutch pedal to the floor.  
Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start).  
Some warning lights will briefly illuminate. See Warning lights and  
chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter for more information  
regarding the warning lights.  
Starting the engine  
1. Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start). If there  
is difficulty in turning the key,  
rotate the steering wheel until the  
key turns freely. This condition may  
occur when:  
the front wheels are turned  
a front wheel is against the curb  
2. Turn the key to 4 (start), then  
release the key as soon as the  
engine begins cranking. Your vehicle has a computer assisted cranking  
system that assists in starting the engine. After releasing the key from  
the 4 (start) position, the engine may continue cranking for up to  
10 seconds or until the vehicle starts.  
265  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Note: Cranking may be stopped at any time by turning the key to the off  
position.  
3. After idling for a few seconds, release the parking brake, apply the  
brake, shift into gear and drive.  
Note: If the engine does not start on the first try, turn the key to the off  
position, wait 10 seconds and try Step 2 again. If the engine still fails to  
start, press the accelerator to the floor and try Step 2 again, keeping the  
accelerator on the floor until the engine begins to accelerate above  
cranking speeds; this will allow the engine to crank with the fuel shut off  
in case the engine is flooded with fuel.  
Guarding against exhaust fumes  
Carbon monoxide is present in exhaust fumes. Take precautions to avoid  
its dangerous effects.  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important ventilating information  
If the engine is idling while the vehicle is stopped for a long period of  
time, open the windows at least 1 inch (2.5 cm) or adjust the heating or  
air conditioning to bring in fresh air.  
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER  
An engine block heater warms the engine coolant which aids in starting  
and allows the heater/defroster system to respond quickly. If your vehicle  
is equipped with this system, your equipment includes a heater element  
which is installed in your engine block and a wire harness which allows  
the user to connect the system to a grounded 120 volt A/C electrical  
source. The block heater system is most effective when outdoor  
temperatures reach below 0°F (-18°C).  
WARNING: Failure to follow engine block heater instructions  
could result in property damage or physical harm.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use  
your heater with ungrounded electrical systems or two-pronged  
(cheater) adapters.  
266  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Prior to using the engine block heater, follow these recommendations for  
proper and safe operation:  
For your safety, use an outdoor extension cord that is product  
certified by Underwriter’s laboratory (UL ) or Canadian Standards  
Association (CSA). Use only an extension cord that can be used  
outdoors, in cold temperatures, and is clearly marked ЉSuitable for Use  
with Outdoor Appliances.Љ Never use an indoor extension cord  
outdoors; it could result in an electric shock or fire hazard.  
Use a 16 gauge outdoor extension cord, minimum.  
Use as short an extension cord as possible.  
Do not use multiple extension cords. Instead, use one extension cord  
which is long enough to reach from the engine block heater cord to  
the outlet without stretching.  
Make certain that the extension cord is in excellent condition (not  
patched or spliced). Store your extension cord indoors at  
temperatures above 32°F (0°C). Outdoor conditions can deteriorate  
extension cords over a period of time.  
To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use your heater with  
ungrounded electrical systems or two pronged (cheater) adapters.  
Also ensure that the block heater, especially the cord, is in good  
condition before use.  
Make sure that when in operation, the extension cord plug /engine  
block heater cord plug connection is free and clear of water in order  
to prevent possible shock or fire.  
Be sure that areas where the vehicle is parked are clean and clear of  
all combustibles such as petroleum products, dust, rags, paper and  
similar items.  
Be sure that the engine block heater, heater cord and extension cord  
are solidly connected. A poor connection can cause the cord to  
become very hot and may result in an electrical shock or fire. Be sure  
to check for heat anywhere in the electrical hookup once the system  
has been operating for approximately a half hour.  
Finally, have the engine block heater system checked during your fall  
tune-up to be sure it’s in good working order.  
How to Use the Engine Block Heater  
Ensure the receptacle terminals are clean and dry prior to use. To clean  
them, use a dry cloth.  
Depending on the type of factory installed equipment, your engine block  
heater system may consume anywhere between 400 watts or 1000 watts  
267  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
of power per hour. Your factory installed block heater system does not  
have a thermostat; however, maximum temperature is attained after  
approximately 3 hours of operation. Block heater operation longer than  
3 hours will not improve system performance and will unnecessarily use  
additional electricity.  
Make sure system is unplugged and properly stowed before driving the  
vehicle. While not in use, make sure the protective cover seals the  
prongs of the engine block heater cord plug.  
BRAKES  
Occasional brake noise is normal. If a metal-to-metal, continuous grinding  
or continuous squeal sound is present, the brake linings may be worn-out  
and should be inspected by an authorized dealer. If the vehicle has  
continuous vibration or shudder in the steering wheel while braking, the  
vehicle should be inspected by an authorized dealer.  
Refer to Warning lights and  
!
P
chimes in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for information on the brake  
system warning light.  
BRAKE  
Four-wheel anti-lock brake system (ABS) (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with an Anti-lock Braking System (ABS).  
This system helps you maintain steering control during emergency stops  
by keeping the brakes from locking. The ABS operates by detecting the  
onset of wheel lockup during brake application and compensates for this  
tendency. Noise from the ABS pump motor and brake pedal pulsation  
may be observed during ABS braking; any pulsation or mechanical noise  
you may feel or hear is normal. In addition, the ABS performs a  
self-check after you start the engine and begin to drive away. A brief  
mechanical noise may be heard during this test. This is normal.  
ABS warning lamp  
The ABS lamp in the instrument  
cluster momentarily illuminates  
ABS  
when the ignition is turned on. If  
the light does not illuminate during  
start up, remains on or flashes, the  
ABS may be disabled and may need to be serviced.  
268  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Even when the ABS is disabled,  
normal braking is still effective. If  
your BRAKE warning lamp  
illuminates with the parking brake  
released, have your brake system  
serviced immediately by an authorized dealer.  
!
P
BRAKE  
Using ABS  
When hard braking is required, apply continuous force on the brake  
pedal; do not pump the brake pedal since this will reduce the  
effectiveness of the ABS and will increase your vehicle’s stopping  
distance. The ABS will be activated immediately, allowing you to retain  
steering control during hard braking and on slippery surfaces. However,  
the ABS does not decrease stopping distance.  
Parking brake  
To set the parking brake, press the  
parking brake pedal down until the  
pedal stops.  
The BRAKE warning lamp in the  
!
P
instrument cluster illuminates and  
remains illuminated until the  
parking brake is released.  
BRAKE  
269  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Pull the release lever to release the  
parking brake. To prevent the pedal  
from releasing too quickly, place  
your left foot on the service brake  
pedal, then slowly pull the release  
lever until the pedal slowly releases.  
Make sure that the pedal is fully  
released. You may want to pull the  
release lever again to make sure the  
parking brake is fully released.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
that the gearshift is securely latched in P (Park) (automatic  
transmission) or in 1 (First) (manual transmission).  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, the engine  
may be required to run while power accessories operate and the parking  
brake is set. It is recommended that wheel chocks be used during this  
operation.  
If you’re parking your vehicle on a grade or with a trailer, press and hold  
the brake pedal down, then set the parking brake. There may be a little  
vehicle movement as the parking brake sets to hold the vehicle’s weight.  
This is normal and should be no reason for concern. If needed, press and  
hold the service brake pedal down, then try reapplying the parking  
brake. Chock the wheels if required. If the parking brake cannot hold the  
weight of the vehicle, the parking brake may need to be serviced or the  
vehicle may be overloaded.  
TRACTION CONTROL™ (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Traction Control™ system. This  
system helps you maintain the stability and steerability of your vehicle,  
especially on slippery road surfaces such as snow- or ice-covered roads  
and gravel roads. The system will allow your vehicle to make better use  
of available traction in these conditions.  
During Traction Control™ operation,  
the traction control light will  
illuminate and the engine will not  
“rev-up” when you push further on  
the accelerator. This is normal  
system behavior and should be no  
reason for concern. Also, if traction control is on when the vehicle is put  
270  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
into four-wheel drive mode (if equipped), the traction control system will  
be automatically disabled. Traction control operation will resume when  
the vehicle is placed back into two-wheel drive mode.  
WARNING: Aggressive driving in any road conditions can cause  
you to lose control of your vehicle increasing the risk of severe  
personal injury or property damage. The occurrence of a Traction  
Control™ event is an indication that at least some of the tires have  
exceeded their ability to grip the road; this may lead to an increased  
risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and  
death. If you experience a severe road event, SLOW DOWN.  
The Traction Control™ switch,  
located on the instrument panel to  
the left of the climate control  
system, has an indicator light that  
illuminates when the system is off.  
The Traction Control™ system will  
automatically turn on every time the  
ignition is turned off and on. The  
Traction Control™ system should normally be left on.  
If you should become stuck in snow or ice or on a very slippery road  
surface, try switching the Traction Control™ system off. This may allow  
excess wheel spin to “dig” the vehicle out and enable a successful  
“rocking” maneuver.  
If a system fault is detected, the traction control active light will  
illuminate, the Traction Control™ button will not turn the system on or  
off and your vehicle should be serviced by an authorized dealer.  
STEERING  
To help prevent damage to the power steering system:  
Never hold the steering wheel at its furthest turning points (until it  
stops) for more than three to five seconds when the engine is running.  
Do not operate the vehicle with a low power steering pump fluid level  
(below the MIN mark on the reservoir).  
Some noise is normal during operation. If excessive, check for low  
power steering pump fluid level before seeking service by your dealer.  
271  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Heavy or uneven efforts may be caused by low power steering fluid.  
Check for low power steering pump fluid level before seeking service  
by your dealer.  
Do not fill the power steering pump reservoir above the MAX mark on  
the reservoir, as this may result in leaks from the reservoir.  
If the power steering system breaks down (or if the engine is turned  
off), you can steer the vehicle manually, but it takes more effort.  
If the steering wanders or pulls, check for:  
an improperly inflated tire  
uneven tire wear  
loose or worn suspension components  
loose or worn steering components  
improper steering alignment  
If any steering components are serviced or replaced, install new  
fasteners (many are coated with thread adhesive or have prevailing  
torque features which may not be re-used). Never re-use a bolt or nut.  
Torque fasteners to specifications in Workshop Manual.  
A high crown in the road or high crosswinds may also make the steering  
seem to wander/pull.  
LIMITED-SLIP AXLE (IF EQUIPPED)  
This axle provides added traction on slippery surfaces, particularly when  
one wheel is on a poor traction surface. Under normal conditions, the  
Limited-slip axle functions like a standard rear axle. The axle may  
exhibit a slight noise or vibration in tight turns with low vehicle speed.  
This is normal behavior and indicates the axle is working.  
272  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
PREPARING TO DRIVE  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
Utility vehicles and trucks have larger tires and increased ground  
clearance, giving the vehicle a higher center of gravity than a passenger  
car.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility vehicles and trucks handle differently than vehicles with a  
lower center of gravity. Utility vehicles and trucks are not designed for  
cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any more than low-slung  
sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road  
conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed or abrupt maneuvers in  
these vehicles. Failure to drive cautiously could result in an increased  
risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and  
death.  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles, with a higher center of gravity,  
may handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Do not overload  
your vehicle and use extra precautions, such as driving at slower  
speeds, avoiding abrupt steering changes and allowing for increased  
stopping distance, when driving a heavily loaded vehicle. Over-loading  
or loading the vehicle improperly can deteriorate handling capability  
and contribute to loss of vehicle control and vehicle rollover.  
BRAKE-SHIFT INTERLOCK  
This vehicle is equipped with a brake-shift interlock feature that prevents  
the gearshift lever from being moved from P (Park) when the ignition is  
in the 3 (on) position and the brake pedal is not pressed.  
If you cannot move the gearshift lever out of P (Park) with ignition in  
the on position and the brake pedal pressed, it is possible that a fuse has  
blown or the vehicle’s brakelamps are not operating properly. Refer to  
Fuses and relays in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
273  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
If the fuse is not blown and the brakelamps are working properly, the  
following procedure will allow you to move the gearshift lever from P  
(Park):  
1. Apply the parking brake. Turn the  
ignition key to 1 (off), then remove  
the key. Locate the access cover  
plate for the brake-shift interlock  
override. It is located on top of the  
steering column shroud.  
2. Apply the brake. Use a tool (or a  
small screwdriver) to pry out the  
access cover. Insert the tool into the  
access hole and slide the white  
override button towards the left.  
Move the gear shift lever into N  
(Neutral) while holding the white  
override disc towards the left.  
3. Start the vehicle.  
WARNING: Do not drive your vehicle until you verify that the  
brakelamps are working.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
274  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)  
Understanding the shift positions of the 5–speed automatic  
transmission  
This vehicle is equipped with an adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy.  
Adaptive Shift Strategy offers the optimal transmission operation and  
shift quality. When the vehicle’s battery has been disconnected for any  
type of service or repair, the transmission will need to relearn the normal  
shift strategy parameters, much like having to reset your radio stations  
when your vehicle battery has been disconnected. The Adaptive  
Transmission Strategy allows the transmission to relearn these operating  
parameters. This learning process could take several transmission  
upshifts and downshifts; during this learning process, slightly firmer  
shifts may occur. After this learning process, normal shift feel and shift  
scheduling will resume.  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission and prevents the rear wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
Start the engine  
Press the brake pedal  
Move the gearshift lever into the desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
Come to a complete stop  
Move the gearshift lever and securely latch it in P (Park)  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
275  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is  
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.  
D (Overdrive) with Tow/Haul OFF  
D (Overdrive) with Tow/Haul OFF is the normal driving position for the  
best fuel economy. The overdrive function allows automatic upshifts and  
downshifts through gears one through five.  
D (Overdrive) with Tow/Haul ON  
The Tow/Haul feature improves transmission operation when towing a  
trailer or a heavy load. All transmission gear ranges are available when  
using Tow/Haul.  
To activate Tow/Haul, press the  
button on the end of the gearshift  
lever.  
The TOW HAUL indicator light will  
illuminate in the instrument cluster.  
Tow/Haul delays upshifts to reduce frequency of transmission shifting.  
Tow/Haul also provides engine braking in all forward gears when the  
transmission is in the D (Overdrive) position; this engine braking will  
slow the vehicle and assist the driver in controlling the vehicle when  
descending a grade. Depending on driving conditions and load  
conditions, the transmission may downshift, slow the vehicle and control  
the vehicle speed when descending a hill, without the accelerator pedal  
being pressed. The amount of downshift braking provided will vary based  
upon the amount the brake pedal is depressed.  
To deactivate the Tow/Haul feature and return to normal driving mode,  
press the button on the end of the gearshift lever. The TOW HAUL light  
will no longer be illuminated.  
When you shut-off and restart the engine, the transmission will  
automatically return to normal D (Overdrive) mode (Tow/Haul OFF).  
WARNING: Do not use the Tow/Haul feature when driving in icy  
or slippery conditions as the increased engine braking can cause  
the rear wheels to slide and the vehicle to swing around with the  
possible loss of vehicle control.  
276  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
3 (Third)  
Transmission starts and operates in third gear only.  
Used for improved traction on slippery roads. Selecting 3 (Third)  
provides engine braking.  
2 (Second)  
Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads or to provide additional  
engine braking on downgrades.  
1 (First)  
Provides maximum engine braking.  
Allows upshifts by moving gearshift lever.  
The transmission will not downshift into 1 (First) at high speeds; it  
will downshift to a lower gear and then shift into 1 (First) when the  
vehicle reaches slower speeds.  
Forced downshifts  
Allowed in D (Overdrive) or D (Drive).  
Press the accelerator to the floor.  
Allows transmission to select an appropriate gear.  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow, it may be rocked out by  
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts in a  
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.  
Do not rock the vehicle for more than a minute or damage to the  
transmission and tires may occur, or the engine may overheat.  
277  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
MANUAL TRANSMISSION OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)  
D
R 1 3  
L 2 4  
Using the clutch  
Manual transmission vehicles have a starter interlock that prevents  
cranking the engine unless the clutch pedal is fully pressed.  
To start the vehicle:  
1. Make sure the parking brake is fully set.  
2. Press the clutch pedal to the floor, then put the gearshift lever in the  
neutral position.  
3. Start the engine.  
4. Press the brake pedal and move the gearshift lever to the desired  
gear; 1 (First) or R (Reverse).  
5. Release the parking brake, then slowly release the clutch pedal while  
slowly pressing on the accelerator.  
During each shift, the clutch pedal must be fully pressed to the floor.  
Make sure the floor mat is properly positioned so it doesn’t interfere with  
the full extension of the clutch pedal.  
Failure to fully press the clutch pedal to the floor may cause  
increased shift efforts, prematurely wear transmission  
components or damage the transmission.  
Do not drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal or use the  
clutch pedal to hold your vehicle at a standstill while waiting on a  
hill. These actions will severely reduce the life of the clutch and  
could nullify a clutch warranty claim.  
Recommended shift speeds  
Do not overspeed the engine when going downhill or steep grades. If  
equipped, use the tachometer and do not allow engine speed to exceed  
the redline area. Operating the engine beyond the recommended speeds  
can cause severe engine damage.  
278  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Shift according to the following shift speed charts:  
Upshifts when accelerating (recommended for best fuel economy)  
6-speed transmission  
Shift from:  
Transfer case position1 (if equipped)  
2H or 4H  
4L  
LO-1  
1-2  
2-3  
3-4  
4
5 mph (8 km/h)  
14 mph (23 km/h)  
22 mph (35 km/h)  
30 mph (48 km/h)  
40 mph (64 km/h)  
2 mph (3 km/h)  
6 mph (10 km/h)  
9 mph (14 km/h)  
12 mph (19 km/h)  
15 mph (24 km/h)  
D
-
(Overdrive)  
Maximum downshift speeds1  
6-speed transmission  
Shift from:  
Transfer case position (if equipped)2  
2H or 4H  
4L  
D
45 mph (72 km/h)  
16 mph (26 km/h)  
(Overdrive) -  
4
4-3  
3-2  
2-1  
35 mph (56 km/h)  
20 mph (32 km/h)  
5 mph (8 km/h)  
12 mph (19 km/h)  
8 mph (13 km/h)  
2 mph (3 km/h)  
1-LO  
Only shift to LO when at a stop.  
1
Use 2H or 4H for 4WD equipped vehicles.  
Downshift at lower speeds when driving on slippery surfaces.  
2
Reverse  
1. Make sure that your vehicle is at a complete stop before you shift into  
R (Reverse). Failure to do so may damage the transmission.  
2. Move the gearshift lever into the neutral position and wait at least  
three seconds before shifting into R (Reverse).  
Note: The gearshift lever can only be moved into R (Reverse) by moving  
it from left of 3 (Third) and 4 (Fourth) before shifting into R (Reverse).  
This is a lockout feature that protects the transmission from accidentally  
being shifted into R (Reverse) from D (Overdrive).  
279  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Parking your vehicle  
1. Apply the brake and shift into the neutral position.  
2. Fully apply the parking brake, then shift into 1 (First).  
3. Turn the ignition off.  
WARNING: Do not park your vehicle in Neutral, it may move  
unexpectedly and injure someone. Use 1 (First) gear and set the  
parking brake fully.  
REVERSE SENSING SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The reverse sensing system (RSS) sounds a tone to warn the driver of  
obstacles near the rear bumper when the R (Reverse) is selected and the  
vehicle is moving at speeds less than 3 mph (5 km/h). The system is not  
effective at speeds above 3 mph (5 km/h) and may not detect certain  
angular or moving objects.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, please read and  
understand the limitations of the reverse sensing system as  
contained in this section. Reverse sensing is only an aid for some  
(generally large and fixed) objects when moving in reverse on a flat  
surface at “parking speeds”. Inclement weather may also affect the  
function of the RSS; this may include reduced performance or a false  
activation.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, always use caution  
when in reverse and when using the RSS.  
WARNING: This system is not designed to prevent contact with  
small or moving objects. The system is designed to provide a  
warning to assist the driver in detecting large stationary objects to  
avoid damaging the vehicle. The system may not detect smaller  
objects, particularly those close to the ground.  
WARNING: Certain add-on devices such as large trailer hitches,  
bike or surfboard racks and any device that may block the  
normal detection zone of the RSS system may create false beeps.  
280  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
The RSS detects obstacles up to  
6 feet (2 meters) from the rear  
bumper with a decreased coverage  
area at the outer corners of the  
bumper, (refer to the figures for  
approximate zone coverage areas).  
As you move closer to the obstacle,  
the rate of the tone increases. When  
the obstacle is less than 10 inches  
(25.0 cm) away, the tone will sound  
continuously. If the RSS detects a  
stationary or receding object further  
than 10 inches (25.0 cm) from the  
side of the vehicle, the tone will  
sound for only three seconds. Once  
the system detects an object  
approaching, the tone will sound  
again.  
While receiving a warning the radio  
volume may be reduced to a  
predetermined level. After the  
warning goes away, the radio will return to the previous volume.  
The RSS may have reduced performance or an increased chance of false  
detection if the tailgate is not locked and in the upright position. If the  
tailgate is down, the RSS tone may be heard intermittently or  
continuously. The tone may also be heard if items in the truck bed  
protrude rearward outside the bed.  
The RSS automatically turns on when the gearshift lever is placed in R  
(Reverse) and the ignition is on. A control in the message center allows  
the driver to disable the system, refer to Message center in the  
Instrument Cluster chapter for more information.  
Keep the RSS sensors (located on the rear bumper/fascia) free  
from snow, ice and large accumulations of dirt (do not clean the  
sensors with sharp objects). If the sensors are covered, it will  
affect the accuracy of the RSS.  
If your vehicle sustains damage to the rear bumper/fascia, leaving  
it misaligned or bent, the sensing zone may be altered causing  
inaccurate measurement of obstacles or false alarms.  
281  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
REARVIEW CAMERA SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The rearview camera system,  
located on the tailgate, provides a  
video image, which appears in the  
rearview mirror or on the navigation  
screen (if equipped), of the area  
behind the vehicle. It adds  
assistance to the driver while  
reversing or reverse parking the  
vehicle.  
To use the camera system, place the transmission in R (Reverse); an  
image will display on the left portion of the rearview mirror or on the  
navigation screen (if equipped). The area displayed on the screen may  
vary according to the vehicle orientation and/or road condition.  
(1) Rear bumper  
(2) Red zone  
(3) Yellow zone  
(4) Green zone  
(5) Centerline of vehicle  
Always use caution while backing.  
Objects in the red zone are closest  
to your vehicle and objects in the  
green zone are further away. Objects  
are getting closer to your vehicle as they move from the green zone to  
the yellow or red zones.  
Use the side mirrors and rearview mirror to get better coverage on both  
sides and rear of the vehicle.  
282  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
When shifting out of R (Reverse) and into any other gear, the image will  
remain on for a few seconds before it shuts off to assist in parking or  
trailer hookup.  
If equipped with the navigation system, after shifting out of R (Reverse)  
and into any gear other than P (Park), the image will remain until the  
vehicle speed reaches 5 mph (8 km/h), only if the rear camera delay  
feature is on, or until any navigation radio button is pressed.  
Note: The default setting for the rear camera delay is off. Press the  
“Settings” button found on the navigation screen (if equipped) to set the  
rear camera delay feature to on or off.  
When towing, the camera system will only see what is being towed  
behind the vehicle; this might not provide adequate coverage as it  
usually provides in normal operation and some objects might not be  
seen.  
The camera lens for the camera is located on the tailgate, near the  
tailgate handle. Keep the lens clean so the video image remains clear and  
undistorted. Clean the lens with a soft, lint-free cloth and non-abrasive  
cleaner.  
Note: If the camera system image is not clear or seems distorted, it may  
be covered with water droplets, snow, mud or any other substance. If  
this occurs, clean the camera lens before using the camera system.  
WARNING: The camera system is a reverse aid supplement  
device that still requires the driver to use it in conjunction with  
the rearview mirror and the side mirrors for maximum coverage.  
WARNING: Objects that are close to either corner of the  
bumper or under the bumper, might not be seen on the screen  
due to the limited coverage of the camera system.  
WARNING: Backup as slow as possible since higher speeds  
might limit your reaction time to stop the vehicle.  
WARNING: Do not use the camera system with the tailgate  
open.  
If the back end of the vehicle is hit or damaged, then check with your  
authorized dealer to have your rear video system checked for proper  
coverage and operation.  
283  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Night time and dark area use  
At night time or in dark areas, the camera system relies on the reverse  
lamp lighting to produce an image. Therefore it is necessary that both  
reverse lamps are operating in order to get a clear image in the dark. If  
either of the lamps are not operating, stop using the camera system, at  
least in the dark, until the lamp(s) are replaced and functioning.  
Servicing  
If the image comes on while the vehicle is not in R (Reverse), have  
the system inspected by your authorized dealer.  
If the image is not clear, then check if there is anything covering the  
lens such as dirt, mud, ice, snow, etc. If the image is still not clear  
after cleaning, have your system inspected by your authorized dealer.  
FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE (4WD) OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation  
of this type of vehicle, see Preparing to drive your vehicle in  
this chapter.  
When four–wheel drive (4WD) is engaged, power is supplied to all four  
wheels through a transfer case. 4WD can be selected when additional  
driving power is desired.  
4WD operation is not recommended on dry pavement. Doing so could  
result in difficult disengagement of the transfer case, increased tire wear  
and decreased fuel economy.  
Manual Shift On Stop (MSOS) 4x4 system (if equipped)  
The 4WD system is engaged or  
disengaged by rotating the control  
for both front wheel hub locks from  
the FREE or LOCK position, then  
manually engaging or disengaging  
the transfer case with the  
floor-mounted shifter. For increased  
fuel economy in 2WD, rotate both  
hub locks to the FREE position.  
For proper operation, make  
sure that each hub is fully engaged and that both hub locks are  
set to the same position (both set to LOCK or both set to  
FREE). To engage LOCK, turn the hub locks completely  
clockwise; to disengage the hubs (FREE), turn the hub locks  
completely counterclockwise.  
284  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Some vehicles may be equipped with wheel ornaments that cover the  
4x4 manual hub lock. These ornaments must be removed to access  
the manual hub locks.  
Electronic Shift On the Fly (ESOF) 4x4 system (if equipped)  
If equipped with the electronic shift 4WD System, and the  
instrument panel control is moved to 4X4 LOW while the vehicle  
is moving above 5 mph (8 km/h), the system will not engage and  
no damage will occur to the 4WD system. Before 4X4 LOW can be  
engaged, the vehicle speed must be below 5 mph (8 km/h) with  
the transmission in N (Neutral). If your vehicle is equipped with  
a manual transmission, the clutch pedal also must be depressed.  
The 4x4 Low indicator will flash continuously until these actions  
are performed by the user. This vehicle is equipped with a  
non-synchronous low range gearset which will not allow the  
transfer case to shift into 4X4 LOW if vehicle speed is above  
5 mph (8 km/h). It is recommended that a shift to 4X4 LOW is  
performed while the vehicle is rolling at a speed below 5 mph  
(8 km/h).  
The 4WD system:  
provides 4x4 High engagement and disengagement while the vehicle is  
moving.  
is operated by a rotary control located on the instrument panel that  
allows you select 2WD, 4x4 High or 4x4 Low operation.  
uses auto-manual hub locks that can be engaged and disengaged  
automatically based on the 4x4 mode selected.  
auto-manual hub locks can be  
manually overridden by rotating  
the hub lock control from AUTO  
to LOCK if desired.  
automatic operation of the  
hub locks is recommended, and  
will increase fuel economy  
For proper operation, make  
sure that each hub is fully  
engaged and that both hub  
locks are set to the same position (both set to LOCK or both  
set to AUTO). To engage LOCK, turn the hub locks completely  
clockwise; to engage AUTO, turn the hub locks completely  
counterclockwise.  
285  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
4WD system indicator lights  
The 4WD system indicator lights illuminate only under the following  
conditions. If these lights illuminate when driving in 2WD, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
4x4 HIGH - momentarily  
4x4  
HIGH  
illuminates after the engine is  
started. Illuminates when 4H (4x4  
High) is engaged. Flashes when  
shifting into or out of 4H (4x4 high) (ESOF systems only).  
4x4 LOW – momentarily  
4x4  
LOW  
illuminates when the ignition is  
turned to the ON position.  
Illuminates when 4L (4x4 Low) is  
engaged. Flashes when shifting into or out of 4L (4x4 Low) or if the  
range shift conditions are not met (ESOF systems only).  
Using a Manual Shift On Stop (MSOS) 4x4 system (if equipped)  
Note: High shift efforts may be encountered when attempting to  
shift into and out of 4x4 modes. It is recommended to allow the  
vehicle to roll at a speed below 5 mph (8 km/h) when shifting.  
Note: Some noise may be heard as the 4x4 system shifts or engages.  
This is normal. In order to reduce engagement noise, it is recommended  
that all shifts be performed at speeds below 5 mph (8 km/h).  
2H (2WD) – For general on-road driving. Sends power to the rear  
wheels only.  
4H (4x4 High) – For winter and off-road conditions. Sends power to  
front and rear wheels. This mode is not intended for use on dry  
pavement.  
N (Neutral) – Only used when towing the vehicle.  
4L (4x4 Low) – For low-speed off-road applications that require extra  
power such as steep grades, deep sand or pulling a boat out of the water.  
Sends power to front and rear wheels. This mode is not intended for  
use on dry pavement.  
286  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Shifting from 2H (2WD) to 4H (4x4 High)  
Engage the locking hubs by rotating  
the hub lock control from FREE to  
LOCK, then move the transfer case  
lever from 2H (2WD) to 4H (4x4  
High) at a stop or a vehicle speed  
below 5 mph (8 km/h).  
For proper operation, make  
sure that both indicator  
arrows on the hub are aligned,  
and that both hubs are set to  
LOCK.  
Do not shift into 4H (4x4  
High) with the rear wheels  
slipping.  
2H  
4H  
N
4L  
Shifting from 4H (4x4 High) to 2H (2WD)  
Move the transfer case lever to 2H  
(2WD) at a stop or a vehicle speed  
below 5 mph (8 km/h).  
2H  
4H  
With the vehicle at complete stop,  
disengage the locking hubs  
N
(optional) by rotating the hub lock  
control from LOCK to FREE.  
4L  
For proper operation, make  
sure that both indicator arrows on the hub are aligned, and  
that both hubs are set to FREE  
Shifting from 4H (4x4 High) to 4L (4x4 Low)  
1. Bring the vehicle to a stop or a speed below 5 mph (8 km/h).  
2. Place the gearshift lever in N (Neutral). If the vehicle is equipped with  
a manual transmission, also depress the clutch pedal.  
287  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
3. Move the transfer case shift lever  
through N (Neutral) directly to 4L  
(4x4 Low).  
2H  
4H  
4. If the shift lever does not, or only  
partially moves to the 4L (4x4 Low)  
position, perform a shift with the  
transmission in N (Neutral) (or  
clutch pedal depressed) and the  
N
4L  
vehicle rolling at a speed below 5 mph (8 km/h). This will ensure the  
transfer case is fully engaged into 4L (4x4 Low).  
Shifting from 4L (4x4 Low) to 4H (4x4 High) or 2H (2WD)  
1. Bring the vehicle to a stop or a speed below 5 mph (8 km/h).  
2. Place the gearshift lever in N (Neutral). If the vehicle is equipped with  
a manual transmission, also depress the clutch pedal.  
3. Move the transfer case shift lever  
through N (Neutral) directly to 4H  
(4x4 High) or 2H (2WD).  
2H  
4H  
4. If the transfer case will not  
N
engage into 4H (4x4 High) or 2H  
(2WD), perform a shift with the  
transmission in N (Neutral) (or  
4L  
clutch pedal depressed) and the  
vehicle rolling at a speed below 5 mph (8 km/h).  
5. If shifting to 2H (2WD) with the vehicle at a complete stop, disengage  
the locking hubs (optional) by rotating the hub lock control from LOCK  
to FREE.  
Using the N (Neutral) position  
The transfer case neutral  
2H  
4H  
position overrides the  
transmission and puts the  
vehicle in neutral regardless of  
transmission gearshift lever  
position. The vehicle can move  
forward or backwards.  
N
4L  
This position should only be used  
when towing the vehicle.  
288  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
WARNING: Do not leave the vehicle unattended with the  
transfer case in the N (Neutral) position. Always set the parking  
brake fully and turn off the ignition when leaving the vehicle.  
Using the Electronic Shift On the Fly (ESOF) 4x4 system  
(if equipped)  
Positions of the electronic shift system  
Note: Some noise may be heard as the 4WD system shifts or engages.  
This is normal.  
2WD – For general on-road driving. Sends power to the rear wheels only.  
4x4 HIGH – For winter and off-road conditions. Sends power to front  
and rear wheels. This mode is not intended for use on dry  
pavement.  
4x4 LOW – For low-speed off-road applications that require extra power  
such as steep grades, deep sand or pulling a boat out of the water. Sends  
power to front and rear wheels. This mode is not intended for use on  
dry pavement.  
Shifting from 2WD to 4x4 HIGH  
Rotate the 4x4 control to the 4x4  
HIGH position at speeds up to  
55 mph (88 km/h).  
The electronic shift 4x4  
system is designed to engage  
4x4 HIGH when the vehicle is  
moving. If shifted to 4x4  
HIGH while at complete stop,  
4x4 may not engage and the  
4x4 indicator may flash  
continuously until the vehicle  
is allowed to move at a speed above 1 mph (1.6 km/h).  
Do not shift into 4x4 HIGH with the rear wheels slipping.  
289  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Shifting from 4x4 HIGH to 2WD  
Rotate the 4x4 control to 2WD at  
any forward speed. Disengagement  
of the transfer case and front hubs  
may be delayed due to torque bind  
which is caused by driving on dry  
hard surfaces or performing tight  
turns while using the 4x4 system.  
You do not need to operate the  
vehicle in R (Reverse) to  
disengage your front hubs, but it  
will eliminate any torque bind and  
allow the system to immediately disengage.  
Shifting from 4x4 HIGH to 4x4 LOW  
If the range shift requirements are not met, the 4x4 Low  
indicator will flash continuously.  
1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.  
2. Place the gearshift in N (Neutral). If the vehicle is equipped with a  
manual transmission, also depress the clutch pedal.  
3. Move the 4x4 control to the 4x4  
LOW position.  
4. Hold the shift conditions until the  
4x4 LOW indicator light illuminates.  
5. If the 4x4 LOW indicator light  
flashes continuously for more than  
10 seconds, allow the vehicle to  
move at a speed below 5 mph  
(8 km/h), then repeat steps 2  
through 5 while the vehicle is rolling  
before reporting any shift concerns to your authorized dealer.  
Shifting from 4x4 LOW to 4x4 HIGH or 2WD  
If the range shift requirements are not met, the 4x4 Low or 4x4  
High indicator will flash continuously, depending on which mode  
the shift began.  
1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop.  
2. Place the gearshift in N (Neutral).  
290  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
3. Move the 4x4 control to the 4x4  
HIGH or 2WD position.  
4. Hold the shift conditions until the  
4x4 LOW indicator light shuts off.  
5. If the 4x4 LOW or 4x4 High  
indicator light flashes continuously  
for more than 10 seconds, allow the  
vehicle to move at a speed below  
5 mph (8 km/h), then repeat steps 2  
through 5 while the vehicle is rolling  
before reporting any shift concerns to your authorized dealer.  
Driving off-road with truck and utility vehicles  
4WD vehicles are specially equipped for driving on sand, snow, mud and  
rough terrain and have operating characteristics that are somewhat  
different from conventional vehicles, both on and off the road.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a long front air dam that may become  
damaged (due to reduced ground clearance) when taking your vehicle  
off-road. This air dam can either be removed or a shorter air dam can be  
purchased from your authorized dealer. In either case, if the air dam is  
to be removed (or replaced) before going off-road, refer to the  
Workshop Manual for the procedure or have your authorized dealer  
perform the work for you.  
How your vehicle differs from other vehicles  
Truck and utility vehicles can differ from some other vehicles. Your  
vehicle may be higher to allow it to travel over rough terrain without  
getting hung up or damaging underbody components.  
The differences that make your vehicle so versatile also make it handle  
differently than an ordinary passenger car.  
Maintain steering wheel control at all times, especially in rough terrain.  
Since sudden changes in terrain can result in abrupt steering wheel  
motion, make sure you grip the steering wheel from the outside. Do not  
grip the spokes.  
Drive cautiously to avoid vehicle damage from concealed objects such as  
rocks and stumps.  
You should either know the terrain or examine maps of the area before  
driving. Map out your route before driving in the area. To maintain  
steering and braking control of your vehicle, you must have all four  
wheels on the ground and they must be rolling, not sliding or spinning.  
291  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Basic operating principles  
Do not use 4WD on dry, hard surfaced roads. Doing so will produce  
excessive noise, increase tire wear and may damage drive components.  
4WD modes are only intended for consistently slippery or loose  
surfaces.  
Drive slower in strong crosswinds which can affect the normal steering  
characteristics of your vehicle.  
Be extremely careful when driving on pavement made slippery by  
loose sand, water, gravel, snow or ice.  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement, slow down, but  
avoid severe brake application, ease the vehicle back onto the  
pavement only after reducing your speed. Do not turn the steering  
wheel too sharply while returning to the road surface.  
It may be safer to stay on the apron or shoulder of the road and slow  
down gradually before returning to the pavement. You may lose  
control if you do not slow down or if you turn the steering wheel too  
sharply or abruptly.  
It often may be less risky to strike small objects, such as highway  
reflectors, with minor damage to your vehicle rather than attempt a  
sudden return to the pavement which could cause the vehicle to slide  
sideways out of control or roll over. Remember, your safety and the  
safety of others should be your primary concern.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
If your vehicle gets stuck  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow it may be rocked out by  
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts, in a  
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.  
292  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Do not rock the vehicle for more than a few minutes or damage to  
the transmission and tires may occur or the engine may overheat.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
Refer to Transmission fluid temperature gauge in the Instrument  
Cluster chapter for transmission fluid temperature information.  
Emergency maneuvers  
In an unavoidable emergency situation where a sudden sharp turn  
must be made, remember to avoid “over-driving” your vehicle, i.e.,  
turn the steering wheel only as rapidly and as far as required to avoid  
the emergency. Excessive steering will result in less vehicle control,  
not more. Additionally, smooth variations of the accelerator and/or  
brake pedal pressure should be utilized if changes in vehicle speed are  
called for. Avoid abrupt steering, acceleration or braking which could  
result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover  
and/or personal injury. Use all available road surface to return the  
vehicle to a safe direction of travel.  
In the event of an emergency stop, avoid skidding the tires and do not  
attempt any sharp steering wheel movements.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
If the vehicle goes from one type of surface to another (i.e., from  
concrete to gravel) there will be a change in the way the vehicle  
responds to a maneuver (steering, acceleration or braking). Again,  
avoid these abrupt inputs.  
Parking  
On some 4WD vehicles, when the transfer case is in the N (Neutral)  
position, the engine and transmission are disconnected from the rest of  
the driveline. Therefore, the vehicle is free to roll even if the automatic  
293  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
transmission is in P (Park) or the manual transmission is in gear. Do not  
leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer case in the N (Neutral)  
position. Always set the parking brake fully and turn off the ignition  
when leaving the vehicle.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
4WD Systems  
4WD (when you select a 4WD mode), uses all four wheels to power the  
vehicle. This increases traction, enabling you to drive over terrain and  
road conditions that a conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot.  
Power is supplied to all four wheels through a transfer case. On 4WD  
vehicles, the transfer case allows you to select 4WD when necessary.  
Information on transfer case operation and shifting procedures can be  
found in the Driving chapter. Information on transfer case maintenance  
can be found in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter. You  
should become thoroughly familiar with this information before you  
operate your vehicle.  
Normal characteristics  
On some 4WD models, the initial shift from two-wheel drive to 4x4 while  
the vehicle is moving can cause some momentary clunk and ratcheting  
sounds. This is the front drivetrain coming up to speed and the  
automatic locking hubs engaging and is not cause for concern.  
Sand  
When driving over sand, try to keep all four wheels on the most solid  
area of the trail. Avoid reducing the tire pressures but shift to a lower  
gear and drive steadily through the terrain. Apply the accelerator slowly  
and avoid spinning the wheels.  
Avoid excessive speed because vehicle momentum can work against you  
and cause the vehicle to become stuck to the point that assistance may  
be required from another vehicle. Remember, you may be able to back  
out the way you came if you proceed with caution.  
294  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Note: If air is released from your tires, the Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System (TPMS) indicator light may illuminate (if equipped).  
Mud and water  
If you must drive through high  
water, drive slowly. Traction or  
brake capability may be limited.  
When driving through water,  
determine the depth; avoid water  
higher than the bottom of the hubs  
(if possible) and proceed slowly. If  
the ignition system gets wet, the  
vehicle may stall.  
Once through water, always try the brakes. Wet brakes do not stop the  
vehicle as effectively as dry brakes. Drying can be improved by moving  
your vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Be cautious of sudden changes in vehicle speed or direction when you  
are driving in mud. Even 4WD vehicles can lose traction in slick mud. As  
when you are driving over sand, apply the accelerator slowly and avoid  
spinning your wheels. If the vehicle does slide, steer in the direction of  
the slide until you regain control of the vehicle.  
If the transmission, transfer case or front axle are submerged in water,  
their fluids should be checked and changed, if necessary.  
Driving through deep water may damage the transmission.  
Refer to Transmission temperature gauge in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for transmission fluid temperature information.  
If the front or rear axle is submerged in water, the axle lubricant should  
be replaced.  
After driving through mud, clean off residue stuck to rotating driveshafts  
and tires. Excess mud stuck on tires and rotating driveshafts causes an  
imbalance that could damage drive components.  
“Tread Lightly” is an educational  
program designed to increase public  
awareness of land-use regulations  
and responsibilities in our nations  
wilderness areas. Ford Motor  
Company joins the U.S. Forest Service and the Bureau of Land  
Management in encouraging you to help preserve our national forest and  
other public and private lands by “treading lightly.”  
295  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Driving on hilly or sloping terrain  
Although natural obstacles may make it necessary to travel diagonally up  
or down a hill or steep incline, you should always try to drive straight up  
or straight down. Avoid driving crosswise or turning on steep  
slopes or hills. A danger lies in losing traction, slipping sideways and  
possibly rolling over. Whenever driving on a hill, determine beforehand  
the route you will use. Do not drive over the crest of a hill without  
seeing what conditions are on the other side. Do not drive in reverse  
over a hill without the aid of an observer.  
When climbing a steep slope or hill,  
start in a lower gear rather than  
downshifting to a lower gear from a  
higher gear once the ascent has  
started. This reduces strain on the  
engine and the possibility of stalling.  
If you do stall out, do not try to  
turn around because you might roll  
over. It is better to back down to a  
safe location.  
Apply just enough power to the  
wheels to climb the hill. Too much  
power will cause the tires to slip,  
spin or lose traction, resulting in  
loss of vehicle control.  
Descend a hill in the same gear you  
would use to climb up the hill to  
avoid excessive brake application  
and brake overheating. Do not  
descend in neutral; instead,  
manually shift to a lower gear. Your  
vehicle has anti-lock brakes, apply  
the brakes steadily. Do not “pump”  
the brakes.  
Driving on snow and ice  
4WD vehicles have advantages over 2WD vehicles in snow and ice but  
can skid like any other vehicle.  
296  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Should you start to slide while driving on snowy or icy roads, turn the  
steering wheel in the direction of the slide until you regain control.  
Avoid sudden applications of power and quick changes of direction on  
snow and ice. Apply the accelerator slowly and steadily when starting  
from a full stop.  
Avoid sudden braking as well. Although a 4WD vehicle may accelerate  
better than a two-wheel drive vehicle in snow and ice, it won’t stop any  
faster, because as in other vehicles, braking occurs at all four wheels. Do  
not become overconfident as to road conditions.  
Make sure you allow sufficient distance between you and other vehicles  
for stopping. Drive slower than usual and consider using one of the lower  
gears. In emergency stopping situations, avoid locking of the wheels. Use  
a “squeeze” technique, push on the brake pedal with a steadily increasing  
force which allows the wheels to brake yet continue to roll so that you  
may steer in the direction you want to travel. If you lock the wheels,  
release the brake pedal and repeat the squeeze technique. If your vehicle  
is equipped with a Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS), apply the  
brake steadily. Do not “pump” the brakes. Refer to the Brakes section of  
this chapter for additional information on the operation of the anti-lock  
brake system.  
WARNING: If you are driving in slippery conditions that require  
tire cables, then it is critical that you drive cautiously. Keep  
speeds down, allow for longer stopping distances and avoid aggressive  
steering to reduce the chances of a loss of vehicle control which can  
lead to serious injury or death. If the rear end of the vehicle slides  
while cornering, steer in the direction of the slide until you regain  
control of the vehicle.  
Maintenance and Modifications  
The suspension and steering systems on your vehicle have been designed  
and tested to provide predictable performance whether loaded or empty  
and durable load carrying capability. For this reason, Ford Motor  
Company strongly recommends that you do not make modifications such  
as adding or removing parts (such as lift kits or stabilizer bars) or by  
using replacement parts not equivalent to the original factory equipment.  
Any modifications to a vehicle that raise the center of gravity can make  
it more likely the vehicle will roll over as a result of a loss of control.  
Ford Motor Company recommends that caution be used with any vehicle  
equipped with a high load or device (such as ladder racks or pickup box  
cover).  
297  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Failure to maintain your vehicle properly may void the warranty, increase  
your repair cost, reduce vehicle performance and operational capabilities  
and adversely affect driver and passenger safety. Frequent inspection of  
vehicle chassis components is recommended if the vehicle is subjected to  
heavy off-road usage.  
VEHICLE USED AS A STATIONARY POWER SOURCE  
Auxiliary equipment called power take-off, or PTO, is often added to the  
engine or transmission to operate utility equipment. Examples include a  
wheel-lift for tow trucks, cranes, tools for construction or tire service,  
and pumping fluids. PTO applications draw auxiliary horsepower from  
the powertrain, often while the vehicle is stationary. In this condition,  
there is limited cooling air flow through the radiator and around the  
vehicle that normally occurs when a vehicle is moving. The aftermarket  
PTO system installer, having the most knowledge of the final application,  
is responsible for determining whether additional chassis heat protection  
or powertrain cooling is required, and alerting the user to the safe and  
proper operation.  
Ford Super Duty Vehicles are qualified for use as a stationary power  
source, within limits detailed in the Ford Truck Body Builders Layout  
Book, found at www.fleet.ford.com/truckbbas, and through the Ford  
Truck Body Builders Advisory Service.  
Gas engine vehicles are qualified for up to 10 minutes of continuous  
operation as a stationary power source, due to the potential for the  
normal venting of fuel vapors. For stationary PTO operation of extended  
duration (beyond 10 minutes), diesel engine is recommended. Further  
consult your aftermarket PTO installer, since the duration of operation  
limit for the aftermarket PTO may be less than the vehicle is capable of.  
DRIVING THROUGH WATER  
If driving through deep or standing  
water is unavoidable, proceed very  
slowly especially when the depth is  
not known. Never drive through  
water that is higher than the bottom  
of the wheel rims (for cars) or the  
bottom of the hubs (for trucks).  
When driving through water, traction or brake capability may be limited.  
Also, water may enter your engine’s air intake and severely damage your  
engine or your vehicle may stall. Driving through deep water where  
298  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
the transmission vent tube is submerged may allow water into the  
transmission and cause internal transmission damage.  
Once through the water, always dry the brakes by moving your  
vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Wet brakes do not stop the vehicle as quickly as dry brakes.  
SNOWPLOWING  
Ford recommends that the Super Duty F-Series used for snow removal  
include the Snow Plow Package Option.  
Installing the snowplow  
Weight limits and guidelines for selecting and installing the snowplow can  
be found in the Ford Truck Body Builders Layout Book, Snowplow  
section, found at www.fleet.ford.com/truckbbas. A typical installation  
affects the following:  
Certification to government safety laws such as occupant protection  
and airbag deployment, braking, and lighting. Look for an “Alterer’s  
Label” on the vehicle from the snowplow installer certifying that the  
installation meets all applicable Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standards (FMVSS).  
The Total Accessory Reserve Capacity (TARC) is shown on the lower  
right side of the vehicle’s Safety Compliance Certification Label. This  
applies to Ford-completed vehicles of 10,000 lb. (4,536 kg) GVWR or  
less. This is the weight of permanently-attached auxiliary equipment,  
such as snowplow frame-mounting hardware, that can be added to the  
vehicle and satisfy Ford compliance certification to FMVSS. Exceeding  
this weight may require the auxiliary equipment installer additional  
safety certification responsibility. The Front Accessory Reserve  
Capacity (FARC) is added for customer convenience.  
Rear ballast weight behind the rear axle may be required to prevent  
exceeding the FGAWR, and provide front-to-rear weight balance for  
proper braking and steering.  
Front wheel toe may require re-adjustment to prevent premature  
uneven tire wear. Specifications are found in the Ford Workshop  
Manual.  
Headlight aim may require re-adjustment.  
299  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
The tire air pressures recommended for general driving are found on  
the vehicle’s Safety Certification Label. The maximum cold inflation  
pressure for the tire and associated load rating is imprinted on the tire  
sidewall. Tire air pressure may require re-adjustment within these  
pressure limits to accommodate the additional weight of the snowplow  
installation.  
Federal and some local regulations require additional exterior lamps  
for snowplow-equipped vehicles. Consult your authorized dealer for  
additional information.  
The snow plow prep package includes a unique powertrain control  
strategy which is required for diesel engine cooling during highway  
driving with the snowplow raised.  
Operating the vehicle with the snowplow attached  
Do not use your vehicle for snow removal until it has been driven at  
least 500 miles (800 km).  
The attached snowplow blade restricts airflow to the radiator, and may  
cause the engine to run at a higher temperature: Attention to engine  
temperature is especially important when outside temperatures are  
above freezing. Angle the blade to maximize airflow to the radiator and  
monitor engine temperature to determine whether a left or right angle  
provides the best performance.  
Follow the severe duty schedule in your scheduled maintenance  
information for engine oil and transmission fluid change intervals.  
Snowplowing with your airbag-equipped vehicle  
Your vehicle is equipped with a driver and passenger airbag  
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) The SRS is designed to activate in  
certain frontal and offset frontal collisions when the vehicle sustains  
sufficient longitudinal deceleration.  
Careless or high speed driving while plowing snow which results in  
sufficient vehicle decelerations can deploy the airbag. Such driving also  
increases the risk of accidents.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
Never remove or defeat the “tripping mechanisms” designed into the  
snow removal equipment by its manufacturer. Doing so may cause  
damage to the vehicle and the snow removal equipment as well as  
possible airbag deployment.  
300  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) or its fuses. See your  
Ford or Lincoln Mercury dealer.  
WARNING: Additional equipment such as snowplow equipment  
may effect the performance of the airbag sensors increasing the  
risk of injury. Please refer to the Body Builders Layout Book for  
instructions about the appropriate installation of additional equipment.  
Transmission operation while plowing  
Operate the vehicle with the automatic transmission gearshift lever in  
the D (Overdrive) position and Tow/Haul off.  
Shift transfer case to 4x4 LOW (4WD Low) when plowing in small  
areas at speeds below 5 mph (8 km/h).  
Shift transfer case to 4x4 HIGH (4WD High) when plowing larger  
areas or light snow at higher speeds. Do not exceed 15 mph  
(24 km/h).  
Do not shift the transmission from a forward gear to R (Reverse) until  
the engine is at idle and the wheels are stopped.  
If the vehicle is stuck, shift the transmission in a steady motion  
between forward and reverse gears. Do not rock the vehicle for more  
than a few minutes. The transmission and tires may be damaged or  
the engine can overheat.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature. Do not rock the vehicle for more than a minute. The  
transmission and tires may be damaged or the engine may  
overheat.  
Refer to Transmission temperature gauge in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for transmission fluid temperature information.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (55 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
301  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE  
Getting roadside assistance  
To fully assist you should you have a vehicle concern, Ford Motor  
Company offers a complimentary roadside assistance program. This  
program is separate from the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. The service  
is available:  
24–hours, seven days a week  
for the coverage period listed on the Roadside Assistance Card  
included in your Owner Guide portfolio.  
Roadside assistance will cover:  
a flat tire change with a good spare (except vehicles that have been  
supplied with a tire inflation kit)  
battery jump start  
lock-out assistance (key replacement cost is the customer’s  
responsibility)  
fuel delivery – Independent Service Contractors, if not prohibited by  
state, local or municipal law shall deliver up to 2.0 gallons (7.5L) of  
gasoline or 5.0 gallons (18.9L) of diesel fuel to a disabled vehicle. Fuel  
delivery service is limited to two no-charge occurrences within a  
12-month period.  
winch out – available within 100 feet (30.5 meters) of a paved or  
county maintained road, no recoveries.  
towing – Ford/Mercury/Lincoln eligible vehicle towed to an authorized  
dealer within 35 miles (56 km) of the disablement location or to the  
nearest authorized dealer. If a member requests to be towed to an  
authorized dealer more than 35 miles (56 km) from the disablement  
location, the member shall be responsible for any mileage costs in  
excess of 35 miles (56 km).  
Trailers shall be covered up to $200 if the disabled eligible vehicle  
requires service at the nearest authorized dealer. If the trailer is disabled,  
but the towing vehicle is operational, the trailer does not qualify for any  
roadside services.  
Canadian customers refer to your Customer Information Guide  
for information on:  
coverage period  
exact fuel amounts  
302  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
towing of your disabled vehicle  
emergency travel expense reimbursement  
travel planning benefits  
In Canada, for uninterrupted Roadside Assistance coverage, you may  
purchase extended coverage prior to your Basic Warranty’s Roadside  
Assistance expiring. For more information and enrollment, contact  
1–877–294–2582 or visit our website at www.ford.ca.  
Using roadside assistance  
Complete the roadside assistance identification card and place it in your  
wallet for quick reference. In the United States, this card is found in the  
Owner Guide portfolio in the glove compartment. In Canada, the card is  
found in the Customer Information Guide in the glove compartment.  
U.S. Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers who require Roadside  
Assistance, call 1-800-241-3673.  
Canadian customers who require roadside assistance, call 1-800-665-2006.  
If you need to arrange roadside assistance for yourself, Ford Motor  
Company will reimburse a reasonable amount for towing to the nearest  
dealership within 35 miles (56 km). To obtain reimbursement information,  
U.S. Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers call 1-800-241-3673.  
Customers will be asked to submit their original receipts.  
Canadian customers who need to obtain reimbursement information, call  
1–800–665–2006.  
HAZARD FLASHER CONTROL  
The hazard flasher is located on the  
steering column, just behind the  
steering wheel. The hazard flashers  
will operate when the ignition is in  
any position or if the key is not in  
the ignition.  
Press in the flasher control and all  
front and rear direction signals will  
flash. Press the flasher control again  
to turn them off. Use it when your  
vehicle is disabled and is creating a  
safety hazard for other motorists.  
Note: With extended use, the flasher may run down your battery.  
303  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
FUEL PUMP SHUT-OFF SWITCH  
This device stops the electric fuel pump from sending fuel to the engine  
when your vehicle has had a substantial jolt.  
After an accident, if the engine cranks but does not start, this switch  
may have been activated.  
This switch is located on the  
passenger’s side of the instrument  
panel. Open the front passenger  
door and remove the small access  
panel  
The switch has a red button on top  
of it.  
To reset the switch:  
1. Turn the ignition off.  
2. Check the fuel system for leaks.  
3. If no leaks are apparent, reset the switch by pushing in on the reset  
button.  
4. Turn the ignition on.  
5. Wait a few seconds and return the key to off.  
6. Make another check for leaks.  
304  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
FUSES AND RELAYS  
Fuses  
If electrical components in the  
vehicle are not working, a fuse may  
have blown. Blown fuses are  
identified by a broken wire within  
the fuse. Check the appropriate  
fuses before replacing any electrical  
components.  
15  
Note: Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified amperage  
rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage rating can cause severe wire  
damage and could start a fire.  
Standard fuse amperage rating and color  
COLOR  
Cartridge  
Fuse  
rating  
Mini  
fuses  
Standard  
fuses  
Maxi  
fuses  
Fuse link  
cartridge  
maxi  
fuses  
2A  
3A  
4A  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
5A  
7.5A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
25A  
30A  
40A  
50A  
60A  
70A  
80A  
Brown  
Red  
Brown  
Red  
Yellow  
Green  
Orange  
Red  
Blue  
Tan  
Natural  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Brown  
Black  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Black  
305  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Passenger compartment fuse panel  
The fuse panel is located in the  
passenger’s footwell. Remove the  
panel cover to access the fuses.  
To remove the fuse panel cover, pull  
the panel toward you. When the  
clips of the panel disengage, let the  
panel fall easily.  
To remove a fuse use the fuse puller  
tool provided on the fuse panel  
cover.  
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery before servicing high  
current fuses.  
Always replace the cover to the passenger compartment fuse  
panel before reconnecting the battery.  
If the battery has been disconnected and reconnected, refer to the  
Battery section of the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
306  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
The fuses are coded as follows.  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
1
2
3
4
5
30A  
15A  
15A  
30A  
10A  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Family entertainment system (FES)  
Not used (spare)  
Keypad illumination, Brake-shift  
interlock (BSI), SPBJB  
6
7
8
9
20A  
10A  
10A  
15A  
Turn signals  
Left headlamp (Low beam)  
Right headlamp (Low beam)  
Interior lighting, Lighted running  
boards  
10  
15A  
Cargo lamp, Puddle lamp, Switch  
backlight  
307  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
11  
12  
10A  
7.5A  
Not used (spare)  
Power mirror switch, Driver power  
seat (Memory)  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
5A  
Not used (spare)  
10A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
20A  
25A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
20A  
10A  
Upfitter relay #3 feed  
Climate control head  
Upfitter relay #4 Feed  
All lock motor feeds  
Heated seat relay feed  
Not used (spare)  
Adjustable pedals, Datalink  
Fog lamp relay feed, Cornering lamps  
Park lamp relay feed  
High beam headlight relay feed  
Horn relay feed  
Power telescoping mirror switch,  
Demand lamps - underhood and  
illuminated visor (battery saver)  
26  
27  
10A  
20A  
Cluster  
Ignition switch feed, Passenger  
compartment fuses 28, 42, 43, 44, and  
45, Engine compartment starter relay  
coil #57 (Diesel engine), Accessory  
shutoff control module (if equipped)  
(Diesel engine), Engine compartment  
starter relay diode (gasoline engines)  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
5A  
5A  
5A  
10A  
10A  
Radio  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Restraints control module (RCM),  
Passenger airbag deactivation  
indicator  
308  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
33  
10A  
Trailer tow brake controller, Trailer  
tow battery charge relay coil  
34  
35  
5A  
10A  
Not used (spare)  
Reverse sensing system (RSS), 4x4  
module, 4x4 solenoid, Traction  
control switch, Tow/Haul switch  
(Diesel engine)  
36  
5A  
Passive anti-theft system (PATS)  
transceiver, Cluster control  
37  
38  
39  
40  
10A  
20A  
20A  
20A  
Climate control, PTC control  
Subwoofer  
Radio, Navigation radio and amplifier  
4x4 module, Satellite radio module,  
SYNC, GPS  
41  
42  
15A  
10A  
Radio, Auto dimming rear view  
mirror, Lock switch illumination  
Heated seat relay coil, Upfitter switch  
relay coils, Heated mirror relay coil  
43  
44  
45  
10A  
10A  
5A  
Fuel tank selector switch, 4x4 module  
Run customer access feed (PTO)  
Front wiper logic, Blower motor relay  
coil  
46  
47  
7.5A  
Not used (spare)  
30A Circuit Power windows, Moon roof, Power  
Breaker  
rear sliding window  
48  
Relay  
Delayed accessory  
309  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Power distribution box  
The power distribution box is located in the engine compartment. The  
power distribution box contains high-current fuses that protect your  
vehicle’s main electrical systems from overloads.  
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery before servicing high  
current fuses.  
WARNING: To reduce risk of electrical shock, always replace  
the cover to the Power Distribution Box before reconnecting the  
battery or refilling fluid reservoirs.  
If the battery has been disconnected and reconnected, refer to the  
Battery section of the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
The high-current fuses are coded as follows:  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
1
Relay  
Blower motor/Variable blower control  
(Dual zone climate control)  
2
Relay  
Electronic shift-on-the-fly (ESOF)  
Lo-Hi  
3
4
5
Relay  
30A*  
Heater mirror  
Not used  
Trailer brake controller (TBC)  
310  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
6
40A*  
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) module  
(Pump)  
7
8
9
30A*  
30A*  
40A*  
20A*  
Upfitter auxiliary switch #1  
Upfitter auxiliary switch #2  
ABS module (Coil)  
Instrument panel power point/cigar  
lighter  
10  
11  
12  
13  
20A*  
15A**  
5A**  
Instrument panel power point  
Brake on/off (BOO) relay feed  
Brake switch, Brake switch relay coil,  
SJB module, 4x4 module  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
Relay  
Relay  
Relay  
Not used  
Not used  
A/C clutch  
Wipers  
Fuel pump driver module (FPDM),  
Fuel injectors (Gasoline engines),  
Diesel fuel control module (DFCM)  
(Diesel engine)  
19  
Relay  
Back-up lamps, Reverse sensing  
system (RSS), Engine compartment  
fuse 63  
20  
21  
22  
Relay  
Relay  
Relay  
Trailer stop/turn (Left)  
Trailer stop/turn (Right)  
Stop lamps, Center high-mounted  
stop lamp (CHMSL), TBC, Customer  
access  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
15A**  
40A*  
30A*  
50A*  
Heater mirror, Heated spotted mirror  
Blower motor relay  
Not used  
ESOF relay lo-hi  
Glow plug control module (GPCM) #1  
(Diesel engine only)  
311  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
Heated mirror relay  
Passenger power seat  
A/C clutch relay  
Power fold mirror relay  
Fuel pump relay  
Back-up lamp relay  
Trailer stop/turn relay  
ESOF relay coils  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
20A*  
30A*  
10A**  
15A**  
20A**  
20A**  
25A**  
5A**  
10A**  
Gasoline engines: Powertrain  
control module (PCM) keep alive  
power, Canister vent  
Diesel engine: Engine control  
module (ECM) keep alive power  
37  
10A**  
Transmission control module (TCM)  
(Diesel engine only)  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
Not used  
ECM power (Diesel engine)  
Starter relay  
Power point (Center console - front)  
Trailer park lamp relay  
Power point (Center console - rear)  
Trailer battery charge relay  
Driver power seat or memory module,  
Air ride seats  
50A*  
30A*  
20A*  
30A*  
20A*  
30A*  
30A*  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
40A*  
50A*  
30A*  
30A*  
30A*  
Run/Start relay  
GPCM #2 (Diesel engine only)  
ESOF relay hi-lo  
Wiper motor  
PCM relay coil, PCM relay (Gasoline  
engines only)  
51  
52  
Not used  
Not used  
312  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
53  
Relay  
PCM power bus (Fuses 68, 70, 72,  
74, 76) (Diesel engine only)  
54  
55  
56  
57  
Relay  
Relay  
Relay  
Relay  
Starter solenoid  
Trailer tow park lamps  
Trailer tow battery charge  
Power Distribution Box (PDB) bus  
(fuses 67, 69, 71, 73, 75, 77)  
SJB Run /Start bus (Fuses 29–37, 46)  
58  
59  
Relay  
Relay  
ESOF hi-lo  
PCM power bus (Fuses 68, 70, 72,  
74, 76) (Gasoline engines only)  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
Diode  
Diode  
Diode  
15A**  
5A**  
One-touch start (OTIS)  
A/C clutch  
Fuel pump  
Trailer tow back-up lamps  
Mirror marker lamps  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
10A**  
Gasoline engines: A/C clutch relay  
coil, Refrigerant containment switch,  
Heated PCV  
Diesel engine: A/C clutch relay coil,  
Clutch switch, Fuel pump cooler, A/C  
cycle pressure switch  
71  
72  
73  
5A**  
15A**  
2A**  
Fuel pump relay diode, PCM/ECM  
Run/Start power  
Gasoline engines: Ignition coils  
Diesel engine: Engine TCM  
Reverse Camera System (RCS)  
313  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
74  
20A**  
Gasoline engines: Vehicle power  
(VPWR): Heated exhaust gas oxygen  
sensor, CMS, Mass air flow sensor,  
Electronic vapor management valve,  
CMCV, Variable cam timing, IMTV  
Diesel engine: VPWR: Engine loads  
75  
76  
5A**  
20A**  
Back-up relay coil power  
Gasoline engines: VPWR: PCM  
Diesel engine: VPWR: ECM  
77  
10A**  
ABS module logic  
* Cartridge fuses ** Mini fuses  
CHANGING A FLAT TIRE  
If you get a flat tire while driving:  
do not brake heavily.  
gradually decrease the vehicle’s speed.  
hold the steering wheel firmly.  
slowly move to a safe place on the side of the road.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a conventional spare tire that is  
different in one or more of the following: type, brand, size, speed rating  
and tread design. If this is the case, this dissimilar spare tire is still rated  
for your vehicle loads (GAWR and GVWR).Temporary spare tires are not  
equipped with Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) sensors if the  
system is present.  
WARNING: The use of tire sealant may damage your Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System (if equipped) and should not be  
used.  
WARNING: If your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure  
Monitoring System, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for more  
information. If the tire pressure monitor sensor becomes damaged, it  
will no longer function.  
314  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information  
WARNING: Failure to follow these guidelines could result in an  
increased risk of loss of vehicle control, injury or death.  
If you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel, then it is intended for  
temporary use only. This means that if you need to use it, you should  
replace it as soon as possible with a road tire/wheel that is the same size  
and type as the road tires and wheels that were originally provided by  
Ford. If the dissimilar spare tire or wheel is damaged, it should be  
replaced rather than repaired.  
A dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that  
is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels  
and can be one of three types:  
1. T-type mini-spare: This spare tire begins with the letter “T” for tire  
size and may have “Temporary Use Only” molded in the sidewall  
2. Full-size dissimilar spare with label on wheel: This spare tire has  
a label on the wheel that states: “THIS TIRE AND WHEEL FOR  
TEMPORARY USE ONLY”  
When driving with one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above, do not:  
Exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)  
Load the vehicle beyond maximum vehicle load rating listed on the  
Safety Compliance Label  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Try to repair the dissimilar spare tire  
Use of one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above at any one wheel  
location can lead to impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
It is not recommended that the vehicle be operated in 4WD modes with  
a temporary emergency spare tire. If 4WD operation is necessary, do not  
operate above speeds of 10 mph (16 km/h) or for distances above  
50 miles (80 km).  
315  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Full-size dissimilar spare without label on wheel  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel, do not:  
Exceed 70 mph (113 km/h)  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire/wheel at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel  
The usage of a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel can lead to  
impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
All-Wheel driving capability (if applicable)  
Load leveling adjustment (if applicable)  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel additional  
caution should be given to:  
Towing a trailer  
Driving vehicles equipped with a camper body  
Driving vehicles with a load on the cargo rack  
Drive cautiously when using a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel and  
seek service as soon as possible.  
Spare tire information  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped the tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS), the system indicator light will illuminate when the spare is in  
use. To restore the full functionality of the TPMS system, all road wheels  
equipped with the tire pressure monitoring sensors must be mounted on  
the vehicle.  
If your vehicle is equipped with TPMS, have a flat tire serviced by an  
authorized dealer in order to prevent damage to the TPMS sensor; refer  
to Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the Tires, Wheel and  
Loading chapter. Replace the spare tire with the road tire as soon as  
possible.  
316  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Stopping and securing the vehicle  
WARNING: To help prevent the vehicle from moving when you  
change a tire, be sure the parking brake is set, then block (in  
both directions) the wheel that is diagonally opposite to the tire being  
changed.  
Refer to the instruction sheet (located in the glove box) for detailed tire  
change instructions.  
Park on a level surface, activate  
hazard flashers and set the parking  
brake.  
Automatic transmission: Place  
gearshift lever in P (Park).  
Manual transmission: Place  
gearshift lever in R (Reverse).  
Electronic Shift-On-the-Fly  
(ESOF) 4x4: Place transfer case  
in 4x4 HIGH or 4x4 LOW before  
turning off the engine.  
Manual shift transfer case 4x4: Place transfer case in 4H or 4L.  
Location of the spare tire and tools  
If your vehicle is equipped with a spare tire, jack and associated tools,  
refer to the following table for their locations:  
Tool  
Location  
Spare tire (pick-up trucks only)  
Under the vehicle, just forward of  
the rear bumper  
Jack  
Regular cab and Crew Cab:  
Fastened to floor pan behind  
rearmost seat on passenger side  
SuperCab: Under rear bench seat  
on passenger side  
317  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Tool  
Location  
Regular cab: Fastened to floor  
behind driver seat  
SuperCab: Fastened to floor under  
rear seat  
Jack handle, lug wrench, lug  
wrench extension (only available  
on Dual Rear Wheel [DRW]  
vehicles) and wheel chock (only  
available on Single Rear Wheel  
[SRW] vehicles equipped with a  
diesel engine)  
Crew Cab: Fastened to floor  
behind rear seat at driver side  
Key and spare tire lock  
In the glove box  
Jack instruction sheet  
Under the jack tool kit  
Removing the spare tire (with spare tire carrier only)  
1. The following tools are required to remove the spare tire:  
one handle extension and two  
typical extensions. To assemble,  
align button with hole and slide  
parts together. To disconnect,  
depress button and pull apart.  
one wheel nut wrench. Slide over  
square end of jack handle.  
Vehicles equipped with dual  
rear wheels, insert the lug  
wrench extension into the lug  
wrench to reach the lug nuts.  
318  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
2. Attach the spare tire lock key (A)  
to the jack handle (B).  
3. Fully insert the jack handle (with  
one extension) through the bumper  
hole and into the guide tube. The  
key and lock will engage with a  
slight push and counterclockwise  
turn. Some resistance will be felt  
when turning the jack handle  
assembly.  
4. Turn the handle counterclockwise  
and lower the spare tire until you  
can slide the tire rearward and the  
cable is slack.  
5. Remove the retainer through the center of the wheel.  
Tire change procedure  
WARNING: When one of the rear wheels is off the ground, the  
transmission alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or  
slipping off the jack, even if the transmission is in P (Park) (automatic  
transmission) or R (Reverse) (manual transmission). To help prevent  
the vehicle from moving when you change the tire, be sure that the  
parking brake is set and the diagonally opposite wheel is blocked.  
WARNING: To prevent the vehicle from moving when you  
change a tire, be sure the parking brake is set, then block (in  
both directions) the wheel that is diagonally opposite (other side and  
end of the vehicle) to the tire being changed.  
WARNING: If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone else  
could be seriously injured.  
319  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the  
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off the road to  
avoid the danger of being hit when operating the jack or changing the  
wheel.  
Note: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is  
being jacked.  
1. Turn engine off and block the  
wheel that is diagonally opposite of  
the flat tire using the wheel chock,  
if equipped. If the vehicle is a  
4x4, lock the manual hub on the  
wheel.  
2. Remove the jack, jack handle, lug wrench and spare tire from the  
stowage locations.  
3. Use the tip of the lug wrench to remove any wheel trim.  
4. Loosen each wheel lug nut one-half turn counterclockwise but do not  
remove them until the wheel is raised off the ground.  
The following steps apply to F–250/F–350 Single Rear Wheel  
(SRW) vehicles only:  
5. Insert the hooked end of the jack  
handle into the jack and use the  
handle to slide the jack under the  
vehicle.  
6. Position the jack according to the  
following guides:  
Front (4x2)  
320  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Front driver side (4x4)  
Note: Make sure the jack fits onto  
the flat area on the outboard side of  
the differential.  
Front passenger side (4x4)  
Note: View shown from the rear of  
the vehicle to clearly identify the  
jack point. Place the jack directly  
under the axle.  
Rear  
321  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Never use the front or rear  
differential as a jacking point.  
WARNING: To lessen the  
risk of personal injury, do  
not put any part of your body  
under the vehicle while changing a  
tire. Do not start the engine when  
your vehicle is on the jack. The  
jack is only meant for changing  
the tire.  
7. Turn the jack handle clockwise  
until the wheel is completely off the  
ground and high enough to install  
the spare tire.  
8. Remove the lug nuts with the lug  
wrench.  
9. Replace the flat tire with the  
spare tire, making sure the valve  
stem is facing outward for all front wheels and single rear wheel vehicles.  
If replacing an inboard rear tire on dual rear wheel vehicles, the valve  
stem must be facing outward. If replacing the outboard wheel, the valve  
stem must be facing inward. Reinstall the lug nuts until the wheel is  
snug against the hub. Do not fully tighten the lug nuts until the wheel  
has been lowered.  
10. Lower the wheel by turning the jack handle counterclockwise.  
Go to step 19.  
The following steps apply to F–350 Dual Rear Wheel (DRW) and  
F–450/F–550 vehicles only:  
11. Slide the notched end of the  
jack handle over the release valve  
and use the handle to slide the jack  
under the vehicle. Make sure the  
valve is closed by turning it  
clockwise.  
322  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
12. Position the jack according to the following guides:  
Front (4x2): F–350 DRW  
Note: Place jack directly under  
I-beam.  
Front driver side (4x4): F–350  
DRW  
Note: Make sure the jack fits onto  
the flat area on the outboard side of  
the differential housing.  
Front passenger side (4x4): F-350  
DRW  
Note: View shown from the rear of  
the vehicle to clearly identify the  
jack point.  
Note: Place the jack directly under  
axle and inboard of the radius arm  
so that the jack clears the radius  
arm.  
323  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Front: F–450/F–550  
Rear: F-350 DRW  
Rear: F-450/F-550  
13. Insert the jack handle into the  
pump linkage.  
14. Use an up-and-down motion  
with the jack handle to raise the  
wheel completely off the ground.  
Hydraulic jacks are equipped  
with a pressure release valve  
that prevents lifting loads which  
exceed the jack’s rated capacity.  
324  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
15. Remove the lug nuts with the lug wrench.  
16. Replace the flat tire with the spare tire, making sure the valve stem  
is facing outward on all front an inboard rear wheels. If replacing the  
outboard wheel, the valve stem must be facing inward. Reinstall the lug  
nuts until the wheel is snug against the hub. Do not fully tighten the lug  
nuts until the wheel has been lowered.  
17. Lower the wheel by slowly turning the release valve  
counterclockwise. Opening the release valve slowly will provide a more  
controlled rate of descent.  
The following steps apply to all vehicles:  
18. Remove the jack and fully  
tighten the lug nuts in the order  
shown. Refer to Wheel lug nut  
torque specifications later in this  
chapter for the proper lug nut  
torque specification.  
8–lug nut torque sequence  
325  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
10–lug nut torque sequence  
19. Stow the flat tire. Refer to Stowing the flat/spare tire if the vehicle  
is equipped with a spare tire carrier.  
Note: Do not stow the Harley-Davidson flat tire and wheel using the  
spare tire winch mechanism; store the flat in the bed of the truck.  
20. Stow the jack, jack handle and lug wrench. Make sure the jack is  
securely fastened so it does not rattle when driving.  
21. Unblock the wheels.  
The following step applies to F–250/F–350 Single Rear Wheel  
(SRW) vehicles only:  
22. When installing the wheel center  
ornaments, ensure that the  
ornament retention towers on the  
back side of the ornament are  
aligned with the studs/lug nuts. The  
retention towers are designed to be  
installed over the studs/nuts and  
retain to the flange on the lug nut.  
326  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
If the ornament retention towers are  
aligned between the studs/lug nuts,  
the ornament is improperly  
installed. This improper installation  
may appear and sound correct, but  
will not keep the ornament on the  
vehicle. Ornaments improperly  
installed in this manner will fall off  
or become loose with minimal force  
or impact.  
Installing dual rear wheel ornaments  
1. Align the ornament with the lug  
nuts.  
(1) is the clip and (2) is the  
flange.  
1
2
2. Hold the ornament so that all of  
the retention clips are sitting on the  
flange of the lug nuts.  
3. Use your hand or rubber mallet to  
tap the ornament in a star pattern.  
There should be an even gap  
between the ornament and the  
wheel.  
327  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
4. Be sure to install all the clips on the nuts over the flanges so that  
there is an even gap all around and the retention clips are fully seated.  
Stowing the flat/spare tire  
Note: Failure to follow spare tire stowage instructions may result in  
failure of cable or loss of spare tire.  
1. Lay the tire on the ground with the valve stem facing in the direction  
specified on the Tire Changing Instructions located in the glove box.  
2. Slide the wheel partially under the vehicle and install the retainer  
through the wheel center. Pull on the cable to align the components at  
the end of the cable.  
3. Turn the jack handle clockwise until the tire is raised to its stowed  
position underneath the vehicle. The effort to turn the jack handle  
increases significantly and the spare tire carrier ratchets or slips when  
the tire is raised to the maximum tightness. Tighten to the best of your  
ability, to the point where the ratchet/slip occurs, if possible. The spare  
tire carrier will not allow you to overtighten. If the spare tire carrier  
ratchets or slips with little effort, take the vehicle to your authorized  
dealer for assistance at your earliest convenience.  
4. Check that the tire lies flat against the frame and is properly  
tightened. Try to push or pull, then turn the tire to be sure it will not  
move. Loosen and retighten, if necessary. Failure to properly stow the  
spare tire may result in failure of the winch cable and loss of the tire.  
328  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
5. Repeat this tightness check procedure when servicing the spare tire  
pressure (every six months, per scheduled maintenance information),  
or at any time that the spare tire is disturbed through service of other  
components.  
6. If removed, install the spare tire lock (if equipped) into the bumper  
drive tube with the spare tire lock key (if equipped) and jack handle.  
WHEEL LUG NUT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS  
On vehicles equipped with single rear wheels, retighten the lug nuts to  
the specified torque at 500 miles (800 km) after any wheel disturbance  
(tire rotation, changing a flat tire, wheel removal, etc.).  
On vehicles equipped with dual rear wheels, retighten the wheel lug nuts  
to the specified torque at 100 miles (160 km), and again at 500 miles  
(800 km) of new vehicle operation and after any wheel disturbance (tire  
rotation, changing a flat tire, wheel removal, etc.).  
Bolt size  
Wheel lug nut torque*  
lb.ft.  
165  
Nm  
M14 x 1.5  
224  
* Torque specifications are for nut and bolt threads free of dirt and  
rust. Use only Ford recommended replacement fasteners.  
It is important to follow the proper wheel mounting and lug nut torque  
procedures.  
On all two-piece flat wheel nuts,  
apply one drop of motor oil between  
the flat washer and the nut.  
WARNING: When a wheel is installed, always remove any  
corrosion, dirt or foreign materials present on the mounting  
surfaces of the wheel or the surface of the wheel hub, brake drum or  
brake disc that contacts the wheel. Ensure that any fasteners that  
attach the rotor to the hub are secured so they do not interfere with  
the mounting surfaces of the wheel. Installing wheels without correct  
metal-to-metal contact at the wheel mounting surfaces can cause the  
wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel to come off while the vehicle is in  
motion, resulting in loss of control.  
329  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Inspect the wheel pilot hole prior to  
installation. If there is visible  
corrosion in wheel pilot hole,  
remove loose particles by wiping  
with clean rag and apply grease.  
Apply grease only to the wheel pilot  
hole surface by smearing a “dime”  
(1 square cm) sized glob of grease  
around the wheel pilot surface (1)  
with end of finger. DO NOT apply  
grease to lug nut/stud holes or  
wheel-to-brake surfaces.  
JUMP STARTING  
WARNING: The gases around the battery can explode if  
exposed to flames, sparks, or lit cigarettes. An explosion could  
result in injury or vehicle damage.  
WARNING: Batteries contain sulfuric acid which can burn skin,  
eyes and clothing, if contacted.  
Do not attempt to push-start your automatic transmission  
vehicle. Automatic transmissions do not have push-start  
capability. Attempting to push-start a vehicle with an automatic  
transmission may cause transmission damage.  
Preparing your vehicle  
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the  
automatic transmission must relearn its shift strategy. As a result, the  
transmission may have firm and/or soft shifts. This operation is  
considered normal and will not affect function or durability of the  
transmission. Over time, the adaptive learning process will fully update  
transmission operation.  
1. Use only a 12–volt supply to start your vehicle.  
2. Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle as this could  
damage the vehicle’s electrical system.  
3. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled vehicle  
making sure the two vehicles do not touch. Set the parking brake on  
both vehicles and stay clear of the engine cooling fan and other moving  
parts.  
330  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
4. Check all battery terminals and remove any excessive corrosion before  
you attach the battery cables. Ensure that vent caps are tight and level.  
5. Turn the heater fan on in both vehicles to protect from any electrical  
surges. Turn all other accessories off.  
Connecting the jumper cables  
1. Connect the positive (+) jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of  
the discharged battery.  
Note: In the illustrations, lightning bolts are used to designate the  
assisting (boosting) battery.  
2. Connect the other end of the positive (+) cable to the positive (+)  
terminal of the assisting battery.  
331  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Connect the negative (-) cable to the negative (-) terminal of the  
assisting battery.  
4. Make the final connection of the negative (-) cable to an exposed  
metal part of the stalled vehicle’s engine, away from the battery and the  
carburetor/fuel injection system.  
Note: Do not attach the negative (-) cable to fuel lines, engine rocker  
covers, the intake manifold or electrical components as grounding  
points.  
WARNING: Do not connect the end of the second cable to the  
negative (-) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A spark may  
cause an explosion of the gases that surround the battery.  
5. Ensure that the cables are clear of fan blades, belts, moving parts of  
both engines, or any fuel delivery system parts.  
332  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Jump starting  
1. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and run the engine at  
moderately increased speed.  
2. Start the engine of the disabled vehicle.  
3. Once the disabled vehicle has been started, run both engines for an  
additional three minutes before disconnecting the jumper cables.  
Removing the jumper cables  
Remove the jumper cables in the reverse order that they were  
connected.  
1. Remove the jumper cable from the ground metal surface.  
Note: In the illustrations, lightning bolts are used to designate the  
assisting (boosting) battery.  
2. Remove the jumper cable on the negative (-) connection of the  
booster vehicle’s battery.  
333  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the booster  
vehicle’s battery.  
4. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the  
disabled vehicle’s battery.  
After the disabled vehicle has been started and the jumper cables  
removed, allow it to idle for several minutes so the engine computer can  
relearn its idle conditions.  
334  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
WRECKER TOWING  
If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional towing  
service or, if you are a member of a roadside assistance program, your  
roadside assistance service provider.  
It is recommended that the vehicle be towed with a wheel lift or flatbed  
equipment. Do not tow with a slingbelt. Ford Motor Company has not  
approved a slingbelt towing procedure.  
On 4x2 vehicles, it is acceptable to tow the vehicle with the front wheels  
on the ground and the rear wheels off the ground using a wheel lift  
On 4x4 vehicles, it is recommended that your vehicle be towed using  
flatbed equipment with all the wheels off the ground. However, a wheel  
lift may be used to lift the rear of the vehicle so long as, depending on  
vehicle configurations, the following preparations are met:  
On Electronic Shift-On-the-Fly (ESOF) vehicles, the 4x4 control is  
turned to the 2WD position prior to towing.  
On manual-shift transfer case vehicles, the front wheel hub locks are  
in the FREE position prior to towing.  
335  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: Towing an ESOF 4x4 vehicle with the front wheels on the ground  
without disengaging the front hubs may cause damage to the automatic  
transmission.  
Note: Towing a 4x2 or an ESOF 4x4 vehicle with the rear wheels on the  
ground for more than 50 miles (80 km) and/or in excess of 35 mph  
(56 km/h) may cause damage to the automatic transmission.  
Note: On Dual Rear Wheel (DRW) vehicles, an outer rear wheel must be  
removed prior to using a wheel lift wrecker.  
Ford Motor Company produces a towing manual for all authorized tow  
truck operators. Have your tow truck operator refer to this manual for  
proper hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle.  
If the vehicle is towed by other means or incorrectly, vehicle  
damage may occur.  
Emergency towing  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle (without access  
to wheel dollies, car hauling trailer, or flatbed transport vehicle) your  
vehicle (regardless of transmission powertrain configuration) can be flat  
towed (all wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:  
Vehicle is facing forward so that it is being towed in a forward  
direction.  
Place the transmission in N (Neutral). Refer to Brake-shift interlock  
in the Driving chapter for specific instructions if you cannot move the  
gear shift lever into N (Neutral).  
Maximum speed is not to exceed 35 mph (56 km/h).  
Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).  
336  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
GETTING THE SERVICES YOU NEED  
Warranty repairs to your vehicle must be performed by an authorized  
Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealer. While any authorized dealer handling  
your vehicle line will provide warranty service, we recommend you  
return to your selling authorized dealer who wants to ensure your  
continued satisfaction.  
Please note that certain warranty repairs require special training and/or  
equipment, so not all authorized dealers are authorized to perform all  
warranty repairs. This means that, depending on the warranty repair  
needed, you may have to take your vehicle to another authorized dealer.  
A reasonable time must be allowed to perform a repair after taking your  
vehicle to the authorized dealer. Repairs will be made using Ford or  
Motorcraft parts, or remanufactured or other parts that are authorized by  
Ford.  
Away from home  
If you are away from home when your vehicle needs service, contact the  
Ford Customer Relationship Center or use the online resources listed  
below to find the nearest authorized dealer.  
In the United States:  
Mailing address  
Ford Motor Company  
Customer Relationship Center  
P.O. Box 6248  
Dearborn, MI 48121  
Telephone  
1-800-392-3673 (FORD)  
(TDD for the hearing impaired: 1-800-232-5952)  
Online  
Additional information and resources are available online at  
www.genuineservice.com.  
U.S. dealer locator by Dealer Name, City/State, or Zip Code  
Owner Guides  
Maintenance Schedules  
Recalls  
Ford Extended Service Plans  
Ford Genuine Accessories  
Service specials and promotions.  
337  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
In Canada:  
Mailing address (Ford vehicles)  
Customer Relationship Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-565-3673 (FORD)  
Online  
www.ford.ca  
Mailing address (Lincoln vehicles)  
Lincoln Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-387-9333  
Online  
www.lincolncanada.com  
Additional assistance  
If you have questions or concerns, or are unsatisfied with the service you  
are receiving, follow these steps:  
1. Contact your Sales Representative or Service Advisor at your  
selling/servicing authorized dealer.  
2. If your inquiry or concern remains unresolved, contact the Sales  
Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager.  
3. If you require assistance or clarification on Ford Motor Company  
policies, please contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center  
In order to help you serve you better, please have the following  
information available when contacting a Customer Relationship Center:  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Your telephone number (home and business)  
The name of the authorized dealer and city where located  
The vehicle’s current odometer reading  
In some states, you must directly notify Ford in writing before pursuing  
remedies under your state’s warranty laws. Ford is also allowed a final  
repair attempt in some states.  
338  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
In the United States, a warranty dispute must be submitted to the BBB  
AUTO LINE before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before pursuing replacement  
or repurchase remedies provided by certain state laws. This dispute  
handling procedure is not required prior to enforcing state created rights  
or other rights which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act or state replacement or repurchase laws.  
IN CALIFORNIA (U.S. ONLY)  
California Civil Code Section 1793.2(d) requires that, if a manufacturer  
or its representative is unable to repair a motor vehicle to conform to the  
vehicle’s applicable express warranty after a reasonable number of  
attempts, the manufacturer shall be required to either replace the  
vehicle with one substantially identical or repurchase the vehicle and  
reimburse the buyer in an amount equal to the actual price paid or  
payable by the consumer (less a reasonable allowance for consumer  
use). The consumer has the right to choose whether to receive a refund  
or replacement vehicle.  
California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) presumes that the manufacturer  
has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its  
applicable express warranties if, within the first 18 months of ownership  
of a new vehicle or the first 18,000 miles (29,000 km), whichever occurs  
first:  
1. Two or more repair attempts are made on the same non-conformity  
likely to cause death or serious bodily injury OR  
2. Four or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity (a  
defect or condition that substantially impairs the use, value or safety of  
the vehicle) OR  
3. The vehicle is out of service for repair of nonconformities for a total of  
more than 30 calendar days (not necessarily all at one time)  
In the case of 1 or 2 above, the consumer must also notify the  
manufacturer of the need for the repair of the nonconformity at the  
following address:  
Ford Motor Company  
16800 Executive Plaza Drive  
Mail Drop 3NE-B  
Dearborn, MI 48126  
339  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
THE BETTER BUSINESS BUREAU (BBB) AUTO LINE PROGRAM  
(U.S. ONLY)  
Your satisfaction is important to Ford Motor Company and to your dealer.  
If a warranty concern has not been resolved using the three-step  
procedure outlined on the first page of the Customer Assistance section,  
you may be eligible to participate in the BBB AUTO LINE program.  
The BBB AUTO LINE program consists of two parts – mediation and  
arbitration. During mediation, a representative of the BBB will contact  
both you and Ford Motor Company to explore options for settlement of  
the claim. If an agreement is not reached during mediation and your  
claim is eligible, you may participate in the arbitration process. An  
arbitration hearing will be scheduled so that you can present your case  
in an informal setting before an impartial person. The arbitrator will  
consider the testimony provided and make a decision after the hearing.  
You are not bound by the decision, but should you choose to accept the  
BBB AUTO LINE decision, Ford must abide by the accepted decision as  
well. Disputes submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE program are usually  
decided within forty days after you file your claim with the BBB.  
BBB AUTO LINE Application: Using the information provided below,  
please call or write to request a program application. You will be asked  
for your name and address, general information about your new vehicle,  
information about your warranty concerns, and any steps you have  
already taken to try to resolve them. A Customer Claim Form will be  
mailed that will need to be completed, signed and returned to the BBB  
along with proof of ownership. Upon receipt, the BBB will review the  
claim for eligibility under the Program Summary Guidelines.  
You can get more information by calling BBB AUTO LINE at  
1-800-955-5100, or writing to:  
BBB AUTO LINE  
4200 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 800  
Arlington, Virginia 22203–1833  
BBB AUTO LINE applications can also be requested by calling the Ford  
Motor Company Customer Relationship Center at 1-800-392-3673.  
Note: Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility  
limitations, modify procedures, or to discontinue this process at any time  
without notice and without obligation.  
340  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
UTILIZING THE MEDIATION/ARBITRATION PROGRAM  
(CANADA ONLY)  
For vehicles delivered to authorized Canadian dealers. In those cases  
where you continue to feel that the efforts by Ford of Canada and the  
authorized dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle service concern  
have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in an impartial  
third party mediation/arbitration program administered by the Canadian  
Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).  
The CAMVAP program is a straight-forward and relatively speedy  
alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other efforts to produce a  
settlement have failed. This procedure is without cost to you and is  
designed to eliminate the need for lengthy and expensive legal  
proceedings.  
In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party arbitrators conduct  
hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an informal  
environment. These impartial arbitrators review the positions of the  
parties, make decisions and, when appropriate, render awards to resolve  
disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair, and final as the arbitrator’s  
award is binding both to you and Ford of Canada.  
CAMVAP services are available in all territories and provinces. For more  
information, without charge or obligation, call your CAMVAP Provincial  
Administrator directly at 1-800-207-0685.  
GETTING ASSISTANCE OUTSIDE THE U.S. AND CANADA  
Before exporting your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the  
appropriate foreign embassy or consulate. These officials can inform you  
of local vehicle registration regulations and where to find unleaded fuel.  
If you cannot find unleaded fuel or can only get fuel with an anti-knock  
index lower than is recommended for your vehicle, contact a regional  
office or owner relations/customer relationship office.  
The use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without proper conversion may  
damage the effectiveness of your emission control system and may cause  
engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford Motor Company/Ford of  
Canada is not responsible for any damage caused by use of improper  
fuel. Using leaded fuel may also result in difficulty importing your vehicle  
back into the U.S.  
341  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in  
Central America, the Caribbean, or the Middle East, contact the nearest  
authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact:  
FORD MOTOR COMPANY  
FORD EXPORT OPERATIONS  
1555 Fairlane Drive  
Fairlane Business Park #3  
Allen Park, Michigan 48101  
U.S.A.  
Telephone: (313) 594-4857  
FAX: (313) 390-0804  
If you are in another foreign country, contact the nearest authorized  
dealer. If the authorized dealer employees cannot help you, they can  
direct you to the nearest Ford affiliate office.  
If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate outside of  
the U.S. or Canada, register your vehicle identification number (VIN) and  
new address with Ford Motor Company Export Operations.  
Customers in the U.S. should call 1-800-392-3673.  
ORDERING ADDITIONAL OWNER’S LITERATURE  
To order the publications in this portfolio, contact Helm, Incorporated at:  
HELM, INCORPORATED  
P.O. Box 07150  
Detroit, Michigan 48207  
Or to order a free publication catalog, call toll free: 1-800-782-4356  
Monday-Friday 8:00 a.m. - 6:00 p.m. EST  
Helm, Incorporated can also be reached by their website:  
www.helminc.com.  
(Items in this catalog may be purchased by credit card, check or  
money order.)  
Obtaining a French Owner’s Guide  
French Owner’s Guides can be obtained from your authorized dealer or  
by writing to:  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
Service Publications CHQ202  
The Canadian Road  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, ON, Canada  
L6J 5E4  
342  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (U.S. ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has  
a defect which could cause a crash  
or could cause injury or death, you  
should immediately inform the  
National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and  
if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a  
recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved  
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor  
Company.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov;  
or write to:  
Administrator  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, Southeast  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
http://www.safercar.gov.  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (CANADA ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or  
could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport  
Canada, using their toll-free number: 1–800–333–0510.  
343  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WASHING THE EXTERIOR  
Wash your vehicle regularly with cool or lukewarm water and a neutral  
pH shampoo, such as MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A), which is  
available from your authorized dealer.  
Never use strong household detergents or soap, such as dish washing  
or laundry liquid. These products can discolor and spot painted  
surfaces.  
Never wash a vehicle that is “hot to the touch” or during exposure to  
strong, direct sunlight.  
Always use a clean sponge or car wash mitt with plenty of water for  
best results.  
Dry the vehicle with a chamois or soft terry cloth towel in order to  
eliminate water spotting.  
It is especially important to wash the vehicle regularly during the  
winter months, as dirt and road salt are difficult to remove and cause  
damage to the vehicle.  
Immediately remove items such as gasoline, diesel fuel, bird droppings  
and insect deposits because they can cause damage to the vehicle’s  
paintwork and trim over time. Use MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), which is available from your authorized dealer.  
Remove any exterior accessories, such as antennas, before entering a  
car wash.  
Suntan lotions and insect repellents can damage any painted  
surface; if these substances come in contact with your vehicle,  
wash off as soon as possible.  
If your vehicle is equipped with running boards, do not use  
rubber, plastic and vinyl protectant products on the running  
board surface, as the area may become slippery.  
Exterior chrome  
Wash the vehicle first, using cool or lukewarm water and a neutral pH  
shampoo, such as MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
Use MotorcraftCustom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15), available from  
your authorized dealer. Apply the product as you would a wax to  
clean bumpers and other chrome parts; allow the cleaner to dry for a  
few minutes, then wipe off the haze with a clean, dry rag.  
Never use abrasive materials such as steel wool or plastic pads  
as they can scratch the chrome surface.  
344  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
After polishing chrome bumpers, apply a coating of Motorcraft௡  
Premium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product to help protect from environmental  
effects.  
WAXING  
Wash the vehicle first.  
Do not use waxes that contain abrasives; use MotorcraftPremium  
Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), which is available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product.  
Do not allow paint sealant to come in contact with any non-body  
(low-gloss black) colored trim, such as grained door handles, roof  
racks, bumpers, side moldings, mirror housings or the windshield cowl  
area. The paint sealant will “gray” or stain the parts over time.  
PAINT CHIPS  
Your authorized dealer has touch-up paint to match your vehicle’s color.  
Take your color code (printed on a sticker in the driver’s door jamb) to  
your authorized dealer to ensure you get the correct color.  
Remove particles such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect deposits, tar  
spots, road salt and industrial fallout before repairing paint chips.  
Always read the instructions before using the products.  
ALUMINUM WHEELS AND WHEEL COVERS  
Aluminum wheels and wheel covers are coated with a clearcoat paint  
finish. In order to maintain their shine:  
Clean weekly with MotorcraftWheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A),  
which is available from your authorized dealer. Heavy dirt and brake  
dust accumulation may require agitation with a sponge. Rinse  
thoroughly with a strong stream of water.  
Never apply any cleaning chemical to hot or warm wheel rims or  
covers.  
Some automatic car washes may cause damage to the finish on your  
wheel rims or covers. Chemical-strength cleaners, or cleaning  
chemicals, in combination with brush agitation to remove brake dust  
and dirt, could wear away the clearcoat finish over time.  
Do not use hydrofluoric acid-based or high caustic-based wheel  
cleaners, steel wool, fuels or strong household detergent.  
To remove tar and grease, use MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), available from your authorized dealer.  
345  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
ENGINE  
Engines are more efficient when they are clean because grease and dirt  
buildup keep the engine warmer than normal. When washing:  
Take care when using a power washer to clean the engine. The  
high-pressure fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause  
damage.  
Do not spray a hot engine with cold water to avoid cracking the  
engine block or other engine components.  
Spray MotorcraftEngine Shampoo and Degreaser (ZC-20) on all  
parts that require cleaning and pressure rinse clean.  
Never wash or rinse the engine while it is running; water in the  
running engine may cause internal damage.  
Never wash or rinse any ignition coil, spark plug wire or spark plug  
well, or the area in and around these locations.  
Cover the highlighted areas to prevent water damage when cleaning  
the engine.  
5.4L V8 gasoline engine  
346  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
6.8L V10 gasoline engine  
PLASTIC (NON-PAINTED) EXTERIOR PARTS  
Use only approved products to clean plastic parts. These products are  
available from your authorized dealer.  
For routine cleaning, use MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
If tar or grease spots are present, use MotorcraftBug and Tar  
Remover (ZC-42).  
WINDOWS AND WIPER BLADES  
The windshield, rear and side windows and the wiper blades should be  
cleaned regularly. If the wipers do not wipe properly, substances on the  
vehicle’s glass or the wiper blades may be the cause. These may include  
hot wax treatments used by commercial car washes, water repellant  
coatings, tree sap, or other organic contamination; these contaminants  
may cause squeaking or chatter noise from the blades, and streaking and  
smearing of the windshield. To clean these items, follow these tips:  
The windshield, rear windows and side windows may be cleaned with  
a non-abrasive cleaner such as MotorcraftUltra-Clear Spray Glass  
Cleaner (ZC-23), available from your authorized dealer.  
The wiper blades can be cleaned with isopropyl (rubbing) alcohol or  
MotorcraftPremium Windshield Washer Concentrate (ZC-32–A),  
available from your authorized dealer. This washer fluid contains  
special solution in addition to alcohol which helps to remove the hot  
347  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
wax deposited on the wiper blade and windshield from automated car  
wash facilities. Be sure to replace wiper blades when they appear  
worn or do not function properly.  
Do not use abrasives, as they may cause scratches.  
Do not use fuel, kerosene, or paint thinner to clean any parts.  
INSTRUMENT PANEL/INTERIOR TRIM AND CLUSTER LENS  
(EXCEPT HARLEY-DAVIDSON)  
Clean the instrument panel, interior trim areas and cluster lens with a  
clean and damp, white cotton cloth, then with a clean and dry, white  
cotton cloth.  
Avoid cleaners or polishes that increase the gloss of the upper portion  
of the instrument panel. The dull finish in this area helps protect the  
driver from undesirable windshield reflection.  
Be certain to wash or wipe your hands clean if you have been in  
contact with certain products such as insect repellent and suntan  
lotion in order to avoid possible damage to the interior painted  
surfaces.  
Do not use household or glass cleaners as these may damage the  
finish of the instrument panel, interior trim and cluster lens.  
WARNING: Do not use chemical solvents or strong detergents  
when cleaning the steering wheel or instrument panel to avoid  
contamination of the airbag system.  
If a staining liquid like coffee/juice has been spilled on the instrument  
panel or on interior trim surfaces, clean as follows:  
1. Wipe up spilled liquid using a clean white cotton cloth.  
2. Wipe the surface with a damp, clean, white cotton cloth. For more  
thorough cleaning, use a mild soap and water solution. If the spot cannot  
be completely cleaned by this method, the area may be cleaned using a  
commercially available cleaning product designed for automotive  
interiors.  
3. If necessary, apply more soap and water solution or cleaning product  
to a clean, white, cotton cloth and press the cloth onto the soiled  
area–allow this to set at room temperature for 30 minutes.  
4. Remove the soaked cloth, and if it is not soiled badly, use this cloth to  
clean the area by using a rubbing motion for 60 seconds.  
5. Following this, wipe area dry with a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
348  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
INSTRUMENT PANEL AND CONSOLE (HARLEY-DAVIDSON ONLY)  
Your vehicle’s instrument panel and console are uniquely painted with both  
high and low gloss paints that require special care. The high gloss area is  
similar to that of the vehicle’s exterior; the low gloss area is designed to  
help protect the driver from undesirable windshield reflection.  
High gloss paint area  
In order to maintain the finish of the instrument panel and console, the  
high gloss areas should be treated similar to the that of exterior paint or  
glossy plastic surfaces. When cleaning the high gloss areas:  
Do not use paper towels or newspaper.  
Do not use silicone or Teflont (PTFE)-based products.  
Dust the high gloss areas with a clean, dry cloth, or use MotorcraftDusting  
Cloth (ZC-24 or ZC-25) or MotorcraftDusting Cloth Mitts (ZC-47).  
For general cleaning, use mild, soapy water and a soft, damp cloth, then  
dry with a clean, dry cloth; or MotorcraftUltra-Clear Spray Glass  
Cleaner (ZC-23).  
For removal of fine scuffs and scratches, use Scotch-Brite Microfiber Cloth  
or cheese cloth along with MotorcraftPremium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A),  
MotorcraftPaint Sealant (ZC-45), or MotorcraftCustom Clear Coat  
Polish (ZC-8-A). Note: Removal of deep scuffs and scratches should be  
performed by an authorized dealer or an experienced repair facility.  
Low gloss paint area  
The low gloss area of the instrument panel’s upper dash should be  
cleaned with mild, soapy water and a soft, damp cloth, then dried with a  
clean, dry cloth. When cleaning the low gloss areas:  
Do not use paper towels or newspaper.  
Do not use silicone or Teflont (PTFE)-based products.  
Do not use exterior paint waxes or sealants.  
Dust the low gloss areas with a clean, dry cloth, or use MotorcraftDusting  
Cloth (ZC-24 or ZC-25) or MotorcraftDusting Cloth Mitts (ZC-47).  
INTERIOR  
For fabric, carpets, cloth seats and safety belts:  
Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.  
Remove light stains and soil with MotorcraftProfessional Strength  
Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54).  
349  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
If grease or tar is present on the material, spot-clean the area first  
with MotorcraftSpot and Stain Remover (ZC-14). In Canada, use  
MotorcraftMulti-Purpose Cleaner (CXC-101).  
If a ring forms on the fabric after spot cleaning, clean the entire area  
immediately (but do not oversaturate) or the ring will set.  
Do not use household cleaning products or glass cleaners, which can  
stain and discolor the fabric and affect the flame retardant abilities of  
the seat materials.  
WARNING: Do not use cleaning solvents, bleach or dye on the  
vehicle’s seatbelts, as these actions may weaken the belt  
webbing.  
LEATHER SEATS (IF EQUIPPED, EXCEPT FOR THE KING RANCH  
F–250 AND F–350 CREW CAB)  
Your leather seating surfaces have a clear, protective coating over the  
leather.  
For King Ranch F-250 and F-350 Crew Cab leather seats, refer to  
separate section in this chapter.  
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For  
more thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap and water  
solution. In Canada, use MotorcraftVinyl Cleaner (CXC-93). Dry the  
area with a soft cloth.  
If the leather cannot be completely cleaned using a mild soap and  
water solution, the leather may be cleaned using a commercially  
available cleaning product designed for automotive interiors.  
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions, solvents or  
cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl and plastics, or oil/petroleum-based  
leather conditioners. These products may cause premature wearing of  
the clear, protective coating on the seat.  
Note: In some instances, color or dye transfer can occur when wet  
clothing comes in contact with leather upholstery. If this occurs, the  
leather should be cleaned immediately to avoid permanent staining.  
350  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cleaning  
LEATHER SEATS FOR THE KING RANCH F-250 AND F-350 CREW  
CAB ONLY (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle is equipped with seating covered in premium, top-grain  
leather which is extremely durable, but still requires special care and  
maintenance in order to ensure longevity and comfort.  
Regular cleaning and conditioning will maintain the appearance of the  
leather. Failure to care for the leather can result in drying out and fading  
of the material.  
Note: In some instances, color or dye transfer can occur when wet  
clothing comes in contact with leather upholstery. If this occurs, the  
leather should be cleaned immediately to avoid permanent staining.  
Cleaning  
For dirt, use a vacuum cleaner then use a clean, damp cloth or soft  
brush.  
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For more  
thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap. If the leather  
cannot be completely cleaned using a mild soap and water solution, the  
leather may be cleaned using a commercially available cleaning product  
“Tanners Preserve Leather Cleaner” and a 3M “Type T” scrubbing pad.  
Clean spills as quickly as possible.  
Test any cleaner or stain remover on an inconspicuous part of the  
leather as cleaners may darken the leather. For more specific cleaning  
information, contact the King Ranch Saddle Shop at 1–800–282–KING  
(5464).  
Do not spill coffee, ketchup, mustard, orange juice or oil-based  
products on the leather as they may permanently stain the leather.  
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions, solvents or  
cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl or plastics.  
Scratches  
Natural Markings - Because the leather in the seat comes from genuine  
steer hides, there will be evidence of naturally occurring markings, such  
as small scars. These markings give character to the seating covers and  
should be considered as proof of a genuine leather product.  
In order to lessen the appearance of certain scratches and other wear  
marks, apply conditioner on the affected area following the same  
instructions as in the Conditioning section.  
351  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
Conditioning  
Bottles of King Ranch Leather Conditioner are available at the King  
Ranch Saddle Shop. Visit the Web site at www.krsaddleshop.com, or  
telephone (in the United States) 1–800–282–KING (5464). If you are  
unable to obtain King Ranch Leather Conditioner, use another premium  
leather conditioner.  
Apply your first conditioning treatment within six months of taking  
delivery of your vehicle. Condition twice yearly in order to replenish  
lost oils and revitalize the aroma, suppleness and resilience of the  
leather.  
Clean the surfaces using the steps outlined in the Cleaning section.  
Ensure the leather is dry then apply a nickel-sized amount of  
conditioner to a clean, dry cloth  
Rub the conditioner into leather until it disappears. Allow the  
conditioner to dry and repeat the process for the entire interior. If a  
film appears, wipe off film with a dry, clean cloth.  
UNDERBODY  
Flush the complete underside of your vehicle frequently. Keep body and  
door drain holes free from packed dirt.  
Note: Use care when using a power washer to clean the driveline,  
especially the driveshaft and interfacing components. The high-pressure  
fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause damage.  
FORD, LINCOLN AND MERCURY CAR CARE PRODUCTS  
Your authorized dealer has many quality products available to clean your  
vehicle and protect its finishes. These quality products have been  
specifically engineered to fulfill your automotive needs; they are custom  
designed to complement the style and appearance of your vehicle. Each  
product is made from high quality materials that meet or exceed rigid  
specifications. For best results, use the following products or products of  
equivalent quality:  
MotorcraftBug and Tar Remover (ZC-42)  
MotorcraftCar Care Kit (ZC-26)  
MotorcraftCustom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15)  
MotorcraftCustom Clear Coat Polish (ZC–8–A)  
MotorcraftDetail Wash (ZC-3–A)  
MotorcraftDusting Cloth (ZC-24)  
352  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
MotorcraftEngine Shampoo and Degreaser (U.S only) (ZC-20)  
MotorcraftEngine Shampoo (Canada only) (CXC-66-A)  
MotorcraftMulti-Purpose Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-101)  
MotorcraftPremium Car Wash Concentrate (U.S. only) (ZC-17-B)  
MotorcraftPremium Glass Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-100)  
MotorcraftPremium Liquid Wax (ZC-53–A)  
MotorcraftProfessional Strength Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54)  
MotorcraftSpot and Stain Remover (U.S. only) (ZC-14)  
MotorcraftTire Clean and Shine (ZC-28)  
MotorcraftUltra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner (ZC-23)  
MotorcraftVinyl Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-93)  
MotorcraftVinyl Conditioner (Canada only) (CXC-94)  
MotorcraftWheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37–A)  
353  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
SERVICE RECOMMENDATIONS  
To help you service your vehicle, we provide scheduled maintenance  
information which makes tracking routine service easy.  
If your vehicle requires professional service, your authorized dealer can  
provide the necessary parts and service. Check your Warranty  
Guide/Customer Information Guide to find out which parts and  
services are covered.  
Use only recommended fuels, lubricants, fluids and service parts  
conforming to specifications. Motorcraftparts are designed and built to  
provide the best performance in your vehicle.  
PRECAUTIONS WHEN SERVICING YOUR VEHICLE  
Do not work on a hot engine.  
Make sure that nothing gets caught in moving parts.  
Do not work on a vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed  
space, unless you are sure you have enough ventilation.  
Keep all open flames and other burning material (such as cigarettes)  
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.  
Working with the engine off  
Automatic transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).  
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key.  
3. Block the wheels.  
Manual transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake, press and hold the clutch pedal, place the  
gearshift in 1 (First), and release the clutch pedal.  
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key.  
3. Block the wheels.  
Working with the engine on  
Automatic transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).  
2. Block the wheels.  
Manual transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake, press and hold the clutch pedal, place the  
gearshift in N (Neutral), and release the clutch pedal.  
354  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
2. Block the wheels.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
OPENING THE HOOD  
1. Inside the vehicle, pull the hood  
release handle located under the  
bottom left corner of the instrument  
panel.  
2. Go to the front of the vehicle and  
release the auxiliary latch located  
below the passenger side of the  
grille, next to the headlamp. Slide  
the handle to release the auxiliary  
latch.  
3. Lift the hood until the lift  
cylinders hold it open.  
355  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING COMPONENTS IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
Refer to the 6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo  
Diesel Owner’s Guide Supplement for diesel engine component  
locations.  
5.4L V8 gasoline engines  
1. Windshield washer fluid reservoir  
2. Battery  
3. Transmission fluid dipstick (automatic transmission)  
4. Engine oil filler cap  
5. Engine oil dipstick  
6. Power steering fluid reservoir  
7. Brake fluid reservoir  
8. Engine coolant reservoir  
9. Air filter assembly  
10. Power distribution box  
356  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
6.8L V10 gasoline engine  
1. Windshield washer fluid reservoir  
2. Battery  
3. Transmission fluid dipstick (automatic transmission)  
4. Engine oil filler cap  
5. Engine oil dipstick  
6. Power steering fluid reservoir  
7. Brake fluid reservoir  
8. Engine coolant reservoir  
9. Air filter assembly  
10. Power distribution box  
357  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID  
Add fluid to fill the reservoir if the  
level is low. In very cold weather, do  
not fill the reservoir completely.  
Only use a washer fluid that meets  
Ford specification WSB-M8B16-A2.  
Do not use any special washer fluid  
such as windshield water repellent  
type fluid or bug wash. They may  
cause squeaking, chatter noise,  
streaking and smearing. Refer to the  
Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities section in this chapter.  
State or local regulations on volatile organic compounds may restrict the  
use of methanol, a common windshield washer antifreeze additive.  
Washer fluids containing non-methanol antifreeze agents should be used  
only if they provide cold weather protection without damaging the  
vehicle’s paint finish, wiper blades or washer system.  
WARNING: If you operate your vehicle in temperatures below  
40°F (5°C), use washer fluid with antifreeze protection. Failure  
to use washer fluid with antifreeze protection in cold weather could  
result in impaired windshield vision and increase the risk of injury or  
accident.  
Note: Do not put washer fluid in the engine coolant reservoir. Washer  
fluid placed in the cooling system may harm engine and cooling system  
components.  
358  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
CHANGING THE WIPER BLADES  
1. Pull the wiper arm away from the  
vehicle. Turn the blade at an angle  
from the wiper arm. Press the lock  
tab to release the blade and pull the  
wiper blade down toward the  
windshield to remove it from the  
arm.  
2. Attach the new wiper to the  
wiper arm and press it into place  
until a click is heard.  
Replace wiper blades at least once per year for optimum performance.  
Poor wiper quality can be improved by cleaning the wiper blades and the  
windshield. Refer to Windows and wiper blades in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
To prolong the life of the wiper blades, it is highly recommended to  
scrape off the ice on the windshield before turning on the wipers. The  
layer of ice has many sharp edges and can damage the micro edge of the  
wiper rubber element.  
ENGINE OIL  
Checking the engine oil  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for checking the engine oil.  
1. Make sure the vehicle is on level ground.  
2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 minutes for the oil to drain into the  
oil pan.  
3. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(Park) (automatic transmission) or 1 (First) (manual transmission).  
4. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engine heat.  
359  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
5. Locate and carefully remove the engine oil dipstick.  
5.4L/6.8L gasoline engines only;  
for diesel engine information,  
refer to the 6.0 and 6.4 Liter  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner’s Guide Supplement.  
6. Wipe the dipstick clean. Insert the dipstick fully, then remove it again.  
If the oil level is between the MIN and MAX marks, the oil level is  
acceptable. DO NOT ADD OIL.  
If the oil level is below the MIN  
mark, add enough oil to raise the  
level within the MIN-MAX range.  
Oil levels above the MAX mark may cause engine damage. Some oil  
must be removed from the engine by a service technician.  
7. Put the dipstick back in and ensure it is fully seated.  
Adding engine oil  
1. Check the engine oil. For instructions, refer to Checking the engine  
oil in this chapter.  
2. If the engine oil level is not within the normal range, add only certified  
engine oil of the recommended viscosity. Remove the engine oil filler cap  
and use a funnel to pour the engine oil into the opening.  
360  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
3. Recheck the engine oil level. Make sure the oil level is not above the  
normal operating range on the engine oil level dipstick.  
4. Install the dipstick and ensure it is fully seated.  
5. Fully install the engine oil filler cap by turning the filler cap clockwise  
1/4 of a turn until three clicks are heard or until the cap is fully seated.  
To avoid possible oil loss, DO NOT operate the vehicle with the  
engine oil level dipstick and/or the engine oil filler cap removed.  
Engine oil and filter recommendations  
Look for this certification  
trademark.  
Use SAE 5W-20 engine oil  
Only use oils “Certified For Gasoline Engines” by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API). An oil with this trademark symbol conforms  
to the current engine and emission system protection standards and fuel  
economy requirements of the International Lubricant Standardization and  
Approval Committee (ILSAC), comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
automobile manufacturers.  
To protect your engine and engine’s warranty, use MotorcraftSAE  
5W-20 or an equivalent SAE 5W-20 oil meeting Ford specification  
WSS-M2C930-A. SAE 5W-20 oil provides optimum fuel economy and  
durability performance meeting all requirements for your  
vehicle’s engine. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities later in this chapter for more information.  
Do not use supplemental engine oil additives, cleaners or other engine  
treatments. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that  
is not covered by Ford warranty.  
Change your engine oil and filter according to the appropriate schedule  
listed in the scheduled maintenance information.  
361  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Ford production and Motorcraftreplacement oil filters are designed for  
added engine protection and long life. If a replacement oil filter is used  
that does not meet Ford material and design specifications, start-up  
engine noises or knock may be experienced.  
It is recommended you use the appropriate Motorcraftoil filter or  
another with equivalent performance for your engine application.  
BATTERY  
WARNING: This vehicle  
may be equipped with more  
than one battery, removal of cable  
from only one battery does not  
disconnect the vehicle electrical  
system. Be sure to disconnect  
cables from all batteries when  
disconnecting power. Failure to do  
so may cause serious personal  
injury or property damage.  
Your vehicle is equipped with a Motorcraftmaintenance-free battery  
which normally does not require additional water during its life of  
service.  
If your battery has a cover/shield, make sure it is reinstalled  
after the battery has been cleaned or replaced.  
For longer, trouble-free operation, keep the top of the battery clean and  
dry. Also, make certain the battery cables are always tightly fastened to  
the battery terminals.  
If you see any corrosion on the battery or terminals, remove the cables  
from the terminals and clean with a wire brush. You can neutralize the  
acid with a solution of baking soda and water.  
It is recommended that the negative battery cable terminal be  
disconnected from the battery if you plan to store your vehicle for an  
extended period of time. This will minimize the discharge of your battery  
during storage.  
Note: Electrical or electronic accessories or components added to  
the vehicle by the dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
362  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Batteries normally produce explosive gases which  
can cause personal injury. Therefore, do not allow flames, sparks  
or lighted substances to come near the battery. When working near the  
battery, always shield your face and protect your eyes. Always provide  
proper ventilation.  
WARNING: When lifting a plastic-cased battery, excessive  
pressure on the end walls could cause acid to flow through the  
vent caps, resulting in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle or  
battery. Lift the battery with a battery carrier or with your hands on  
opposite corners.  
WARNING: Keep batteries out of reach of children. Batteries  
contain sulfuric acid. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing.  
Shield your eyes when working near the battery to protect against  
possible splashing of acid solution. In case of acid contact with skin or  
eyes, flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and  
get prompt medical attention. If acid is swallowed, call a physician  
immediately.  
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling.  
Because your vehicle’s engine is also electronically controlled by a  
computer, some control conditions are maintained by power from the  
battery. When the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed,  
the engine must relearn its idle and fuel trim strategy for optimum  
driveability and performance. To begin this process:  
1. With the vehicle at a complete stop, set the parking brake.  
2. Put the gearshift in P (Park) (automatic transmission) or the neutral  
position (manual transmission), turn off all accessories and start the  
engine.  
3. Run the engine until it reaches normal operating temperature.  
4. Allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
5. Turn the A/C on and allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
6. Drive the vehicle to complete the relearning process.  
The vehicle may need to be driven 10 miles (16 km) or more to  
relearn the idle and fuel trim strategy.  
363  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
If you do not allow the engine to relearn its idle trim, the idle  
quality of your vehicle may be adversely affected until the idle  
trim is eventually relearned.  
If the battery has been disconnected or a new battery has been installed,  
the clock and the preset radio stations must be reset once the battery is  
reconnected.  
Always dispose of automotive  
batteries in a responsible manner.  
Follow your local authorized  
standards for disposal. Call your  
local authorized recycling center  
to find out more about recycling  
automotive batteries.  
RECYCLE  
ENGINE COOLANT  
Checking engine coolant  
The concentration and level of engine coolant should be checked at the  
intervals listed in scheduled maintenance information. The coolant  
concentration should be maintained at 50/50 coolant and distilled water,  
which equates to a freeze point of -34°F (-36°C). Coolant concentration  
testing is possible with a hydrometer or antifreeze tester. The level of  
coolant should be maintained at the FULL COLD level or within the  
COLD FILL RANGE in the coolant reservoir. If the level falls below, add  
coolant per the instructions in the Adding engine coolant section.  
Your vehicle was factory-filled with a 50/50 engine coolant and water  
concentration. If the concentration of coolant falls below 40% or above  
60%, the engine parts could become damaged or not work properly. A  
50/50 mixture of coolant and water provides the following:  
Freeze protection down to -34°F (-36°C).  
Boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C).  
Protection against rust and other forms of corrosion.  
Proper function of calibrated gauges.  
364  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
When the engine is cold, check the  
level of the engine coolant in the  
reservoir.  
The engine coolant should be at the FULL COLD level or within the  
COLD FILL RANGE as listed on the engine coolant reservoir  
(depending upon application).  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for service interval  
schedules.  
Be sure to read and understand Precautions when servicing your  
vehicle in this chapter.  
If the engine coolant has not been checked at the recommended interval,  
the engine coolant reservoir may become low or empty. If the reservoir is  
low or empty, add engine coolant to the reservoir. Refer to Adding  
engine coolant in this chapter.  
Note: Automotive fluids are not interchangeable; do not use engine  
coolant, antifreeze or windshield washer fluid outside of its specified  
function and vehicle location.  
Adding engine coolant  
When adding coolant, make sure it is a 50/50 mixture of engine coolant  
and distilled water. Add the mixture to the coolant reservoir, when the  
engine is cool, until the appropriate fill level is obtained.  
WARNING: Do not add engine coolant when the engine is hot.  
Steam and scalding liquids released from a hot cooling system  
can burn you badly. Also, you can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts.  
WARNING: Do not put engine coolant in the windshield washer  
fluid container. If sprayed on the windshield, engine coolant  
could make it difficult to see through the windshield.  
365  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Do not mix coolants. Add the coolant type originally equipped  
in your vehicle. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities in this chapter.  
Note: Do not use stop leak pellets or cooling system sealants/additives  
as they can cause damage to the engine cooling and/or heating systems.  
This damage would not be covered under your vehicle’s warranty.  
A large amount of water without engine coolant may be added, in case  
of emergency, to reach a vehicle service location. In this instance, the  
cooling system must be drained and refilled with a 50/50 mixture of  
engine coolant and distilled water as soon as possible. Water alone  
(without engine coolant) can cause engine damage from corrosion,  
overheating or freezing.  
Do not use alcohol, methanol, brine or any engine coolants  
mixed with alcohol or methanol antifreeze (coolant). Alcohol  
and other liquids can cause engine damage from overheating or  
freezing.  
Do not add extra inhibitors or additives to the coolant. These  
can be harmful and compromise the corrosion protection of the engine  
coolant.  
For vehicles with overflow coolant systems with a non-pressurized cap  
on the coolant recovery system, add coolant to the coolant recovery  
reservoir when the engine is cool. Add the proper mixture of coolant and  
water to the FULL COLD level. For all other vehicles which have a  
coolant degas system with a pressurized cap, or if it is necessary to  
remove the coolant pressure relief cap on the radiator of a vehicle with  
an overflow system, follow these steps to add engine coolant.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of personal injury, make sure the  
engine is cool before unscrewing the coolant pressure relief cap.  
The cooling system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come  
out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly.  
Add the proper mixture of coolant and water to the cooling system by  
following these steps:  
1. Before you begin, turn the engine off and let it cool.  
2. When the engine is cool, wrap a thick cloth around the coolant  
pressure relief cap on the coolant reservoir (a translucent plastic bottle).  
Slowly turn cap counterclockwise (left) until pressure begins to release.  
3. Step back while the pressure releases.  
366  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
4. When you are sure that all the pressure has been released, use the  
cloth to turn it counterclockwise and remove the cap.  
5. Fill the coolant reservoir slowly with the proper coolant mixture, to  
within the COLD FILL RANGE or the FULL COLD level on the reservoir.  
If you removed the radiator cap in an overflow system, fill the radiator  
until the coolant is visible and radiator is almost full.  
6. Replace the cap. Turn until tightly installed. Cap must be tightly  
installed to prevent coolant loss.  
After any coolant has been added, check the coolant concentration (refer  
to Checking engine coolant). If the concentration is not 50/50  
(protection to –34°F/–36°C), drain some coolant and adjust the  
concentration. It may take several drains and additions to obtain a 50/50  
coolant concentration.  
Whenever coolant has been added, the coolant level in the coolant  
reservoir should be checked the next few times you drive the vehicle. If  
necessary, add enough 50/50 concentration of engine coolant and  
distilled water to bring the liquid level to the proper level.  
If you have to add more than 1.0 quart (1.0 liter) of engine coolant per  
month, have your authorized dealer check the engine cooling system.  
Your cooling system may have a leak. Operating an engine with a low  
level of coolant can result in engine overheating and possible engine  
damage.  
Recycled engine coolant  
Ford Motor Company does NOT recommend the use of recycled engine  
coolant since a Ford-approved recycling process is not yet available.  
Used engine coolant should be disposed of in an appropriate  
manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for recycling  
and disposing of automotive fluids.  
Coolant refill capacity  
To find out how much fluid your vehicle’s cooling system can hold, refer  
to Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a diesel engine, refer to the  
Maintenance Product Specifications and Capacities section of your  
6.0 and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s  
Guide Supplement.  
Fill your engine coolant reservoir as outlined in Adding engine coolant  
in this section.  
367  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Severe climates  
If you drive in extremely cold climates (less than –34°F [–36°C]):  
It may be necessary to increase the coolant concentration  
above 50%.  
NEVER increase the coolant concentration above 60%.  
Increased engine coolant concentrations above 60% will  
decrease the overheat protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
freeze protection at the temperatures in which you drive in the  
winter months.  
If you drive in extremely hot climates:  
It is still necessary to maintain the coolant concentration  
above 40%.  
NEVER decrease the coolant concentration below 40%.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the corrosion protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the freeze protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
protection at the temperatures in which you drive.  
Vehicles driven year-round in non-extreme climates should use a 50/50  
mixture of engine coolant and distilled water for optimum cooling system  
and engine protection.  
What you should know about fail-safe cooling (if equipped)  
If the engine coolant supply is depleted, this feature allows the vehicle to  
be driven temporarily before incremental component damage is incurred.  
The “fail-safe” distance depends on ambient temperatures, vehicle load  
and terrain.  
How fail-safe cooling works  
If the engine begins to overheat:  
The engine coolant temperature gauge will move to the red (hot) area.  
368  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
The message center will indicate the engine is overheating.  
The  
indicator will illuminate.  
If the engine reaches a preset over-temperature condition, the engine  
will automatically switch to alternating cylinder operation. Each disabled  
cylinder acts as an air pump and cools the engine.  
When this occurs the vehicle will still operate. However:  
The engine power will be limited.  
The air conditioning system will be disabled.  
Continued operation will increase the engine temperature and the engine  
will completely shut down, causing steering and braking effort to  
increase.  
Once the engine temperature cools, the engine can be re-started. Take  
your vehicle to a service facility as soon as possible to minimize engine  
damage.  
When fail-safe mode is activated  
You have limited engine power when in the fail-safe mode, so drive the  
vehicle with caution. The vehicle will not be able to maintain high-speed  
operation and the engine will run rough. Remember that the engine is  
capable of completely shutting down automatically to prevent engine  
damage; therefore:  
1. Pull off the road as soon as safely possible and turn off the engine.  
2. Arrange for the vehicle to be taken to a service facility.  
3. If this is not possible, wait a short period for the engine to cool.  
4. Check the coolant level and replenish if low.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
5. Re-start the engine and take your vehicle to a service facility.  
Driving the vehicle without repairing the engine problem  
increases the chance of engine damage. Take your vehicle to a  
service facility as soon as possible.  
369  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
FUEL FILTER  
For fuel filter replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to  
scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate intervals for  
changing the fuel filter.  
Replace the fuel filter with an authorized Motorcraft part. The  
customer warranty may be void for any damage to the fuel system  
if an authorized Motorcraft fuel filter is not used.  
WHAT YOU SHOULD KNOW ABOUT AUTOMOTIVE FUELS  
Important safety precautions  
WARNING: Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an  
overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If the fuel  
filler cap is venting vapor or if you hear a hissing sound, wait  
until it stops before completely removing the fuel filler cap. Otherwise,  
fuel may spray out and injure you or others.  
WARNING: If you do not use the proper fuel filler cap,  
excessive vacuum in the fuel tank may damage the fuel system  
or cause the fuel cap to disengage in a collision, which may result in  
serious personal injury.  
WARNING: Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death  
if misused or mishandled.  
WARNING: Gasoline may contain benzene, which is a  
cancer-causing agent.  
370  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Observe the following guidelines when handling automotive fuel:  
Extinguish all smoking materials  
and any open flames before  
refueling your vehicle.  
Always turn off the vehicle before  
refueling.  
Automotive fuels can be harmful  
or fatal if swallowed. Fuel such as gasoline is highly toxic and if  
swallowed can cause death or permanent injury. If fuel is swallowed,  
call a physician immediately, even if no symptoms are immediately  
apparent. The toxic effects of fuel may not be visible for hours.  
Avoid inhaling fuel vapors. Inhaling too much fuel vapor of any kind  
can lead to eye and respiratory tract irritation. In severe cases,  
excessive or prolonged breathing of fuel vapor can cause serious  
illness and permanent injury.  
Avoid getting fuel liquid in your eyes. If fuel is splashed in the eyes,  
remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with water for 15 minutes and  
seek medical attention. Failure to seek proper medical attention could  
lead to permanent injury.  
Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin and/or clothing, promptly remove contaminated  
clothing and wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Repeated or  
prolonged skin contact with fuel liquid or vapor causes skin irritation.  
Be particularly careful if you are taking “Antabuse” or other forms of  
disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism. Breathing gasoline vapors,  
or skin contact could cause an adverse reaction. In sensitive  
individuals, serious personal injury or sickness may result. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin, promptly wash skin thoroughly with soap and  
water. Consult a physician immediately if you experience an adverse  
reaction.  
WARNING: When refueling always shut the engine off and  
never allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never  
smoke while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain  
conditions. Care should be taken to avoid inhaling excess fumes.  
WARNING: The flow of fuel through a fuel pump nozzle can  
produce static electricity, which can cause a fire if fuel is  
pumped into an ungrounded fuel container.  
371  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Refueling  
WARNING: Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause  
severe injuries. To help avoid injuries to you and others:  
Read and follow all the instructions on the pump island;  
Turn off your engine when you are refueling;  
Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle;  
Keep sparks, flames and smoking materials away from fuel;  
Stay outside your vehicle and do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling your vehicle — this is against the law in some places;  
Keep children away from the fuel pump; never let children pump  
fuel.  
Use the following guidelines to avoid electrostatic charge build-up when  
filling an ungrounded fuel container:  
Place approved fuel container on the ground.  
DO NOT fill a fuel container while it is in the vehicle (including the  
cargo area).  
Keep the fuel pump nozzle in contact with the fuel container while  
filling.  
DO NOT use a device that would hold the fuel pump handle in the fill  
position.  
Fuel filler cap  
When fueling your vehicle:  
1. Turn the engine off.  
2. Carefully turn the filler cap counterclockwise until it spins off.  
3. Pull to remove the cap from the fuel filler pipe.  
4. To install the cap, align the tabs on the cap with the notches on the  
filler pipe.  
5. Turn the filler cap clockwise until it clicks.  
If the “Check Fuel Cap” indicator comes on and stays on after you start  
the engine, the fuel filler cap may not be properly installed. Turn off the  
engine, remove the fuel filler cap, align the cap properly and reinstall it.  
372  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
If you must replace the fuel filler cap, replace it with a fuel filler  
cap that is designed for your vehicle. The vehicle warranty may  
be void for any damage to the fuel tank or fuel system if the  
correct genuine Ford or Motorcraft fuel filler cap is not used.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If the fuel  
filler cap is venting vapor or if you hear a hissing sound, wait  
until it stops before completely removing the fuel filler cap. Otherwise,  
fuel may spray out and injure you or others.  
WARNING: If you do not use the proper fuel filler cap,  
excessive pressure or vacuum in the fuel tank may damage the  
fuel system or cause the fuel cap to disengage in a collision, which may  
result in possible personal injury.  
Choosing the right fuel  
Use only UNLEADED fuel or UNLEADED fuel blended with a maximum  
of 10% ethanol. Do not use fuel ethanol (E85), diesel, methanol, leaded  
fuel or any other fuel. The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law and  
could damage your vehicle.  
Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel or fuel additives with metallic  
compounds, including manganese-based additives.  
Note: Use of any fuel other than those recommended may cause  
powertrain damage, a loss of vehicle performance, and repairs may not  
be covered under warranty.  
373  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Octane recommendations  
Your vehicle is designed to use  
“Regular” unleaded gasoline with a  
pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of 87.  
Some stations offer fuels posted as  
“Regular” with an octane rating  
below 87, particularly in high altitude areas. Fuels with octane levels  
below 87 are not recommended.  
87  
(R+M)/2 METHOD  
Do not be concerned if your engine sometimes knocks lightly. However, if  
it knocks heavily under most driving conditions while you are using fuel  
with the recommended octane rating, see your authorized dealer to  
prevent any engine damage.  
Fuel quality  
If you are experiencing starting, rough idle or hesitation driveability  
problems, try a different brand of unleaded gasoline. If the problems  
persist, see your authorized dealer.  
Do not add aftermarket fuel additive products to your fuel tank. It  
should not be necessary to add any aftermarket products to your fuel  
tank if you continue to use high quality fuel of the recommended octane  
rating. These products have not been approved for your engine and  
could cause damage to the fuel system. Repairs to correct the effects of  
using an aftermarket product in your fuel may not be covered by your  
warranty.  
Many of the world’s automakers approved the World-Wide Fuel Charter  
that recommends gasoline specifications to provide improved  
performance and emission control system protection for your vehicle.  
Gasolines that meet the World-Wide Fuel Charter should be used when  
available. Ask your fuel supplier about gasolines that meet the  
World-Wide Fuel Charter.  
Cleaner air  
Ford endorses the use of reformulated “cleaner-burning” gasolines to  
improve air quality, per the recommendations in the Choosing the right  
fuel section.  
374  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Running out of fuel  
Avoid running out of fuel because this situation may have an adverse  
effect on powertrain components.  
If you have run out of fuel:  
You may need to cycle the ignition from off to on several times after  
refueling to allow the fuel system to pump the fuel from the tank to  
the engine. On restarting, cranking time will take a few seconds longer  
than normal.  
Normally, adding 1 gallon (3.8L) of fuel is enough to restart the  
engine. If the vehicle is out of fuel and on a steep grade, more than  
1 gallon (3.8L) may be required.  
The service engine soon  
indicator may come on. For more  
indicator, refer to  
information on the service engine soon  
Warning lights and chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
ESSENTIALS OF GOOD FUEL ECONOMY  
Measuring techniques  
Your best source of information about actual fuel economy is you, the  
driver. You must gather information as accurately and consistently as  
possible. Fuel expense, frequency of fill-ups or fuel gauge readings are  
NOT accurate as a measure of fuel economy. We do not recommend taking  
fuel economy measurements during the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of  
driving (engine break-in period). You will get a more accurate  
measurement after 2,000 miles–3,000 miles (3,000 km–5,000 km).  
Filling the tank  
The advertised fuel capacity of the fuel tank on your vehicle is equal to  
the rated refill capacity of the fuel tank as listed in the Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities section of this chapter.  
The advertised capacity is the amount of the indicated capacity and the  
empty reserve combined. Indicated capacity is the difference in the  
amount of fuel in a full tank and a tank when the fuel gauge indicates  
empty. Empty reserve is the small amount of fuel remaining in the fuel  
tank after the fuel gauge indicates empty.  
The amount of usable fuel in the empty reserve varies and should  
not be relied upon to increase driving range. When refueling your  
vehicle after the fuel gauge indicates empty, you might not be  
able to refuel the full amount of the advertised capacity of the  
fuel tank due to the empty reserve still present in the tank.  
375  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
For consistent results when filling the fuel tank:  
Turn the engine/ignition switch to the off position prior to refueling,  
an error in the reading will result if the engine is left running.  
Use the same filling rate setting (low — medium — high) each time  
the tank is filled.  
Allow no more than two automatic click-offs when filling.  
Always use fuel with the recommended octane rating.  
Use a known quality gasoline, preferably a national brand.  
Use the same side of the same pump and have the vehicle facing the  
same direction each time you fill up.  
Have the vehicle loading and distribution the same every time.  
Your results will be most accurate if your filling method is consistent.  
Calculating fuel economy  
1. Fill the fuel tank completely and record the initial odometer reading  
(in miles or kilometers).  
2. Each time you fill the tank, record the amount of fuel added (in  
gallons or liters).  
3. After at least three to five tank fill-ups, fill the fuel tank and record  
the current odometer reading.  
4. Subtract your initial odometer reading from the current odometer  
reading.  
5. Follow one of the simple calculations in order to determine fuel  
economy:  
Calculation 1: Divide total miles traveled by total gallons used.  
Calculation 2: Multiply liters used by 100, then divide by total  
kilometers traveled.  
Keep a record for at least one month and record the type of driving (city  
or highway). This will provide an accurate estimate of the vehicle’s fuel  
economy under current driving conditions. Additionally, keeping records  
during summer and winter will show how temperature impacts fuel  
economy. In general, lower temperatures give lower fuel economy.  
Driving style — good driving and fuel economy habits  
Give consideration to the lists that follow and you may be able to change  
a number of variables and improve your fuel economy.  
376  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Habits  
Smooth, moderate operation can yield up to 10% savings in fuel.  
Steady speeds without stopping will usually give the best fuel economy.  
Idling for long periods of time (greater than one minute) may waste  
fuel.  
Anticipate stopping; slowing down may eliminate the need to stop.  
Sudden or hard accelerations may reduce fuel economy.  
Slow down gradually.  
Driving at reasonable speeds (traveling at 55 mph [88 km/h] uses 15%  
less fuel than traveling at 65 mph [105 km/h]).  
Revving the engine before turning it off may reduce fuel economy.  
Using the air conditioner or defroster may reduce fuel economy.  
You may want to turn off the speed control in hilly terrain if  
unnecessary shifting between the top gears occurs. Unnecessary  
shifting of this type could result in reduced fuel economy.  
Warming up a vehicle on cold mornings is not required and may  
reduce fuel economy.  
Resting your foot on the brake pedal while driving may reduce fuel  
economy.  
Combine errands and minimize stop-and-go driving.  
Maintenance  
Keep tires properly inflated and use only recommended size.  
Operating a vehicle with the wheels out of alignment will reduce fuel  
economy.  
Use recommended engine oil. Refer to Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Perform all regularly scheduled maintenance items. Follow the  
recommended maintenance schedule and owner maintenance checks  
found in scheduled maintenance information.  
Conditions  
Heavily loading a vehicle or towing a trailer may reduce fuel economy  
at any speed.  
Carrying unnecessary weight may reduce fuel economy (approximately  
1 mpg [0.4 km/L] is lost for every 400 lb [180 kg] of weight carried).  
377  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Adding certain accessories to your vehicle (for example bug  
deflectors, rollbars/light bars, running boards, ski/luggage racks) may  
reduce fuel economy.  
To maximize the fuel economy, drive with the tonneau cover installed  
(if equipped).  
Using fuel blended with alcohol may lower fuel economy.  
Fuel economy may decrease with lower temperatures during the first  
8–10 miles (12–16 km) of driving.  
Driving on flat terrain offers improved fuel economy as compared to  
driving on hilly terrain.  
Transmissions give their best fuel economy when operated in the top  
cruise gear and with steady pressure on the gas pedal.  
Four-wheel-drive operation (if equipped) is less fuel efficient than  
two-wheel-drive operation.  
Close windows for high speed driving.  
EPA fuel economy estimates  
If applicable, every new vehicle should have a sticker on the window  
called the Monroney Label which contains EPA fuel economy estimates.  
Contact your authorized dealer if the Monroney Label is not supplied  
with your vehicle. The EPA fuel economy estimates should be your guide  
for the fuel economy comparisons with other vehicles. Your fuel economy  
may vary depending upon the method of operation and conditions.  
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM  
Your vehicle is equipped with various emission control components and a  
catalytic converter which will enable your vehicle to comply with applicable  
exhaust emission standards. To make sure that the catalytic converter and  
other emission control components continue to work properly:  
Use only the specified fuel listed.  
Avoid running out of fuel.  
Do not turn off the ignition while your vehicle is moving, especially at  
high speeds.  
Have the items listed in scheduled maintenance information  
performed according to the specified schedule.  
The scheduled maintenance items listed in scheduled maintenance  
information are essential to the life and performance of your vehicle  
and to its emissions system.  
378  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
If other than Ford, Motorcraftor Ford-authorized parts are used for  
maintenance replacements or for service of components affecting  
emission control, such non-Ford parts should be equivalent to genuine  
Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
Illumination of the service engine soon  
indicator, charging system  
warning light or the temperature warning light, fluid leaks, strange odors,  
smoke or loss of engine power could indicate that the emission control  
system is not working properly.  
An improperly operating or damaged exhaust system may allow exhaust  
to enter the vehicle. Have a damaged or improperly operating exhaust  
system inspected and repaired immediately.  
WARNING: Exhaust leaks may result in entry of harmful and  
potentially lethal fumes into the passenger compartment.  
Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or engine. By  
law, vehicle owners and anyone who manufactures, repairs, services,  
sells, leases, trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles are not  
permitted to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent  
it from working. Information about your vehicle’s emission system is on  
the Vehicle Emission Control Information Decal located on or near the  
engine. This decal also lists engine displacement.  
Please consult your Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for  
complete emission warranty information.  
On board diagnostics (OBD-II)  
Your vehicle is equipped with a computer that monitors the engine’s  
emission control system. This system is commonly known as the On  
Board Diagnostics System (OBD-II). The OBD-II system protects the  
environment by ensuring that your vehicle continues to meet  
government emission standards. The OBD-II system also assists your  
authorized dealer in properly servicing your vehicle. When the service  
engine soon  
a malfunction. Temporary malfunctions may cause the service engine  
soon indicator to illuminate. Examples are:  
indicator illuminates, the OBD-II system has detected  
1. The vehicle has run out of fuel—the engine may misfire or run poorly.  
379  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
2. Poor fuel quality or water in the fuel—the engine may misfire or run  
poorly.  
3. The fuel cap may not have been securely tightened. See Fuel filler  
cap in this chapter.  
4. Driving through deep water—the electrical system may be wet.  
These temporary malfunctions can be corrected by filling the fuel tank  
with good quality fuel, properly tightening the fuel cap or letting the  
electrical system dry out. After three driving cycles without these or any  
other temporary malfunctions present, the service engine soon  
indicator should stay off the next time the engine is started. A driving  
cycle consists of a cold engine startup followed by mixed city/highway  
driving. No additional vehicle service is required.  
If the service engine soon  
indicator remains on, have your vehicle  
serviced at the first available opportunity. Although some malfunctions  
detected by the OBD-II may not have symptoms that are apparent,  
continued driving with the service engine soon  
indicator on can  
result in increased emissions, lower fuel economy, reduced engine and  
transmission smoothness, and lead to more costly repairs.  
Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing  
Some state/provincial and local governments may have  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) programs to inspect the emission control  
equipment on your vehicle. Failure to pass this inspection could prevent  
you from getting a vehicle registration. Your vehicle may not pass the I/M  
test if the service engine soon  
indicator is on or not working  
properly (bulb is burned out), or if the OBD-II system has determined  
that some of the emission control systems have not been properly  
checked. In this case, the vehicle is considered not ready for I/M testing.  
If the service engine soon  
indicator is on or the bulb does not  
work, the vehicle may need to be serviced. Refer to the On board  
diagnostics (OBD-II) description in this chapter.  
If the vehicle’s engine or transmission has just been serviced, or the  
battery has recently run down or been replaced, the OBD-II system may  
indicate that the vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. To determine if the  
vehicle is ready for I/M testing, turn the ignition key to the on position  
for 15 seconds without cranking the engine. If the service engine  
soon  
indicator blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not  
ready for I/M testing; if the service engine soon  
indicator stays on  
solid, it means that the vehicle is ready for I/M testing.  
380  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
The OBD-II system is designed to check the emission control system  
during normal driving. A complete check may take several days. If the  
vehicle is not ready for I/M testing, the following driving cycle consisting  
of mixed city and highway driving may be performed:  
15 minutes of steady driving on an expressway/highway followed by  
20 minutes of stop-and-go driving with at least four 30-second idle  
periods.  
Allow the vehicle to sit for at least eight hours without starting the  
engine. Then, start the engine and complete the above driving cycle. The  
engine must warm up to its normal operating temperature. Once started,  
do not turn off the engine until the above driving cycle is complete. If  
the vehicle is still not ready for I/M testing, the above driving cycle will  
have to be repeated.  
POWER STEERING FLUID  
Check the power steering fluid. Refer to scheduled maintenance  
information. If adding fluid is necessary, use only MERCONATF.  
Gasoline engine shown; diesel  
engine similar. Refer to  
Identifying components in the  
engine compartment in the 6.0  
and 6.4 Liter Power Stroke  
Direct Injection Turbo Diesel  
Owner Guide Supplement.  
Check the fluid level when it is at ambient temperature, 20°F–80°F  
(-7°C–25°C):  
1. Check the fluid level in the reservoir. It should be between the MIN  
and MAX range. Do not add fluid if the level is within this range.  
2. If the fluid level is low. Add fluid to bring fluid level up to be between  
the MIN and MAX range.  
3. Start the engine.  
4. While the engine idles, turn the steering wheel left and right several  
times.  
5. Turn the engine off.  
6. Recheck the fluid level in the reservoir. Do not add fluid if the level is  
between the MIN and MAX range.  
381  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
7. If the fluid is low, add fluid in small amounts, continuously checking  
the level until it is between the MIN and MAX range. Refer to  
Maintenance Products Specifications and Capacities in this chapter  
for the proper fluid type. Be sure to put the cap back on the reservoir.  
BRAKE FLUID  
Vacuum boost system  
Hydroboost system  
The fluid level will drop slowly as the brakes wear, and will rise when the  
brake components are replaced. Fluid levels between the MIN and MAX  
lines are within the normal operating range; there is no need to add  
fluid. If the fluid levels are outside of the normal operating range, the  
performance of your brake system could be compromised; seek service  
from your authorized dealer immediately.  
382  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
CLUTCH FLUID (IF EQUIPPED)  
Check the fluid level. Refer to scheduled maintenance information for  
the service interval schedules.  
During normal operation, the fluid level in the clutch reservoir should  
remain constant. If the fluid level drops, refill the fluid level to the step  
in the reservoir.  
Use only a DOT 3 brake fluid designed to meet Ford specifications. Refer  
to Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
WARNING: Carefully read cautionary information on product  
label. For MEDICAL EMERGENCY INFORMATION contact a  
physician or Poison Control Center immediately; on Ford-Motorcraft  
products call: 1-800-959-3673 (FORD). Failure to follow these  
instructions may result in personal injury.  
1. Clean the reservoir cap before  
removal to prevent dirt and water  
from entering the reservoir.  
2. Remove cap and rubber  
diaphragm from reservoir.  
3. Add fluid until the level reaches  
the step in the reservoir.  
4. Reinstall rubber diaphragm and  
cap onto reservoir.  
TRANSMISSION FLUID  
Checking automatic transmission fluid (if equipped)  
Refer to your scheduled maintenance information for scheduled  
intervals for fluid checks and changes. Your transmission does not  
consume fluid. However, the fluid level should be checked if the  
transmission is not working properly, i.e., if the transmission slips or  
shifts slowly or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage.  
Automatic transmission fluid expands when warmed. To obtain an  
accurate fluid check, drive the vehicle until it is at normal operating  
temperature (approximately 20 miles [30 km]). If your vehicle has been  
operated for an extended period at high speeds, in city traffic during hot  
weather or pulling a trailer, the vehicle should be turned off for about  
30 minutes to allow fluid to cool before checking.  
383  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
1. Drive the vehicle 20 miles (30 km) or until it reaches normal operating  
temperature.  
2. Park the vehicle on a level surface and engage the parking brake.  
3. With the parking brake engaged and your foot on the brake pedal,  
start the engine and move the gearshift lever through all of the gear  
ranges. Allow sufficient time for each gear to engage.  
4. Latch the gearshift lever in P (Park) and leave the engine running.  
5. Remove the dipstick, wiping it clean with a clean, dry lint free rag. If  
necessary, refer to Identifying components in the engine compartment  
in this chapter for the location of the dipstick.  
6. Install the dipstick making sure it is fully seated in the filler tube.  
7. Remove the dipstick and inspect the fluid level. The fluid should be in  
the designated area for normal operating temperature or ambient  
temperature.  
Low fluid level  
Do not drive the vehicle if the fluid  
level is at the bottom of the dipstick  
and the ambient temperature is  
above 50°F (10°C).  
Correct fluid level  
The transmission fluid should be checked at normal operating  
temperature 150°F-170°F (66°C-77°C) on a level surface. The normal  
operating temperature can be reached after approximately 20 miles  
(30 km) of driving.  
You can check the fluid without driving if the ambient temperature is  
above 50°F (10°C). However, if fluid is added at this time, an overfill  
condition could result when the vehicle reaches normal operating  
temperature.  
The transmission fluid should be in  
this range if at normal operating  
temperature (150°F-170°F  
[66°C-77°C]).  
The transmission fluid should be in  
this range if at ambient temperature  
(50°F-95°F [10°C-35°C]).  
384  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
High fluid level  
Fluid levels above the safe range  
may result in transmission failure.  
An overfill condition of transmission  
fluid may cause shift and/or  
engagement concerns and/or possible damage.  
High fluid levels can be caused by an overheating condition.  
Adjusting automatic transmission fluid levels  
Before adding any fluid, make sure the correct type is used. The type of  
fluid used is normally indicated on the dipstick handle and also in the  
Maintenance Product Specifications and Capacities section in this  
chapter.  
Use of a non-approved automatic transmission fluid may cause  
internal transmission component damage.  
If necessary, add fluid in 1/2 pint (250 ml) increments through the filler  
tube until the level is correct.  
If an overfill occurs, excess fluid  
should be removed by a qualified  
technician.  
An overfill condition of  
transmission fluid may cause shift and/or engagement concerns  
and/or possible damage.  
Do not use supplemental transmission fluid additives, treatments or  
cleaning agents. The use of these materials may affect transmission  
operation and result in damage to internal transmission components.  
385  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Checking and adding manual transmission fluid (if equipped)  
1. Clean the filler plug.  
2. Remove the filler plug and  
inspect the fluid level.  
3. Fluid level should be at the  
bottom of the opening.  
4. Add enough fluid through the  
filler opening so that the fluid level  
is at the bottom of the opening.  
5. Install and tighten the fill plug  
securely.  
Use only fluid that meets Ford specifications. Refer to Maintenance  
Product Specifications and Capacities in this chapter.  
386  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
TRANSFER CASE FLUID (IF EQUIPPED)  
1. Clean the filler plug.  
2. Remove the filler plug and  
inspect the fluid level.  
3. Add only enough fluid through  
the filler opening so that the fluid  
level is at the bottom of the  
opening.  
Use only fluid that meets Ford specifications. Refer to the Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities section in this chapter.  
387  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
AIR FILTER  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for changing the air filter element.  
When changing the air filter element, use only the Motorcraft air filter  
element listed. Refer to Motorcraft part numbers in this chapter.  
The following procedure is for vehicles equipped with a gasoline engine.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a diesel engine, refer to the 6.0 and 6.4  
Liter Power Stroke Direct Injection Turbo Diesel Owner’s Guide  
Supplement.  
Note: Do not start your engine with the air cleaner removed and do not  
remove it while the engine is running.  
Changing the air filter element  
1. Loosen clamp and disconnect  
sensor.  
2. Release three retainer clamps.  
3. Pull air filter cover toward passenger side of vehicle and up to release  
the tabs. Lift air filter element up and out of housing.  
The air filter box needs to be free of any debris before installing a new  
air filter.  
4. Install a new air filter element into the tray assembly.  
388  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
5. Return air filter cover to original  
position making sure the four tabs  
are engaged and secure the three  
clamps. Tighten clamp on air tube  
and reconnect sensor.  
MOTORCRAFT PART NUMBERS  
Component  
Air filter element  
Fuel filter  
5.4L V8/6.8L V10 engines  
FA-1883  
FG-1083  
Oil filter  
FL-820-S  
Battery (standard)  
Battery (optional)  
Spark plugs-platinum  
Remote automatic transmission filter  
BXT-65-650  
BXT-65-750  
1
2, 3  
1For spark plug replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to the  
scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate intervals for  
changing the spark plugs.  
Replace the spark plugs with ones that meet Ford material and  
design specifications for your vehicle, such as Motorcraftor  
equivalent replacement parts. The customer warranty may be  
void for any damage to the engine if such spark plugs are not  
used.  
2Also available with 6.4L diesel engine and TorqShift transmission. Part  
number is FT-176.  
3Also available with 6.4L diesel engine and TorqShift transmission. Part  
number is FT-175.  
389  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
390  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
391  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
392  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
393  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
ENGINE DATA  
Engine  
5.4L V8 engine  
330  
87 octane  
1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8  
1.0–1.1mm  
(0.039–0.043 inch)  
Coil on plug  
9.8:1  
6.8L V10 engine  
415  
87 octane  
1-6-5-10-2-7-3-8-4-9  
1.0–1.1mm  
(0.039–0.043 inch)  
Coil on plug  
9.2:1  
Cubic inches  
Required fuel  
Firing order  
Spark plug gap  
Ignition system  
Compression ratio  
Drivebelt routing  
5.4L V8/6.8L V10 engines  
394  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING YOUR VEHICLE  
Safety Compliance Certification Label  
The National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration Regulations require  
that a Safety Compliance  
Certification Label be affixed to a  
vehicle and prescribe where the  
Safety Compliance Certification  
Label may be located. The Safety  
Compliance Certification Label is  
located on the structure by the  
trailing edge of the driver’s door or  
the edge of the driver’s door.  
Vehicle identification number (VIN)  
The vehicle identification number is  
located on the driver side  
instrument panel.  
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX  
Please note that in the graphic,  
XXXX is representative of your  
vehicle identification number.  
395  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) contains the following  
information:  
1. World manufacturer identifier  
2. Brake system / Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) / Restraint  
Devices and their location  
3. Make, vehicle line, series, body  
type  
4. Engine type  
5. Check digit  
6. Model year  
7. Assembly plant  
8. Production sequence number  
TRANSMISSION CODE DESIGNATIONS  
You can find a transmission code on  
the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label. The following table tells you  
which transmission each code  
represents.  
Code  
Description  
5
7
T
B
Six-speed manual, Dana (ZF S6–650)  
Six-speed manual, Dana (Z/F M6HD-W)  
Five-speed automatic, TorqShift (gas engines)  
Five-speed automatic, TorqShift (diesel engine)  
396  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
GENUINE FORD ACCESSORIES FOR YOUR VEHICLE  
A wide selection of Genuine Ford Accessories are available for your  
vehicle through your local Ford or Ford of Canada dealer. These quality  
accessories have been specifically engineered to fulfill your automotive  
needs; they are custom designed to complement the style and  
aerodynamic appearance of your vehicle. In addition, each accessory is  
made from high quality materials and meets or exceeds Ford’s rigorous  
engineering and safety specifications. Ford Motor Company will repair or  
replace any properly dealer-installed Genuine Ford Accessories found to  
be defective in factory-supplied materials or workmanship during the  
warranty period, as well as any component damaged by the defective  
accessories. The accessories will be warranted for whichever provides  
you the greatest benefit:  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 km) (whichever occurs first), or  
the remainder of your new vehicle limited warranty.  
Contact your dealer for details and a copy of the warranty.  
The following is a list of several Genuine Ford Accessories. Not all  
accessories are available for all models. For a complete listing of the  
accessories that are available for your vehicle, please contact your dealer  
or visit our online store at: www.fordaccessories.com.  
Exterior style  
Bug shields  
Chrome exhaust tips  
Deflectors  
Running boards  
Splash guards  
Step bars  
Wheels  
Interior style  
Ambient lighting  
Electrochromic compass/temperature interior mirrors  
Floor mats  
397  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Lifestyle  
Ash cup / smoker’s package  
Bedliners and bedmats  
Cargo organization and management  
Towing mirrors  
Trailer hitches, wiring harnesses and accessories  
Peace of mind  
Keyless entry keypad  
Remote start  
Vehicle security systems  
Wheel locks  
Not all accessories are available for all models.  
For maximum vehicle performance, keep the following information in  
mind when adding accessories or equipment to your vehicle:  
When adding accessories, equipment, passengers and luggage to your  
vehicle, do not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of  
the front or rear axle (GVWR or GAWR as indicated on the Safety  
Compliance Certification Label). Consult your authorized dealer for  
specific weight information.  
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio  
Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulate the use of mobile  
communications systems — such as two-way radios, telephones and  
theft alarms - that are equipped with radio transmitters. Any such  
equipment installed in your vehicle should comply with FCC or CRTC  
regulations and should be installed only by your authorized dealer.  
Mobile communications systems may harm the operation of your vehicle,  
particularly if they are not properly designed for automotive use.  
To avoid interference with other vehicle functions, such as anti-lock  
braking systems, amateur radio users who install radios and antennas  
onto their vehicle should not locate the Amateur Radio Antennas in  
the area of the driver’s side hood.  
Electrical or electronic accessories or components that are added to  
the vehicle by the authorized dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
398  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
FORD ESP EXTENDED SERVICE PLANS  
More than 30 million Ford, Lincoln, and Mercury owners have discovered  
the powerful protection of Ford ESP. It is the only extended service plan  
backed by Ford Motor Company, and provides “peace of mind”  
protection beyond the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage.  
Up to 500+ Covered Vehicle Components  
There are four, new-vehicle Extended Service Plans with different levels  
of coverage. Ask you dealer for details.  
PremiumCare – Our most comprehensive coverage. With over 500  
covered components, this plan is so complete that we generally only  
discuss what’s not covered!  
ExtraCare – Covers 113 components, and includes many high-tech  
items.  
BaseCare – Covers 84 components.  
PowertrainCare – Covers 29 critical components.  
Ford ESP is honored by all Ford, Lincoln and Mercury Dealers in  
the U.S. and Canada It’s the only extended service plan authorized and  
backed by Ford Motor Company. That means you get:  
Reliable, quality service anywhere you go.  
Factory-trained technicians.  
Genuine Ford and MotorcraftParts.  
Rental car reimbursement  
If your vehicle is kept overnight for covered repairs, you are  
eligible for rental car coverage, including Bumper-to-Bumper warranty  
repairs, or manufacturer’s recalls.  
Transferable coverage  
If you sell your vehicle before your Ford ESP coverage expires, you can  
transfer any remaining coverage to the new owner. Whenever you’re  
ready to sell your car, prospective buyers may feel better about taking a  
risk on your used vehicle. Ford ESP may add resale value!  
Plus, exclusive 24/7 roadside assistance, including:  
Towing, flat-tire change and battery jump starts.  
Out-of-fuel and lock-out assistance.  
Travel expense reimbursement for lodging, meals and rental car.  
Destination assistance for taxi, shuttle, rental car coverage and  
emergency transportation.  
399  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ford Extended Service Plan  
Ford ESP Can Quickly Pay for Itself  
One service bill – the cost of parts and labor – can easily exceed the  
price of your Ford ESP Service Contract. With Ford ESP, you minimize  
your risk for unexpected repair bills and rising repair costs.  
Avoid the rising cost of properly maintaining your vehicle!  
Ford ESP also offers a Premium Maintenance Plan that covers items that  
routinely wear out.  
The coverage is prepaid, so you never have to worry about affording  
your vehicle maintenance. It covers regular checkups, routine  
inspections, preventive care and replacement of items that require  
periodic attention for normal “wear”:  
Wiper blades  
Spark plugs (except  
California)  
Clutch disc  
Brake pads and linings  
Shock absorbers  
Belts and hoses  
Contact your selling Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealership today so they  
can customize a Ford Extended Service Plan that fits your driving  
lifestyle and budget.  
Interest free finance options available  
Take advantage of our installment payment plan, just a 10% down  
payment will provide you with an affordable no interest, no-fee payment  
opportunity.  
400  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
401  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A
B
C
Cleaning your vehicle  
Axle  
402  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
D
Dipstick  
Clock adjust  
Clutch  
Compass, electronic  
E
Controls  
Emergencies, roadside  
Coolant  
403  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
G
F
H
Heating  
I
404  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Instrument panel  
M
J
K
Keyless entry system  
L
Lamps  
N
O
P
Locks  
405  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
R
Setting the clock  
S
Steering wheel  
406  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Transfer case  
T
Transmission  
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System (TPMS)  
U
V
W
Windows  
407  
2010 F-250/350/450/550 (f23)  
Owners Guide, 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Echo Trimmer 99944200540 User Manual
Euro Pro Gas Grill KG845E User Manual
Extron electronic Switch 68 392 02 User Manual
Faber Ventilation Hood 5980410 User Manual
Fender Guitar 12683 User Manual
Furuno Radar Detector FA 50 User Manual
Garland Oven SUMG100D1 User Manual
Gefen Cable Box EXT DVI 2 VGAN User Manual
Gianni Industries Door TB 400 User Manual
GN Netcom Headphones STRATUS ULTRA G User Manual